2015
OWNER’S MANUAL
300
VEHICLES SOLD IN CANADA
With respect to any Vehicles Sold in Canada, the name
Chrysler Group LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the
name Chrysler Canada Inc. used in substitution therefore.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
Drunken driving is one of the most frequent causes of
accidents.
This manual illustrates and describes the operation of
features and equipment that are either standard or optional on this vehicle. This manual may also include a
description of features and equipment that are no longer
available or were not ordered on this vehicle. Please
disregard any features and equipment described in this
manual that are not on this vehicle.
Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood
alcohol levels far below the legal minimum. If you are
drinking, don’t drive. Ride with a designated nondrinking driver, call a cab, a friend, or use public transportation.
Chrysler Group LLC reserves the right to make changes
in design and specifications, and/or make additions to or
improvements to its products without imposing any
obligation upon itself to install them on products previously manufactured.
WARNING!
Driving after drinking can lead to an accident.
Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are
slower, and your judgment is impaired when you
have been drinking. Never drink and then drive.
Copyright © 2014 Chrysler Group LLC
SECTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
1
1
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
2
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2
3
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
3
4
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
4
5
STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
5
6
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451
6
7
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
7
8
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
8
9
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
9
10
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 559
10
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS
䡵 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER . . . . . . . .6
䡵 HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS . . . .7
䡵 WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
1
4 INTRODUCTION
When it comes to service, remember that your authorized
Congratulations on selecting your new Chrysler Group dealer knows your vehicle best, has factory-trained techniLLC vehicle. Be assured that it represents precision cians and genuine parts, and cares about your satisfaction.
workmanship, distinctive styling, and high quality - all HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
essentials that are traditional to our vehicles.
Consult the Table of Contents to determine which section
This Owner’s Manual has been prepared with the assis- contains the information you desire.
tance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint
you with the operation and maintenance of your vehicle. Since the specification of your vehicle depends on the
It is supplemented by Warranty Information, and various items of equipment ordered, certain descriptions and
customer-oriented documents. Please take the time to illustrations may differ from your vehicle’s equipment.
read these publications carefully. Following the instruc- The detailed index at the back of this Owner’s Manual
tions and recommendations in this manual will help contains a complete listing of all subjects.
assure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.
Consult the following table for a description of the
NOTE: After reviewing the owner information, it symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout
should be stored in the vehicle for convenient referenc- this Owner’s Manual:
ing and remain with the vehicle when sold.
INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION 5
1
6 INTRODUCTION
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS
This Owners Manual contains WARNINGS against operating procedures that could result in a collision or
bodily injury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures that could result in damage to your vehicle. If you
do not read this entire Owners Manual, you may miss
important information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is on the left
front corner of the instrument panel. The VIN is visible
VIN Location
from outside of the vehicle through the windshield. This The vehicle identification number (VIN) is also located
number also appears on the Automobile Information on the right front strut tower inside the engine compartDisclosure Label affixed to a window on your vehicle, the ment.
vehicle registration, and the title.
INTRODUCTION 7
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING!
Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle could
seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety and
may lead to a collision resulting in serious injury or
death.
VIN Location
NOTE: It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN.
1
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2
CONTENTS
䡵 A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
▫ Rearming Of The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Keyless Ignition Node (KIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
▫ To Arm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Key Fob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
▫ To Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
▫ Ignition Or Accessory On Message . . . . . . . . . .15
▫ Security System Manual Override . . . . . . . . . . .21
䡵 SENTRY KEY® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16 䡵 ILLUMINATED ENTRY — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . .21
▫ Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17 䡵 REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) . . . . . . . . . . .21
▫ Customer Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
▫ To Unlock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
▫ To Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
䡵 VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ To Unlatch The Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Using The Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 䡵 WINDOWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
▫ Programming Additional Transmitters . . . . . . .24
▫ Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
▫ Transmitter Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .24
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 䡵 TRUNK LOCK AND RELEASE . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
䡵 REMOTE STARTING SYSTEM —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
▫ How To Use Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
䡵 DOOR LOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
▫ Manual Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
▫ Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
▫ Child-Protection Door Lock System —
Rear Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
䡵 KEYLESS ENTER-N-GO™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
䡵 TRUNK SAFETY WARNING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
▫ Trunk Emergency Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
䡵 OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS . . . . . . . . . .46
▫ Important Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
▫ Seat Belt Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
▫ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . . . . .60
▫ Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
▫ Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11
䡵 ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS . . . .96
䡵 SAFETY TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
▫ Transporting Passengers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
▫ Exhaust Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
▫ Safety Checks You Should Make Inside
The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
▫ Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make
Outside The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
2
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The Keyless Ignition Node (KIN System) has four operating positions, three of which are labeled and will
Your vehicle uses a keyless ignition system. This system
illuminate when in position. The three positions are: OFF,
consists of a Key Fob with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
ACC, and ON/RUN. The fourth position is START.
transmitter and a Keyless Ignition Node (KIN).
During start, ON/RUN will illuminate.
Keyless Enter-N-Go™ Feature
NOTE: In case the ignition does not change with the
This vehicle is equipped with the Keyless Enter-N-Go™ push of a button, the RKE transmitter (Key Fob) may
feature. Refer to ⬙Keyless Enter-N-Go™⬙ in ⬙Things To have a low or dead battery. In this situation, a back up
Know Before Starting Your Vehicle⬙ for further information. method can be used to operate the ignition switch. Put
the nose side (side opposite of the emergency key) of the
Keyless Ignition Node (KIN)
Key Fob against the Engine START/STOP button and
This feature allows the driver to operate the ignition with push to operate the ignition.
the push of a button as long as the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter is in the passenger compartment.
A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13
Key Fob
The Key Fob also contains the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter and an emergency key, which stores in
the rear of the Key Fob.
The emergency key allows for entry into the vehicle
should the battery in the vehicle or the Key Fob go dead.
The emergency key is also for locking/unlocking the
glove compartment. You can keep the emergency key
with you when valet parking.
Keyless Ignition Node (KIN System)
1 — OFF
2 — ACC (ACCESSORY)
3 — ON/RUN
2
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To remove the emergency key, slide the mechanical latch
on the back of the Key Fob sideways with your thumb
and then pull the key out with your other hand.
Emergency Key Removal
NOTE: You can insert the double-sided emergency key
into the lock cylinders with either side up.
Mechanical Latch On The Back Of The Key Fob
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15
Ignition Or Accessory On Message
Opening the driver’s door when the ignition is in ACC or
ON (engine not running), a chime will sound to remind you
to cycle the ignition to OFF. In addition to the chime, the
ignition or accessory on message will display in the cluster.
NOTE: With the Uconnect® system, the power window
switches, radio, power sunroof (if equipped), and power
outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the
ignition is placed in the OFF position. Opening either
front door will cancel this feature. The time for this
feature is programmable. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings”
in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further
information.
WARNING!
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the Key
Fob from the vehicle and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children, and do not
leave the ignition of a vehicle equipped with
Keyless Enter-N-Go™ in the ACC or ON/RUN
mode. A child could operate power windows, other
controls, or move the vehicle.
(Continued)
2
16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
CAUTION!
The system uses a Key Fob with a factory-mated Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, a Keyless Ignition Node
(KIN) and a RF receiver to prevent unauthorized vehicle
operation. Therefore, only Key Fobs that are programmed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate
the vehicle. The system will not allow the engine to crank
with an invalid Key Fob.
After placing the ignition to the ON/RUN position, the
Vehicle Security Light will turn on for three seconds for a
bulb check. If the light remains on after the bulb check, it
indicates that there is a problem with the system. In
addition, if the light begins to flash after the bulb check,
it indicates that someone used an invalid Key Fob to start
SENTRY KEY®
the engine. Either of these conditions will result in the
The Sentry Key® Immobilizer system prevents unauthor- engine being shut off after two seconds.
ized vehicle operation by disabling the engine. The
system does not need to be armed or activated. Operation
is automatic, regardless of whether the vehicle is locked
or unlocked.
An unlocked car is an invitation to thieves. Always
remove the Key Fob from vehicle, place the ignition
in the OFF and lock all doors when leaving the
vehicle unattended.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17
If the Vehicle Security Light turns on during normal
vehicle operation (vehicle running for longer than 10
seconds), it indicates that there is a fault in the system.
Should this occur, have the vehicle serviced as soon as
possible by an authorized dealer.
CAUTION!
• Do not make modifications or alterations to the
immobilizer system. Modifications or alterations to
the immobilization system may result in a loss of
security protection.
• The Sentry Key® Immobilizer system is not compatible with some aftermarket remote starting systems. Use of these systems may result in vehicle
starting problems and loss of security protection.
All of the Key Fobs provided with your new vehicle have
been programmed to the vehicle electronics.
Replacement Keys
NOTE: Only Key Fobs that are programmed to the
vehicle electronics can be used to start and operate the
vehicle. Once a Key Fob is programmed to a vehicle, it
cannot be programmed to any other vehicle.
CAUTION!
• Always remove the Key Fobs from the vehicle and
lock all doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
• For vehicles equipped with Keyless Enter-N-Go™,
always remember to place the ignition in the OFF
position.
2
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
At the time of purchase, the original owner is provided
with a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN).
Keep the PIN in a secure location. This number is
required for authorized dealer replacement of Key Fobs.
Duplication of Key Fobs may be performed at an authorized dealer. This procedure consists of programming a
blank Key Fob to the vehicle electronics. A blank Key Fob
is one that has never been programmed.
General Information
Customer Key Programming
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
The Sentry Key® system complies with FCC rules part 15
and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is
subject to the following conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
• This device must accept any interference that may be
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE: When having the Sentry Key® Immobilizer System serviced, bring all vehicle keys with you to an NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved
authorized dealer.
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
Programming Key Fobs or RKE transmitters may be
performed at an authorized dealer.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19
VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM — IF EQUIPPED
To Arm The System
The Vehicle Security Alarm monitors the vehicle doors Follow these steps to arm the Vehicle Security Alarm:
for unauthorized entry and the Keyless Enter-N-Go™
1. Make sure the vehicles ignition is placed in the “OFF”
START/STOP button for unauthorized operation. While
position (refer to ⬙Starting Procedures⬙ in ⬙Starting
the Vehicle Security Alarm is armed, interior switches for
And Operating⬙ for further information).
door locks and decklid release are disabled. If something
• Make sure the vehicle ignition system is OFF.
triggers the alarm, the Vehicle Security Alarm will provide the following audible and visible signals: the horn 2. Perform one of the following methods to lock the
will pulse, the park lamps and/or turn signals will flash,
vehicle:
and the Vehicle Security Light in the instrument cluster
• Push LOCK on the interior power door lock switch
will flash.
with the driver and/or passenger door open.
Rearming Of The System
• Push the LOCK button on the exterior Passive Entry
If something triggers the alarm, and no action is taken to
Door Handle with a valid Key Fob available in the
disarm it, the Vehicle Security Alarm will turn the horn
same exterior zone (refer to ⬙Keyless Enter-N-Go™⬙
off after 29 seconds, 5 seconds between cycles, up to 8
in ⬙Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle⬙ for
cycles if the trigger remains active and then the Vehicle
further information).
Security Alarm will rearm itself.
2
20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Push the LOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry NOTE:
(RKE) transmitter.
• The driver’s door key cylinder and the trunk button on
the RKE transmitter cannot arm or disarm the Vehicle
3. If any doors are open, close them.
Security Alarm.
To Disarm The System
The Vehicle Security Alarm can be disarmed using any of • When the Vehicle Security Alarm is armed, the interior
power door lock switches will not unlock the doors.
the following methods:
The Vehicle Security Alarm is designed to protect your
• Push the UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless
vehicle. However, you can create conditions where the
Entry (RKE) transmitter.
system will give you a false alarm. If one of the previously
• Grasp the Passive Entry Unlock Door Handle if described arming sequences has occurred, the Vehicle Secuequipped. Refer to “Keyless Enter-N-Go™” in “Things rity Alarm will arm regardless of whether you are in the
To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further vehicle or not. If you remain in the vehicle and open a door,
the alarm will sound. If this occurs, disarm the Vehicle
information.
Security Alarm.
• Place the vehicle ignition system in the OFF position.
• Push the Keyless Enter-N-Go™ START/STOP button (requires at least one valid Key Fob in the
vehicle).
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21
If the Vehicle Security Alarm is armed and the battery NOTE:
becomes disconnected, the Vehicle Security Alarm will re• The front courtesy overhead console and door courmain armed when the battery is reconnected; the exterior
tesy lights will turn on if the dimmer control is in the
lights will flash, the horn will sound. If this occurs, disarm
“Dome ON” position (extreme top position).
the Vehicle Security Alarm.
• The Illuminated Entry system will not operate if the
Security System Manual Override
dimmer control is in the “Dome defeat” position
The Vehicle Security Alarm will not arm if you lock the
(extreme bottom position).
doors using the manual door lock plunger.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE)
ILLUMINATED ENTRY — IF EQUIPPED
The RKE system allows you to lock or unlock the doors,
The courtesy lights will turn on when you use the open the trunk, or activate the Panic Alarm from disRemote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter to unlock the tances up to approximately 66 ft (20 m) using a hand-held
doors or open any door.
Key Fob with RKE transmitter. The RKE transmitter does
This feature also turns on the approach lighting in the not need to be pointed at the vehicle to activate the
system.
outside mirrors (if equipped).
The lights will fade to off after approximately 30 seconds,
or they will immediately fade to off once the ignition is
placed in the ON/RUN position from the OFF position.
2
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Driving at speeds 5 mph (8 km/h) and above To Unlock The Doors
disables the system from responding to all RKE transmit- Push and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE
ter buttons for all RKE transmitters.
transmitter once to unlock the driver’s door or twice
within five seconds to unlock all doors. The turn signal
lights will flash to acknowledge the unlock signal. The
illuminated entry system will also turn on.
If the vehicle is equipped with Passive Entry, refer to
“Keyless Enter-N-Go™” under “Things To Know Before
Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
1st Push Of Key Fob Unlocks
Key Fob With RKE Transmitter
This feature lets you program the system to unlock either
the driver’s door or all doors on the first push of the
UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter. To change the
current setting, refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23
If the vehicle is equipped with Passive Entry, refer to
“Keyless Enter-N-Go™” under “Things To Know Before
This feature will cause the turn signal lights to flash when
Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
the doors are locked with the RKE transmitter. This
feature can be turned on or turned off. To change the Sound Horn With Lock
current setting, refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “UnderThis feature will cause the horn to chirp when the doors
standing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
are locked with the RKE transmitter. This feature can be
Headlight Illumination On Approach
turned on or turned off. To change the current setting,
This feature activates the headlights for up to 90 seconds refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your
when the doors are unlocked with the RKE transmitter. Instrument Panel” for further information.
Flash Lights With Lock
The time for this feature is programmable on vehicles To Unlatch The Trunk
equipped through Uconnect®. To change the current
Push the TRUNK button on the RKE transmitter two
setting, refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding
times within five seconds to unlatch the trunk.
Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
If the vehicle is equipped with Passive Entry, refer to
To Lock The Doors
“Keyless Enter-N-Go™” under “Things To Know Before
Push and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmit- Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
ter to lock all doors. The turn signal lights will flash, and
the horn will chirp to acknowledge the signal.
2
24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• You may need to be less than 35 ft (11 m) from the
vehicle when using the RKE transmitter to turn off the
To turn the Panic Alarm feature on or off, push and hold
Panic Alarm due to the radio frequency noises emitted
the PANIC button on the RKE transmitter for at least one
by the system.
second and release. When the Panic Alarm is activated,
the turn signals will flash, the horn will pulse on and off, Programming Additional Transmitters
and the interior lights will turn on.
Programming Key Fobs or RKE transmitters may be
The Panic Alarm will stay on for three minutes unless performed at an authorized dealer.
you turn it off by either pushing the PANIC button a
Transmitter Battery Replacement
second time or drive the vehicle at a speed of 15 MPH
The recommended replacement battery is one CR2032
(24 km/h) or greater.
battery.
NOTE:
NOTE:
• The interior lights will turn off if you place the ignition
in the ACC or ON/RUN position while the Panic • Perchlorate Material — special handling may apply.
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate
Alarm is activated. However, the exterior lights and
horn will remain on.
• Do not touch the battery terminals that are on the back
housing or the printed circuit board.
Using The Panic Alarm
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25
1. Remove the emergency key by sliding the mechanical 2. Insert the tip of the emergency key or a #2 flat blade
latch on the back of the RKE transmitter sideways
screwdriver into the slot and gently pry the two halves
with your thumb and then pull the key out with your
of the RKE transmitter apart. Make sure not to damage
other hand.
the seal during removal.
Emergency Key Removal
Separating The RKE Transmitter Case
2
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
3. Remove the battery by turning the back cover over
(battery facing downward) and tapping it lightly on a
solid surface such as a table or similar, then replace the
battery. When replacing the battery, match the + sign
on the battery to the + sign on the inside of the battery
clip, located on the back cover. Avoid touching the
new battery with your fingers. Skin oils may cause
battery deterioration. If you touch a battery, clean it
with rubbing alcohol.
• This device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
If your RKE transmitter fails to operate from a normal
distance, check for these two conditions:
4. To assemble the RKE transmitter case, snap the two 1. A weak battery in the transmitter. The expected life of
the battery is a minimum of three years.
halves together.
2. Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station
tower, airport transmitter, and some mobile or CB
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
radios.
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
General Information
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27
REMOTE STARTING SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED
How To Use Remote Start
All of the following conditions must be met before the
This system uses the Remote Keyless Entry engine will remote start:
(RKE) transmitter to start the engine conve• Vehicle in PARK
niently from outside the vehicle while still
maintaining security. The system has a range of • Doors closed
approximately 300 ft (91 m).
• Hood closed
NOTE:
• Trunk closed
• The vehicle must be equipped with an automatic
• Hazard switch off
transmission to be equipped with Remote Start.
• Brake switch inactive (brake pedal not pushed)
• Obstructions between the vehicle and RKE transmitter
may reduce this range.
• Battery at an acceptable charge level
• RKE panic button not pushed
2
28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• System not disabled from previous remote start event Remote Start Abort Message
• Vehicle security alarm not active
• Ignition in OFF position
The following messages will display in the instrument
cluster if the vehicle fails to remote start or exits remote
start prematurely:
WARNING!
• Remote Start Aborted — Door Ajar
• Do not start or run an engine in a closed garage or
confined area. Exhaust gas contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which is odorless and colorless. Carbon
Monoxide is poisonous and can cause serious injury or death when inhaled.
• Keep Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitters
away from children. Operation of the Remote Start
System, windows, door locks or other controls
could cause serious injury or death.
• Remote Start Aborted — Hood Ajar
• Remote Start Aborted — Trunk Ajar
• Remote Start Aborted — Fuel Low
• Remote Start Disabled — Start Vehicle To Reset
The instrument cluster message stays active until the
ignition is cycled to the ON/RUN position.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29
• The engine can be started two consecutive times (two
15-minute cycles) with the RKE transmitter. However,
the ignition must be cycled to the RUN position before
Push and release the REMOTE START button on
you can repeat the start sequence for a third cycle.
the RKE transmitter twice within five seconds.
The vehicle doors will lock, parking lights will To Exit Remote Start Mode Without Driving The
flash and the horn will chirp twice (if pro- Vehicle
grammed). Then, the engine will start and the vehicle will
Push and release the REMOTE START button one time or
remain in the Remote Start mode for a 15-minute cycle.
allow the engine to run for the entire 15-minute cycle.
NOTE:
NOTE: To avoid unintentional shutdowns, the system
• If an engine fault is present or fuel level is low, the will disable the one time push of the REMOTE START
vehicle will start and then shut down in 10 seconds. button for two seconds after receiving a valid Remote
Start request.
• The park lamps will turn on and remain on during
Remote Start mode.
To Enter Remote Start Mode
• For security, power window and power sunroof operation (if equipped) are disabled when the vehicle is
in the Remote Start mode.
2
30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To Exit Remote Start Mode And Drive The Vehicle
Before the end of 15-minute cycle, push and release the
UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter to unlock the
doors and disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm (if
equipped). Then, prior to the end of the 15-minute cycle,
push and release the START/STOP button.
NOTE: The message “Push Start Button” will display in
the DID until you push the START button.
DOOR LOCKS
Manual Door Locks
To lock each door, push the door lock knob on each door
trim panel downward. To unlock the front doors, pull the
inside door handle to the first detent. To unlock the rear
doors, pull the door lock knob on the door trim panel
upward.
Door Lock Knob
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31
If the door lock knob is down when you shut the door,
the door will lock. Therefore, make sure the Key Fob is
not inside the vehicle before closing the door.
WARNING!
• For personal security and safety in the event of a
collision, lock the vehicle doors before you drive as
well as when you park and leave the vehicle.
• When leaving the vehicle, always make sure the
keyless ignition node is in the “OFF” mode, remove the Key Fob from the vehicle and lock your
vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children, and do not
leave the ignition of a vehicle equipped with
Keyless Enter-N-Go™ in the ACC or ON/RUN
mode. A child could operate power windows, other
controls, or move the vehicle.
2
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The doors can also be locked and unlocked with the
A power door lock switch is on each front door trim Keyless Enter-N-Go™ (Passive Entry) system. For further
information, refer to “Keyless Enter-N-Go™” under
panel. Use this switch to lock or unlock the doors.
“Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for
further information.
Power Door Locks
If you push the power door lock switch while the ignition
is in the ACC or ON/RUN position, and any front door
is open, the power locks will not operate. This prevents
you from accidentally locking the Key Fob in the vehicle.
Placing the ignition in the OFF position or closing the
door will allow the locks to operate. If a door is open, and
the ignition is in the ACC or ON/RUN position, a chime
will sound as a reminder to remove the Key Fob.
Power Door Lock Switch
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33
Automatic Door Locks — If Equipped
3. The driver door is opened.
The auto door lock feature default condition is enabled.
When enabled, the door locks will lock automatically
when the vehicle’s speed exceeds 15 mph (24 km/h). The
auto door lock feature can be enabled or disabled by your
authorized dealer per written request of the customer.
Please see your authorized dealer for service.
4. The doors were not previously unlocked.
Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit Programming
To change the current setting, refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
NOTE: Use the Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature
The doors will unlock automatically on vehicles with in accordance with local laws.
power door locks if:
Child-Protection Door Lock System — Rear
1. The Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature is en- Doors
To provide a safer environment for small children riding
abled.
in the rear seats, the rear doors are equipped with
2. The vehicle was in motion, then speed returned to
Child-Protection Door Lock system.
0 mph (0 km/h) and the transmission is placed in
PARK.
Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit
2
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To Engage Or Disengage The Child-Protection
Door Lock System
1. Open the rear door.
2. Insert the tip of the emergency key into the lock and
rotate to the LOCK or UNLOCK position.
3. Repeat steps 1 and 2 for the opposite rear door.
Child-Protection Door Lock Function
WARNING!
Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in a collision.
Remember that the rear doors can only be opened
from the outside when the Child-Protection locks are
engaged (locked).
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35
NOTE: For emergency exit from the rear seats when the • If wearing gloves on your hands, or if it has been
raining on the Passive Entry door handle, the unlock
Child-Protection Door Lock System is engaged, manually
sensitivity can be affected, resulting in a slower reraise the door lock knob to the unlocked position, roll
sponse time.
down the window, and open the door using the outside
door handle.
• If the vehicle is unlocked by the Passive Entry Door
Handle and no door goes ajar within 60 seconds, the
KEYLESS ENTER-N-GO™
vehicle will re-lock and if equipped will arm the
The Passive Entry system is an enhancement to the
security alarm.
vehicle’s Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system and a
feature of Keyless Enter-N-Go™ . This feature allows you To Unlock From The Driver’s Side
to lock and unlock the vehicle’s door(s) without having to With a valid Passive Entry RKE transmitter within 5 ft
push the RKE transmitter lock or unlock buttons.
(1.5 m) of the driver’s door handle, grab the front driver
door handle to unlock the driver’s door automatically.
The interior door panel lock knob will raise when the
• Passive Entry may be programmed ON/OFF. Refer to door is unlocked.
“Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE:
2
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To Unlock From The Passenger Side
With a valid Passive Entry RKE transmitter within 5 ft
(1.5 m) of the passenger door handle, grab the front
passenger door handle to unlock all four doors automatically. The interior door panel lock knob will raise when
the door is unlocked.
NOTE: All doors will unlock when the front passenger
door handle is grabbed regardless of the driver’s door
unlock preference setting (“Unlock Driver Door 1st
Press” or “Unlock All Doors 1st Press”).
Grab The Door Handle To Unlock
NOTE: If “Unlock All Doors 1st Press” is programmed,
all doors will unlock when you grab hold of the front
driver’s door handle. To select between “Unlock Driver
Door 1st Press” and “Unlock All Doors 1st Press,” refer to
“Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
Preventing Inadvertent Locking Of Passive Entry RKE
Transmitter In Vehicle
To minimize the possibility of unintentionally locking a
Passive Entry RKE transmitter inside your vehicle, the
Passive Entry system is equipped with an automatic door
unlock feature which will function if the ignition switch
is in the OFF position.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37
FOBIK-Safe only executes in vehicles with passive entry. NOTE: The vehicle will only unlock the doors when the
There are three situations that trigger a FOBIK-Safe doors are locked using the door panel switch, a valid
search in any passive entry vehicle.
Passive Entry RKE transmitter is detected inside the
vehicle, and no valid Passive Entry RKE transmitter is
1. A lock request is made by a valid Passive Entry RKE
detected outside the vehicle. The vehicle will not unlock
transmitter while a door is ajar.
the doors when any of the following conditions are true:
2. A lock request is made by the Passive Entry door
• The doors are locked manually using the door lock
handle while a door is ajar.
knobs.
3. A lock request is made by the door panel switch while
• There is a valid Passive Entry RKE transmitter outside
the door is ajar.
the vehicle and within 5 ft (1.5 m) of either Passive
When any of these situations occur, after all ajar doors are
Entry door handle.
shut, the FOBIK-Safe search will be executed. If it finds a
• Three attempts are made to lock the doors using the
Passive Entry RKE transmitter inside the car and it does
door panel switch and then close the doors.
not find any Passive Entry RKE transmitters outside the
car, then the car will unlock and alert the customer.
2
38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If you inadvertently leave your vehicle’s Passive
Entry RKE transmitter in the trunk and try to close the
With a valid Passive Entry RKE transmitter within 3 ft
deck lid, the deck lid will automatically unlatch, unless
(1.0 m) of the deck lid, push the button on the right side
another one of the vehicle’s Passive Entry RKE transmitof CHMSL (Center High Mounted Stop Light), which is
ters is outside the vehicle and within 3 ft (1.0 m) of the
located on the deck lid.
deck lid.
To Enter The Trunk
To Lock The Vehicle’s Doors
With one of the vehicle’s Passive Entry RKE transmitters
within 5 ft (1.5 m) of the driver or passenger front door
handles, push the door handle LOCK button to lock all
four doors.
Trunk Passive Entry Button
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39
Do NOT grab the door handle when pushing the door
handle lock button. This could unlock the door(s).
2
Push The Door Handle Button To Lock
Do NOT Grab The Door Handle When Locking
40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
WINDOWS
• After pushing the door handle button, you must wait Power Windows
two seconds before you can lock or unlock the doors, The window controls on the driver’s door control all the
using either Passive Entry door handle. This is done to door windows.
allow you to check if the vehicle is locked by pulling
the door handle, without the vehicle reacting and
unlocking.
• The Passive Entry system will not operate if the RKE
transmitter battery is dead.
The vehicle doors can also be locked by using the RKE
transmitter lock button or the lock button located on the
vehicle’s interior door panel.
Power Window Switches
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41
There are single window controls on each passenger door
trim panel, which operate the passenger door windows.
The window controls will operate only when the ignition
is in the ACC or ON/RUN position.
WARNING! (Continued)
ignition of a vehicle equipped with Keyless Enter-NGo™ in the ACC or ON/RUN mode. Occupants,
particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by the windows while operating the power
window switches. Such entrapment may result in
serious injury or death.
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with the Uconnect®, the
power window switches will remain active for up to 10
minutes after the ignition is placed in the OFF position.
Opening either front door will cancel this feature. The
time is programmable. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in AUTO-Down Feature
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further inThe driver door power window switch and some model
formation.
passenger door power window switches have an AUTOdown feature. Push the window switch to the second
WARNING!
detent, release, and the window will go down automatiNever leave children unattended in a vehicle, and do cally.
not let children play with power windows. Do not To open the window part way, push the window switch
leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or in a to the first detent and release it when you want the
location accessible to children, and do not leave the window to stop.
(Continued)
2
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To stop the window from going all the way down during • Any impact due to rough road conditions may trigger
the auto-reverse function unexpectedly during autothe AUTO-down operation, pull up on the switch briefly.
closure. If this happens, pull the switch lightly to the
AUTO-Up Feature With Anti-Pinch Protection — If
first detent and hold to close the window manually.
Equipped
Lift the window switch to the second detent, release, and
the window will go up automatically.
To stop the window from going all the way up during the
AUTO-up operation, push down on the switch briefly.
WARNING!
There is no anti-pinch protection when the window
is almost closed. Be sure to clear all objects from the
window before closing.
To close the window part way, lift the window switch to
Reset Auto-Up
the first detent and release it when you want the window
Should the Auto Up feature stop working, the window
to stop.
may need to be reset. To reset Auto Up:
NOTE:
1. Make sure the door is fully closed.
• If the window runs into any obstacle during autoclosure, it will reverse direction and then go back 2. Pull the window switch up to close the window
completely and continue to hold the switch up for an
down. Remove the obstacle and use the window
additional two seconds after the window is closed.
switch again to close the window.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43
3. Push the window switch down firmly to the second
detent to open the window completely and continue
to hold the switch down for an additional two seconds
after the window is fully open.
2
Window Lockout Switch
The window lockout switch on the driver’s door trim
panel allows you to disable the window controls on the
rear passenger doors and the rear sunscreen (if
equipped). To disable the window controls and the rear
sunscreen, push and release the window lockout button
(setting it in the DOWN position). To enable the window
controls and the rear sunscreen, push and release the
window lockout button again (setting it in the UP
position).
Window Lockout Switch
44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the rear windows open, then open the front and rear
windows together to minimize the buffeting. If the
buffeting occurs with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to minimize the buffeting.
TRUNK LOCK AND RELEASE
Trunk Release
Button
The trunk lid can be released from
outside the vehicle by pushing the
TRUNK button on the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
twice within five seconds or by
using the external release switch
located on the underside of the
decklid overhang. The release feature will function only when the
vehicle is in the unlock condition.
With the ignition in the ON/RUN position, the Trunk
Open symbol will display in the instrument cluster
indicating that the trunk is open. The odometer display
will reappear once the trunk is closed.
The trunk lid can be released from inside the vehicle by
pushing the TRUNK RELEASE button located on the
With the ignition in the OFF position, the Trunk Open
instrument panel to the left of the steering wheel.
symbol will display until the trunk is closed.
NOTE: The transmission must be in PARK before the
button will operate.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45
Refer to “Keyless Enter-N-Go™” in “Things To Know Trunk Emergency Release
Before Starting Your Vehicle” for more information on As a security measure, a Trunk Internal Emergency Release
trunk operation with the Passive Entry feature.
lever is built into the trunk latching mechanism. In the event
of an individual being locked inside the trunk, the trunk can
TRUNK SAFETY WARNING
be simply opened by pulling on the glow-in-the-dark handle
attached to the trunk latching mechanism.
WARNING!
Do not allow children to have access to the trunk,
either by climbing into the trunk from outside, or
through the inside of the vehicle. Always close the
trunk lid when your vehicle is unattended. Once in
the trunk, young children may not be able to escape,
even if they entered through the rear seat. If trapped
in the trunk, children can die from suffocation or
heat stroke.
Trunk Emergency Internal Release
2
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the
risk of harm from a deploying air bag:
Some of the most important safety features in your
vehicle are the restraint systems:
1. Children 12 years old and under should always ride
buckled up in a vehicle with a rear seat.
• Seat Belt Systems
2. If a child from 2 to 12 years old (not in a rear-facing
• Supplemental Restraint Systems (SRS) Air Bags
child restraint) must ride in the front passenger seat,
• Child Restraints
move the seat as far back as possible and use the
proper child restraint. (Refer to “Child Restraints”)
Important Safety Precautions
Please pay close attention to the information in this 3. Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle seat
belt properly (Refer to ⬙Child Restraints⬙) should be
section. It tells you how to use your restraint system
secured in a vehicle with a rear seat in child restraints or
properly, to keep you and your passengers as safe as
belt-positioning booster seats. Older children who do
possible.
not use child restraints or belt-positioning booster seats
should ride properly buckled up in a vehicle with a rear
seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47
4. Never allow children to slide the shoulder belt behind 9. If the air bag system in this vehicle needs to be
them or under their arm.
modified to accommodate a disabled person, contact
the Customer Center. Phone numbers are provided
5. You should read the instructions provided with your
under ⬙If You Need Assistance.⬙
child restraint to make sure that you are using it
properly.
WARNING!
6. All occupants should always wear their lap and
shoulder belts properly.
7. The driver and front passenger seats should be moved
back as far as practical to allow the Advanced Front
Air Bags room to inflate.
8. Do not lean against the door or window. If your
vehicle has side air bags, and deployment occurs, the
side air bags will inflate forcefully into the space
between you and the door and you could be injured.
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
2
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
belts. The feature is active whenever the ignition is in
the START or ON/RUN position. If the driver or
Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even
outboard front seat passenger is unbelted, the Seat Belt
on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver
Reminder Light will turn on and remain on until both
and could cause a collision that includes you. This can
outboard front seat belts are buckled.
happen far away from home or on your own street.
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they The BeltAlert warning sequence begins after the vehicle
can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some speed is over 5 MPH (8 km/h) by blinking the Seat Belt
of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown Reminder Light and sounding an intermittent chime.
from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of Once the sequence starts, it will continue for the entire
ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the duration or until the respective seat belts are buckled.
inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should After the sequence completes, the Seat Belt Reminder
Light remains illuminated until the respective seat belts
be belted at all times.
are buckled. The driver should instruct all other occuEnhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
pants to buckle their seat belts. If an outboard front seat
(BeltAlert)
belt is unbuckled while traveling at speeds greater than
BeltAlert is a feature intended to remind the driver 5 MPH (8 km/h), BeltAlert will provide both audio and
and outboard front passenger (if equipped with out- visual notification.
board front passenger BeltAlert) to buckle their seat
Seat Belt Systems
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49
The outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert is not active
when the outboard front passenger seat is unoccupied.
BeltAlert may be triggered when an animal or heavy
object is on the outboard front passenger seat or when the
seat is folded flat (if equipped). It is recommended that
pets be restrained in the rear seat (if equipped) in pet
harnesses or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts,
and cargo is properly stowed.
Lap/Shoulder Belts
All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped with
lap/shoulder belts.
The seat belt webbing retractor will lock only during very
sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the shoulder part of the seat belt to move freely with you under
normal conditions. However, in a collision the seat belt
will lock and reduce your risk of striking the inside of the
BeltAlert can be activated or deactivated by your autho- vehicle or being thrown out of the vehicle.
rized dealer. Chrysler Group LLC does not recommend
deactivating BeltAlert.
NOTE: If BeltAlert has been deactivated, the Seat Belt
Reminder Light will continue to illuminate while the
driver’s or outboard front passenger’s (if equipped with
BeltAlert) seat belt remains unbuckled.
2
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, the air bags won’t deploy at all.
Always wear your seat belt even though you have
air bags.
• In a collision, you and your passengers can suffer
much greater injuries if you are not properly buckled up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle or
other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the
vehicle. Always be sure you and others in your
vehicle are buckled up properly.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
• Wearing your seat belt incorrectly could make your
injuries in a collision much worse. You might
suffer internal injuries, or you could even slide out
of the seat belt. Follow these instructions to wear
your seat belt safely and to keep your passengers
safe, too.
• Two people should never be belted into a single
seat belt. People belted together can crash into one
another in a collision, hurting one another badly.
Never use a lap/shoulder belt or a lap belt for more
than one person, no matter what their size.
(Continued)
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of
injury in a collision. The seat belt forces won’t be at
the strong hip and pelvic bones, but across your
abdomen. Always wear the lap part of your seat
belt as low as possible and keep it snug.
• A twisted seat belt may not protect you properly. In
a collision, it could even cut into you. Be sure the
seat belt is flat against your body, without twists. If
you can’t straighten a seat belt in your vehicle, take
it to your authorized dealer immediately and have
it fixed.
• A seat belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle
will not protect you properly. The lap portion could
ride too high on your body, possibly causing internal injuries. Always buckle your seat belt into the
buckle nearest you.
• A seat belt that is too loose will not protect you
properly. In a sudden stop, you could move too far
forward, increasing the possibility of injury. Wear
your seat belt snugly.
• A seat belt that is worn under your arm is dangerous.
Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the
vehicle in a collision, increasing head and neck injury.
A seat belt worn under the arm can cause internal
injuries. Ribs aren’t as strong as shoulder bones. Wear
the seat belt over your shoulder so that your strongest
bones will take the force in a collision.
• A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect
you from injury during a collision. You are more
likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not
wear your shoulder belt. The lap and shoulder belt
are meant to be used together.
(Continued)
(Continued)
2
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• A frayed or torn seat belt could rip apart in a
collision and leave you with no protection. Inspect
the seat belt system periodically, checking for cuts,
frays, or loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify
the seat belt system. Seat belt assemblies must be
replaced after a collision.
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions
1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and
adjust the front seat.
Pulling Out The Latch Plate
3. When the belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch
2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front
plate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”
seat, and next to your arm in the rear seat (for vehicles
equipped with a rear seat). Grasp the latch plate and
pull out the seat belt. Slide the latch plate up the
webbing as far as necessary to allow the seat belt to go
around your lap.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53
2
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle
Positioning The Lap Belt
4. Position the lap belt so that it is snug and lies low
across your hips, below your abdomen. To remove
slack in the lap belt portion, pull up on the shoulder
belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is too tight, tilt the latch
plate and pull on the lap belt. A snug seat belt reduces
the risk of sliding under the seat belt in a collision.
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
5. Position the shoulder belt across the shoulder and 3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing.
chest with minimal, if any slack so that it is comfortThe folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of
able and not resting on your neck. The retractor will
the latch plate.
withdraw any slack in the shoulder belt.
4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the
6. To release the belt, push the red button on the buckle.
folded webbing and the seat belt is no longer twisted.
The seat belt will automatically retract to its stowed
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage
position. If necessary, slide the latch plate down the
In the driver and front passenger seats, the top of the
webbing to allow the seat belt to retract fully.
shoulder belt can be adjusted upward or downward to
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
position the seat belt away from your neck. Push or
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/ squeeze the anchorage button to release the anchorage,
shoulder belt.
and move it up or down to the position that serves you
best.
1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to the
anchor point.
2. At about 6 to 12 inches (15 to 30 cm) above the latch plate,
grasp and twist the seat belt webbing 180° to create a fold
that begins immediately above the latch plate.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55
NOTE: The adjustable upper shoulder belt anchorage is
equipped with an Easy Up feature. This feature allows
the shoulder belt anchorage to be adjusted in the upward
position without pushing or squeezing the release button. To verify the shoulder belt anchorage is latched, pull
downward on the shoulder belt anchorage until it is
locked into position.
Seat Belt Extender
Adjustable Anchorage
As a guide, if you are shorter than average, you will
prefer the shoulder belt anchorage in a lower position,
and if you are taller than average, you will prefer the
shoulder belt anchorage in a higher position. After you
release the anchorage button, try to move it up or down
to make sure that it is locked in position.
If a seat belt is not long enough to fit properly, even when
the webbing is fully extended and the adjustable upper
shoulder belt anchorage (if equipped) is in its lowest
position, your authorized dealer can provide you with a
Seat Belt Extender. The Seat Belt Extender should be used
only if the existing seat belt is not long enough. When the
Seat Belt Extender is not required for a different occupant, it must be removed.
2
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• ONLY use a Seat Belt Extender if it is physically
required in order to properly fit the original seat
belt system. DO NOT USE the Seat Belt Extender
if, when worn, the distance between the front edge
of the Seat Belt Extender buckle and the center of
the occupant’s body is LESS than 6 inches.
• Using a Seat Belt Extender when not needed can
increase the risk of serious injury or death in a
collision. Only use the Seat Belt Extender when the
lap belt is not long enough and only use in the
recommended seating positions. Remove and store
the Seat Belt Extender when not needed.
Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the seat belt
across the thighs and as snug across the hips as possible.
Keep the seat belt low so that it does not come across the
abdomen. That way the strong bones of the hips will take
the force if there is a collision.
Seat Belt Pretensioner
The front seat belt system is equipped with pretensioning
devices that are designed to remove slack from the seat
belt in the event of a collision. These devices may
improve the performance of the seat belt by removing
slack from the seat belt early in a collision. Pretensioners
work for all size occupants, including those in child
restraints.
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat
belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be
We recommend that pregnant women use the seat belts worn snugly and positioned properly.
throughout their pregnancy. Keeping the mother safe is
the best way to keep the baby safe.
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57
The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Like the air bags, the pretensioners are single use items. A deployed pretensioner or
a deployed air bag must be replaced immediately.
Energy Management Feature
This vehicle has a seat belt system with an Energy Management feature in the front seating positions that may help
further reduce the risk of injury in the event of a collision.
This seat belt system has a retractor assembly that is
designed to release webbing in a controlled manner.
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) — If Equipped
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions may be • ALR = Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
equipped with Switchable Automatic Locking Retractors
(ALR) which are used to secure a child restraint system.
For additional information, refer to “Installing Child
Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat Belt” under the “Child
Restraints” section of this manual. The table below
defines the type of feature for each seating position.
2
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If the passenger seating position is equipped with an seating position that has a seat belt with this feature.
ALR and is being used for normal usage, only pull the Children 12 years old and under should always be
seat belt webbing out far enough to comfortably wrap properly restrained in a vehicle with a rear seat.
around the occupant’s mid-section so as to not activate
the ALR. If the ALR is activated, you will hear a ratchWARNING!
eting sound as the seat belt retracts. Allow the webbing to
retract completely in this case and then carefully pull out • Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
only the amount of webbing necessary to comfortably
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
wrap around the occupant’s mid-section. Slide the latch
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearplate into the buckle until you hear a ⬙click.⬙
facing child restraint.
In Automatic Locking Mode, the shoulder belt is auto- • Only use rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
matically pre locked. The seat belt will still retract to
with a rear seat.
remove any slack in the shoulder belt. Use the Automatic
Locking Mode anytime a child restraint is installed in a
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59
How To Engage The Automatic Locking Mode
1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt.
2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until
the entire seat belt is extracted.
3. Allow the seat belt to retract. As the seat belt retracts,
you will hear a clicking sound. This indicates the seat
belt is now in the Automatic Locking Mode.
How To Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it
to retract completely to disengage the Automatic Locking
Mode and activate the vehicle sensitive (emergency)
locking mode.
WARNING!
• The seat belt assembly must be replaced if the
switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) feature or any other seat belt function is not working
properly when checked according to the procedures in the Service Manual.
• Failure to replace the seat belt assembly could
increase the risk of injury in collisions.
• Do not use the Automatic Locking Mode to restrain
occupants who are wearing the seat belt or children
who are using booster seats. The locked mode is
only used to install rear-facing or forward-facing
child restraints that have a harness for restraining
the child.
2
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
• Front and Side Impact Sensors
Air Bag System Components
• Seat Belt Pretenioners
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following air bag • Seat Belt Buckle Switch
system components:
• Seat Track Position Sensors
• Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
Advanced Front Air Bags
• Air Bag Warning Light
This vehicle has Advanced Front Air Bags for both the
• Steering Wheel and Column
driver and front passenger as a supplement to the seat
belt restraint systems. The driver’s Advanced Front Air
• Instrument Panel
Bag is mounted in the center of the steering wheel. The
• Knee Impact Bolsters
passenger’s Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the
instrument panel, above the glove compartment. The
• Advanced Front Air Bags
words “SRS AIRBAG” or “AIRBAG” are embossed on
• Supplemental Side Air Bags
the air bag covers.
• Supplemental Knee Air Bags
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61
WARNING!
Advanced Front Air Bag And Knee Bolster Locations
1 — Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags
2 — Passenger Knee Impact Bolster
3 — Supplemental Driver Side Knee Air Bag/Knee Bolster
• Being too close to the steering wheel or instrument
panel during Advanced Front Air Bag deployment
could cause serious injury, including death. Air
bags need room to inflate. Sit back, comfortably
extending your arms to reach the steering wheel or
instrument panel.
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
2
62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
the driver or front passenger seat belt is buckled. The seat
belt buckle switch may adjust the inflation rate of the
The Advanced Front Air Bag system has multistage
Advanced Front Air Bags.
driver and front passenger air bags. This system provides
output appropriate to the severity and type of collision as
WARNING!
determined by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC),
which may receive information from the front impact • No objects should be placed over or near the air
sensors or other system components.
bag on the instrument panel or steering wheel,
Advanced Front Air Bag Features
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately during an
impact that requires air bag deployment. A low energy
output is used in less severe collisions. A higher energy
output is used for more severe collisions.
This vehicle may be equipped with driver and/or front
passenger seat track position sensors that may adjust the
inflation rate of the Advanced Front Air Bags based upon
seat position.
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or front
passenger seat belt buckle switch that detects whether
because any such objects could cause harm if the
vehicle is in a collision severe enough to cause the
air bags to inflate.
• Do not put anything on or around the air bag
covers or attempt to open them manually. You may
damage the air bags and you could be injured
because the air bags may no longer be functional.
The protective covers for the air bag cushions are
designed to open only when the air bags are
inflating.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63
WARNING! (Continued)
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, air bags won’t deploy at all. Always wear your seat belts even though you have air
bags.
Advanced Front Air Bag Operation
Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to provide additional protection by supplementing the seat belts. Advanced Front Air Bags are not expected to reduce the risk
of injury in rear, side, or rollover collisions. The Advanced Front Air Bags will not deploy in all frontal
collisions, including some that may produce substantial
vehicle damage — for example, some pole collisions,
truck underrides, and angle offset collisions.
On the other hand, depending on the type and location of
impact, Advanced Front Air Bags may deploy in crashes
with little vehicle front-end damage but that produce a
severe initial deceleration.
Because air bag sensors measure vehicle deceleration
over time, vehicle speed and damage by themselves are
not good indicators of whether or not an air bag should
have deployed.
Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all collisions, and also are needed to help keep you in position,
away from an inflating air bag.
When the ORC detects a collision requiring the Advanced Front Air Bags, it signals the inflator units. A large
quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the
Advanced Front Air Bags.
2
64 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The steering wheel hub trim cover and the upper right
side of the instrument panel separate and fold out of the
way as the air bags inflate to their full size. The Advanced
Front Air Bags fully inflate in less time than it takes to
blink your eyes. The air bags then quickly deflate while
helping to restrain the driver and front passenger.
Knee Impact Bolsters
Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
This vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Driver
Knee Air Bag mounted in the instrument panel below the
steering column. The Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
provides enhanced protection during a frontal impact by
working together with the seat belts, pretensioners, and
Advanced Front Air Bags.
The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees of the Supplemental Side Air Bags
driver and front passenger, and position the front occupants
for improved interaction with the Advanced Front Air Bags. Your vehicle is equipped with two types of side air bags:
1. Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SABs):
WARNING!
Located in the outboard side of the front seats. The
SABs are marked with a “SRS AIRBAG” or “AIRBAG”
• Do not drill, cut, or tamper with the knee impact
label sewn into the outboard side of the seats.
bolsters in any way.
• Do not mount any accessories to the knee impact
bolsters such as alarm lights, stereos, citizen band
radios, etc.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65
When the SAB deploys, it opens the seam on the outboard side of the seatback’s trim cover. The inflating SAB
deploys through the seat seam into the space between the
occupant and the door. The SAB moves at a very high
speed and with such a high force that it could injure you
if you are not seated properly, or if items are positioned
in the area where the SAB inflates. Children are at an
even greater risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
WARNING!
Front Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag Label
The SABs may help to reduce the risk of occupant injury
during certain side impact and certain rollover events, in
addition to the injury reduction potential provided by the
seat belts and body structure.
Do not use accessory seat covers or place objects
between you and the Side Air Bags; the performance
could be adversely affected and/or objects could be
pushed into you, causing serious injury.
2
66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2. Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains
(SABICs): Located above the side windows. The trim
covering the SABICs is labeled “SRS AIRBAG” or
“AIRBAG.”
SABICs may help reduce the risk of head injury to front
and rear seat outboard occupants. SABICs may reduce
the risk of injuries in certain side impact and vehicle
rollover events, in addition to the injury reduction potential provided by the seat belts and body structure.
The SABICs deploy downward, covering the side windows. An inflating SABIC pushes the outside edge of the
trim out of the way and covers the window. The SABICs
inflate with enough force to injure you if you are not
belted and seated properly, or if items are positioned in
the area where the SABICs inflate. Children are at an
even greater risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
The SABICs may help reduce the risk of partial or
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side
windows in certain rollover or side impact events.
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain (SABIC)
Label Location
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67
WARNING!
• Your vehicle is equipped with left and right Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABICs).
Do not stack luggage or other cargo up high enough
to block the deployment of the SABICs. The trim
covering above the side windows where the SABIC
and its deployment path are located should remain
free from any obstructions.
• Your vehicle is equipped with SABICs. In order for
the SABICs to work as intended, do not install any
accessory items in your vehicle which could alter
the roof. Do not add an aftermarket sunroof to your
vehicle. Do not add roof racks that require permanent attachments (bolts or screws) for installation
on the vehicle roof. Do not drill into the roof of the
vehicle for any reason.
The SABICs and SABs (“Side Air Bags”) are designed to
activate in certain side impacts and certain rollover
events. The Occupant Restraint Controller (“ORC”) determines whether the deployment of the Side Air Bags in
a particular side impact or rollover event is appropriate,
based on the severity and type of collision. Vehicle
damage by itself is not a good indicator of whether or not
Side Air Bags should have deployed.
Side Air Bags are a supplement to the seat belt restraint
system. Side Air Bags deploy in less time than it takes to
blink your eyes. Occupants, including children, who are
up against or very close to Side Air Bags can be seriously
injured or killed. Occupants, including children, should
never lean on or sleep against the door, side windows, or
area where the Side Air Bags inflate, even if they are in an
infant or child restraint.
2
68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Seat belts (and child restraints where appropriate) are
necessary for your protection in all collisions. They also
help keep you in position, away from inflating Side Air
Bags. To get the best protection from the Side Air Bags,
occupants must wear their seat belts properly and sit
upright with their backs against the seats. Children must
be properly restrained in a child restraint or booster seat
that is appropriate for the size of the child.
WARNING! (Continued)
• Relying on the Side Air Bags alone could lead to
more severe injuries in a collision. The Side Air
Bags work with your seat belt to restrain you
properly. In some collisions, Side Air Bags won’t
deploy at all. Always wear your seat belt even
though you have Side Air Bags.
NOTE: Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior
trim, but they will open during air bag deployment.
WARNING!
• Side Air Bags need room to inflate. Do not lean
against the door or window. Sit upright in the
center of the seat.
• Being too close to the Side Air Bags during deployment could cause you to be severely injured or
killed.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69
Side Impacts
Rollover Events
In side impacts, the side impact sensors aid the ORC in
determining the appropriate response to impact events.
The system is calibrated to deploy the Side Air Bags on
the impact side of the vehicle during impacts that require
Side Air Bag occupant protection. In side impacts, the
Side Air Bags deploy independently; a left side impact
deploys the left Side Air Bags only and a right side
impact deploys the right Side Air Bags only.
Side Air Bags are designed to activate in certain rollover
events. The ORC determines whether the deployment of
the Side Air Bags in a particular rollover event is appropriate, based on the severity and type of collision. Vehicle
damage by itself is not a good indicator of whether or not
Side Air Bags should have deployed.
The Side Air Bags will not deploy in all side collisions,
including some collisions at certain angles, or some side
collisions that do not impact the area of the passenger
compartment. The Side Air Bags may deploy during
angled or offset frontal collisions where the Advanced
Front Air Bags deploy.
The Side Air Bags will not deploy in all rollover events.
The rollover sensing-system determines if a rollover
event may be in progress and whether deployment is
appropriate. A slower-developing event may deploy the
seat belt pretensioners on both sides of the vehicle. A
faster-developing event may deploy the seat belt pretensioners as well as the SABs and SABICs on both sides of
the vehicle. The rollover sensing-system may also deploy
the seat belt pretensioners, with or without the SABs and
SABICs, on both sides of the vehicle if the vehicle
experiences a near rollover event.
2
70 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If A Deployment Occurs
The Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to deflate
immediately after deployment.
NOTE: Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all
collisions. This does not mean something is wrong with
the air bag system.
If you do have a collision, which deploys the air bags, any
or all of the following may occur:
• As the air bags deflate, you may see some smoke-like
particles. The particles are a normal by-product of the
process that generates the non-toxic gas used for air
bag inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the
skin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye
irritation, rinse the area with cool water. For nose or
throat irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation
continues, see your doctor. If these particles settle on
your clothing, follow the garment manufacturer’s instructions for cleaning.
• The air bag material may sometimes cause abrasions
Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have deand/or skin reddening to the occupants as the air bags
ployed. If you are involved in another collision, the air
deploy and unfold. The abrasions are similar to fricbags will not be in place to protect you.
tion rope burns or those you might get sliding along a
carpet or gymnasium floor. They are not caused by
contact with chemicals. They are not permanent and
normally heal quickly. However, if you haven’t healed
significantly within a few days, or if you have any
blistering, see your doctor immediately.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 71
WARNING!
Deployed air bags and seat belt pretensioners cannot
protect you in another collision. Have the air bags,
seat belt pretensioners, and the seat belt retractor
assemblies replaced by an authorized dealer immediately. Also, have the Occupant Restraint Controller
System serviced as well.
NOTE:
Enhanced Accident Response System
In the event of an impact, if the communication network
remains intact, and the power remains intact, depending
on the nature of the event, the ORC will determine
whether to have the Enhanced Accident Response System perform the following functions:
• Cut off fuel to the engine.
• Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or
until the ignition is placed in the “OFF” position.
• Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim,
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as
but they will open during air bag deployment.
the battery has power or until the ignition is placed in
• After any collision, the vehicle should be taken to an
the “OFF” position.
authorized dealer immediately.
• Unlock the doors automatically.
2
72 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The ORC contains a backup power supply system that
may deploy the air bags even if the battery loses power or
In order to reset the Enhanced Accident Response System
it becomes disconnected prior to deployment.
functions after an event, the ignition must be changed
from ignition START or ON/RUN to ignition OFF.
The ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning Light in the
instrument panel for approximately four to eight seconds
Air Bag Warning Light
for a self-check when the ignition is first placed in the
ON/RUN position. After the self-check, the Air Bag
The air bags must be ready to inflate for your Warning Light will turn off. If the ORC detects a malprotection in a collision. The Occupant Re- function in any part of the system, it turns on the Air Bag
straint Controller (ORC) monitors the internal Warning Light, either momentarily or continuously. A
circuits and interconnecting wiring associated single chime will sound to alert you if the light comes on
with air bag system electrical components.
again after initial startup.
System Reset Procedure
The ORC monitors the readiness of the electronic parts of
the air bag system whenever the ignition is in the START
or ON/RUN position. If the ignition is in the OFF
position or in the ACC position, the air bag system is not
on and the air bags will not inflate.
The ORC also includes diagnostics that will illuminate
the instrument panel Air Bag Warning Light if a malfunction is detected that could affect the air bag system. The
diagnostics also record the nature of the malfunction.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 73
While the air bag system is designed to be maintenance
free, if any of the following occurs, have an authorized
dealer service the air bag system immediately.
• The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on during
the four to eight seconds when the ignition is first
placed in the ON/RUN position.
• The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the four to
eight-second interval.
WARNING!
Ignoring the Air Bag Warning Light in your instrument
panel could mean you won’t have the air bags to
protect you in a collision. If the light does not come on
as a bulb check when the ignition is first placed in the
on position, and stays on after you start the vehicle, or
if it comes on as you drive, have an authorized dealer
service the air bag system immediately.
• The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or Redundant Air Bag Warning Light
remains on while driving.
If a fault with the Air Bag Warning Light is
NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer, or any engine
detected, which could affect the Supplemental
related gauges are not working, the Occupant Restraint
Restraint System (“SRS”), the Redundant Air
Controller (ORC) may also be disabled. In this condition
Bag Warning Light will illuminate on the inthe air bags may not be ready to inflate for your protec- strument panel. The Redundant Air Bag Warning Light
tion. Have an authorized dealer service the air bag will stay on until the fault is cleared. In addition, a single
system immediately.
chime will sound to alert you that the Redundant Air Bag
Warning Light has come on and a fault has been detected.
2
74 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If the Redundant Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or remains on while driving have an authorized
dealer service the vehicle immediately. For additional information regarding the Redundant Air Bag Warning Light
refer to the “Instrument Panel” section of this manual.
Maintaining Your Air Bag System
WARNING!
• Modifications to any part of the air bag system
could cause it to fail when you need it. You could
be injured if the air bag system is not there to
protect you. Do not modify the components or
wiring, including adding any kind of badges or
stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or the
upper right side of the instrument panel. Do not
modify the front bumper, vehicle body structure, or
add aftermarket side steps or running boards.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the air
bag system yourself. Be sure to tell anyone who
works on your vehicle that it has an air bag system.
• Do not attempt to modify any part of your air bag
system. The air bag may inflate accidentally or may
not function properly if modifications are made.
Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any
air bag system service. If your seat, including your
trim cover and cushion, needs to be serviced in any
way (including removal or loosening/tightening of
seat attachment bolts), take the vehicle to your
authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approved
seat accessories may be used. If it is necessary to
modify the air bag system for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 75
These data can help provide a better understanding of
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
(EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a
certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by
bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will the EDR under normal driving conditions and no perassist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems per- sonal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location)
formed. The EDR is designed to record data related to are recorded. However, other parties, such as law envehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of forcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle personally identifying data routinely acquired during a
is designed to record such data as:
crash investigation.
Event Data Recorder (EDR)
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating; To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed.
In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties,
were buckled/fastened;
such as law enforcement, that have the special equip• How far (if at all) the driver was pushing the accelera- ment, can read the information if they have access to the
tor and/or brake pedal; and,
vehicle or the EDR.
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
2
76 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Child Restraints
WARNING! (Continued)
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all
times, including babies and children.
great that you could not hold the child, no matter
how strong you are. The child and others could be
badly injured. Any child riding in your vehicle
should be in a proper restraint for the child’s size.
Every state in the United States, and every Canadian
province, requires that small children ride in proper
restraint systems. This is the law, and you can be prosThere are different sizes and types of restraints for
ecuted for ignoring it.
children from newborn size to the child almost large
Children 12 years or younger should ride properly enough for an adult seat belt. Always check the child seat
buckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash Owner’s Manual to make sure you have the correct seat
statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in for your child. Carefully read and follow all the instructhe rear seats rather than in the front.
tions and warnings in the child restraint Owner’s Manual
and on all the labels attached to the child restraint.
WARNING!
In a collision, an unrestrained child can become a
projectile inside the vehicle. The force required to
hold even an infant on your lap could become so
(Continued)
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety
Standards. You should also make sure that you can install
it in the vehicle where you will use it.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 77
NOTE:
• For additional information, refer to www.seatcheck.org or
call 1–866–SEATCHECK (732–8243). Canadian residents
should refer to Transport Canada’s website for additional
information:
2
• www.tc.gc.ca/eng/roadsafety/safedriverschildsafety-index-53.htm
Summary Of Recommendations For Restraining Children In Vehicles
Infants and Toddlers
Child Size, Height, Weight Or
Age
Children who are two years old or
younger and who have not
reached the height or weight limits
of their child restraint
Recommended Type Of Child
Restraint
Either an Infant Carrier or a Convertible Child Restraint, facing rearward in the rear seat of the vehicle
78 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Small Children
Larger Children
Children Too Large for Child
Restraints
Child Size, Height, Weight Or
Age
Children who are at least two
years old or who have out-grown
the height or weight limit of their
rear-facing child restraint
Children who have out-grown
their forward-facing child restraint,
but are too small to properly fit
the vehicle’s seat belt
Children 12 years old or younger,
who have out-grown the height or
weight limit of their booster seat
Recommended Type Of Child
Restraint
Forward-Facing Child Restraint
with a five-point Harness, facing
forward in the rear seat of the
vehicle
Belt Positioning Booster Seat and
the vehicle seat belt, seated in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Vehicle Seat Belt, seated in the rear
seat of the vehicle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 79
Infants And Child Restraints
Safety experts recommend that children ride rear-facing
in the vehicle until they are two years old or until they
reach either the height or weight limit of their rear-facing
child restraint. Two types of child restraints can be used
rear-facing: infant carriers and convertible child seats.
The infant carrier is only used rear-facing in the vehicle.
It is recommended for children from birth until they
reach the weight or height limit of the infant carrier.
Convertible child seats can be used either rear-facing or
forward-facing in the vehicle. Convertible child seats
often have a higher weight limit in the rear-facing
direction than infant carriers do, so they can be used
rear-facing by children who have outgrown their infant
carrier but are still less than at least two years old.
Children should remain rear-facing until they reach the
highest weight or height allowed by their convertible
child seat.
WARNING!
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
Older Children And Child Restraints
Children who are two years old or who have outgrown
their rear-facing convertible child seat can ride forwardfacing in the vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and
convertible child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for children who are over two years old or who
have outgrown the rear-facing weight or height limit of
their rear-facing convertible child seat. Children should
2
80 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
remain in a forward-facing child seat with a harness for
as long as possible, up to the highest weight or height
allowed by the child seat.
All children whose weight or height is above the forwardfacing limit for the child seat should use a belt-positioning
booster seat until the vehicle’s seat belts fit properly. If the
child cannot sit with knees bent over the vehicle’s seat
cushion while the child’s back is against the seatback, they
should use a belt-positioning booster seat. The child and
belt-positioning booster seat are held in the vehicle by the
seat belt.
WARNING!
• Improper installation can lead to failure of an infant
or child restraint. It could come loose in a collision.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
The child could be badly injured or killed. Follow the
child restraint manufacturer’s directions exactly when
installing an infant or child restraint.
• After a child restraint is installed in the vehicle, do
not move the vehicle seat forward or rearward
because it can loosen the child restraint attachments. Remove the child restraint before adjusting
the vehicle seat position. When the vehicle seat has
been adjusted, reinstall the child restraint.
• When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in
the vehicle with the seat belt or LATCH anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle. Do not leave it
loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop or accident, it
could strike the occupants or seatbacks and cause
serious personal injury.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 81
Children Too Large For Booster Seats
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt
comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend over
the front of the seat when their back is against the seatback,
should use the seat belt in a rear seat. Use this simple 5-step
test to decide whether the child can use the vehicle’s seat belt
alone:
1. Can the child sit all the way back against the back of
the vehicle seat?
2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over the front
of the vehicle seat – while they are still sitting all the
way back?
3. Does the shoulder belt cross the child’s shoulder
between their neck and arm?
4. Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as possible,
touching the child’s thighs and not their stomach?
5. Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?
If the answer to any of these questions was “no,” then the
child still needs to use a booster seat in this vehicle. If the
child is using the lap/shoulder belt, check seat belt fit
periodically and make sure the seat belt buckle is latched.
A child’s squirming or slouching can move the seat belt
out of position. If the shoulder belt contacts the face or
neck, move the child closer to the center of the vehicle, or
use a booster seat to position the seat belt on the child
correctly.
WARNING!
Never allow a child to put the shoulder belt under an
arm or behind their back. In a crash, the shoulder belt
will not protect a child properly, which may result in
serious injury or death. A child must always wear
both the lap and shoulder portions of the seat belt
correctly.
2
82 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Recommendations For Attaching Child Restraints
Restraint Type
Combined
Weight of the
Child + Child
Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Use any attachment method shown with an “X” Below
LATCH –
Seat Belt Only
LATCH –
Seat Belt + Top
Lower Anchors
Lower Anchors
Tether Anchor
Only
+ Top Tether
Anchor
X
X
X
X
X
X
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 83
Lower Anchors And Tethers For Children (LATCH)
Restraint System
Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchorage system called LATCH, which stands for Lower
Anchors and Tethers for CHildren. The LATCH system
has three vehicle anchor points for installing LATCHequipped child seats. There are two lower anchorages
located at the back of the seat cushion where it meets the
seatback and one top tether anchorage located behind the
seating position. These anchorages are used to install
LATCH-equipped child seats without using the vehicle’s
seat belts. Some seating positions may have a top tether
anchorage but no lower anchorages. In these seating
positions, the seat belt must be used with the top tether
anchorage to install the child restraint. Please see the
following table for more information.
2
84 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
LATCH Positions For Installing Child Restraints In
This Vehicle
•
•
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per
seating position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 85
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
LATCH anchorage system to attach the
child restraint?
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Can the LATCH anchorages and the seat
belt be used together to attach a rearfacing or forward-facing child restraint?
Can two child restraints be attached using
a common lower LATCH anchorage?
No
No
Use the LATCH anchorage system until
the combined weight of the child and the
child restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the
seat belt and tether anchor instead of the
LATCH system once the combined weight
is more than 65 lbs (29.5 kg).
Do not use the seat belt when you use the
LATCH anchorage system to attach a rearfacing or forward-facing child restraint.
Never “share” a LATCH anchorage with
two or more child restraints. If the center
position does not have dedicated LATCH
lower anchorages, use the seat belt to install a child seat in the center position next
to a child seat using the LATCH anchorages in an outboard position.
2
86 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch
the back of the front passenger seat?
Yes
Can the head restraints be removed?
Yes
The child seat may touch the back of the
front passenger seat if the child restraint
manufacturer also allows contact. See your
child restraint owner’s manual for more
information.
Center position only may be removed.
Locating LATCH Anchorages
The lower anchorages are round bars that are
found at the rear of the seat cushion where it
meets the seatback, below the anchorage symbols on the seatback. They are just visible when
you lean into the rear seat to install the child restraint.
You will easily feel them if you run your finger along the
gap between the seatback and seat cushion.
LATCH Anchorages
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 87
Locating Tether Anchorages
There are tether strap anchorages behind each
rear seating position located in the panel between the rear seatback and the rear window.
They are found under a plastic cover with the
tether anchorage symbol on it.
LATCH-compatible child restraint systems will be
equipped with a rigid bar or a flexible strap on each side.
Each will have a hook or connector to attach to the lower
anchorage and a way to tighten the connection to the
anchorage. Forward-facing child restraints and some
rear-facing child restraints will also be equipped with a
tether strap. The tether strap will have a hook at the end
to attach to the top tether anchorage and a way to tighten
the strap after it is attached to the anchorage.
Center Seat LATCH
If a child restraint installed in the center position blocks
the seat belt webbing or buckle for the outboard position,
do not use that outboard position. If a child seat in the
center position blocks the outboard LATCH anchors or
seat belt, do not install a child seat in that outboard
position.
Tether Strap Anchorages
2
88 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Never use the same lower anchorage to attach more
than one child restraint. Please refer to “Installing
The LATCH-Compatible Child Restraint System” for
typical installation instructions.
1. Loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and on the
tether strap of the child seat so that you can more
easily attach the hooks or connectors to the vehicle
anchorages.
2. Place the child seat between the lower anchorages for
that seating position. For some second row seats, you
may need to recline the seat and/or raise the head
Always follow the directions of the child restraint
restraint to get a better fit. If the rear seat can be moved
manufacturer when installing your child restraint. Not
forward and rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to
all child restraint systems will be installed as described
move it to its rear-most position to make room for the
here.
child seat. You may also move the front seat forward
To Install A LATCH-Compatible Child Restraint
to allow more room for the child seat.
If the selected seating position has a Switchable Auto- 3. Attach the lower hooks or connectors of the child
matic Locking Retractor (ALR) seat belt, stow the seat
restraint to the lower anchorages in the selected seatbelt, following the instructions below. See the section
ing position.
“Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle Seat Belt”
to check what type of seat belt each seating position has.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 89
4. If the child restraint has a tether strap, connect it to the
top tether anchorage. See the section “Installing Child
Restraints Using the Top Tether Anchorage” for directions to attach a tether anchor.
5. Tighten all of the straps as you push the child restraint
rearward and downward into the seat. Remove slack
in the straps according to the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
6. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
How To Stow An Unused ALR Seat Belt:
When using the LATCH attaching system to install a
child restraint, stow all ALR seat belts that are not being
used by other occupants or being used to secure child
restraints. An unused belt could injure a child if they play
with it and accidentally lock the seat belt retractor. Before
installing a child restraint using the LATCH system,
buckle the seat belt behind the child restraint and out of
the child’s reach. If the buckled seat belt interferes with
the child restraint installation, instead of buckling it
behind the child restraint, route the seat belt through the
child restraint belt path and then buckle it. Do not lock
the seat belt. Remind all children in the vehicle that the
seat belts are not toys and that they should not play with
them.
2
90 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• Improper installation of a child restraint to the
LATCH anchorages can lead to failure of the restraint. The child could be badly injured or killed.
Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s directions
exactly when installing an infant or child restraint.
• Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads imposed by correctly-fitted
child restraints. Under no circumstances are they to
be used for adult seat belts, harnesses, or for
attaching other items or equipment to the vehicle.
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) that is designed to keep the lap portion of the seat
belt tight around the child restraint so that it is not
necessary to use a locking clip. The ALR retractor can be
“switched” into a locked mode by pulling all of the
webbing out of the retractor and then letting the webbing
retract back into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will
make a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back
into the retractor. For additional information on ALR,
refer to the “Automatic Locking Mode” description under “Occupant Restraints.”
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 91
Lap/Shoulder Belt Systems for Installing Child
Restraints in this Vehicle
2
• ALR = Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
•
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
92 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
Tether Anchor with the seat belt to attach a
forward facing child restraint?
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch
the back of the front passenger seat?
Weight limit of the
Child Restraint
Can the head restraints be removed?
Can the buckle stalk be twisted to tighten
the seat belt against the belt path of the
child restraint?
Yes
No
Yes
Always use the tether anchor when using
the seat belt to install a forward facing
child restraint, up to the recommended
weight limit of the child restraint.
Contact between the front passenger seat
and the child restraint is allowed, if the
child restraint manufacturer also allows
contact.
Center Only may be removed.
Do not twist the buckle stalk in a seating
position with an ALR retractor.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 93
5. To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder part of
the belt until you have pulled all the seat belt webbing
out of the retractor. Then, allow the webbing to retract
Place the child seat in the center of the seating
back into the retractor. As the webbing retracts, you will
position. For some second row seats, you may need to
hear a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is now in
recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a
the Automatic Locking mode.
better fit. If the rear seat can be moved forward and
rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to move it to its 6. Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it is
locked, you should not be able to pull out any webrear-most position to make room for the child seat.
bing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat step 5.
You may also move the front seat forward to allow
more room for the child seat.
7. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the lap
portion around the child restraint while you push the
Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor
child restraint rearward and downward into the vehicle
to pass it through the belt path of the child restraint.
seat.
Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path.
8. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the seating
Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a
position has a top tether anchorage, connect the tether
“click.”
strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether strap. See
the section “Installing Child Restraints Using the Top
Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion tight
Tether Anchorage” for directions to attach a tether anagainst the child seat.
chor.
Installing A Child Restraint With A Switchable
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
1.
2.
3.
4.
2
94 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
9. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
seat belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
WARNING! (Continued)
(LATCH) Restraint System” for the location of approved tether anchorages in your vehicle.
Installing Child Restraints Using The Top Tether
Anchorage
WARNING!
Do not attach a tether strap for a rear-facing car seat
to any location in front of the car seat, including the
seat frame or a tether anchorage. Only attach the
tether strap of a rear-facing car seat to the tether
anchorage that is approved for that seating position,
located behind the top of the vehicle seat. See the
section “Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren
(Continued)
1. Look behind the seating position where you
plan to install the child restraint to find the
tether anchorage. You may need to move the
seat forward to provide better access to the
tether anchorage. If there is no top tether anchorage for that
seating position, move the child restraint to another position
in the vehicle if one is available.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 95
2. Rotate or lift the cover to access the anchor directly
behind the seat where you are placing the child
restraint.
2
3. Route the tether strap to provide the most direct path
for the strap between the anchor and the child seat. If
your vehicle is equipped with adjustable rear head
restraints, raise the head restraint, and where possible,
route the tether strap under the head restraint and
between the two posts. If not possible, lower the head
restraint and pass the tether strap around the outboard
side of the head restraint.
Tether Strap Mounting
1 — Cover
3 — Attaching Strap
A — Tether Strap Hook
B — Tether Anchor
96 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
4. Attach the tether strap hook of the child restraint to Transporting Pets
the top tether anchorage as shown in the diagram.
Air Bags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet. An
5. Remove slack in the tether strap according to the child unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possibly injured,
or injure a passenger during panic braking or in a collision.
restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
WARNING!
• An incorrectly anchored tether strap could lead to
increased head motion and possible injury to the
child. Use only the anchorage position directly
behind the child seat to secure a child restraint top
tether strap.
• If your vehicle is equipped with a split rear seat,
make sure the tether strap does not slip into the
opening between the seatbacks as you remove
slack in the strap.
Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses
or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS
A long break-in period is not required for the engine and
drivetrain (transmission and axle) in your vehicle.
Drive moderately during the first 300 miles (500 km).
After the initial 60 miles (100 km), speeds up to 50 or
55 mph (80 or 90 km/h) are desirable.
While cruising, brief full-throttle acceleration within the
limits of local traffic laws contributes to a good break-in.
Wide-open throttle acceleration in low gear can be detrimental and should be avoided.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 97
The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory is a
high-quality energy conserving type lubricant. Oil
changes should be consistent with anticipated climate
conditions under which vehicle operations will occur. For
the recommended viscosity and quality grades, refer to
“Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle.”
CAUTION!
Never use Non-Detergent Oil or Straight Mineral Oil
in the engine or damage may result.
NOTE: A new engine may consume some oil during its
first few thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This
should be considered a normal part of the break-in and
not interpreted as a problem.
SAFETY TIPS
Transporting Passengers
NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO
AREA.
WARNING!
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle
that is not equipped with seats and seat belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
2
98 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Exhaust Gas
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon
monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless.
Breathing it can make you unconscious and can
eventually poison you. To avoid breathing (CO),
follow these safety tips:
• Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in
confined areas any longer than needed to move
your vehicle in or out of the area.
• If you are required to drive with the trunk/liftgate/
rear doors open, make sure that all windows are
closed and the climate control BLOWER switch is
set at high speed. DO NOT use the recirculation
mode.
(Continued)
• If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running, adjust your heating or cooling
controls to force outside air into the vehicle. Set the
blower at high speed.
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
system.
Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust
system, when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the
vehicle, or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is
damaged, have a competent mechanic inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken,
damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open
seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes
to seep into the passenger compartment. In addition,
inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 99
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle
Air Bag Warning Light
The light should come on and remain on for four
to eight seconds as a bulb check when the
Inspect the seat belt system periodically, checking for
ignition switch is first turned ON. If the light is
cuts, frays, and loose parts. Damaged parts must be
not lit during starting, see your authorized
replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the
dealer. If the light stays on, flickers, or comes on while
system.
driving, have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a
Defroster
collision. Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after
a collision if they have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor, Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place
torn webbing, etc.). If there is any question regarding seat the blower control on high speed. You should be able to feel
the air directed against the windshield. See your authobelt or retractor condition, replace the seat belt.
rized dealer for service if your defroster is inoperable.
Seat Belts
2
100 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Floor Mat Safety Information
WARNING! (Continued)
Always use floor mats designed to fit the footwell of your
vehicle. Use only floor mats that leave the pedal area
unobstructed and that are firmly secured so that they
cannot slip out of position and interfere with the pedals
or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways.
WARNING!
Pedals that cannot move freely can cause loss of
vehicle control and increase the risk of serious personal injury.
• Always make sure that floor mats are properly
attached to the floor mat fasteners.
• Never place or install floor mats or other floor coverings in the vehicle that cannot be properly secured to
prevent them from moving and interfering with the
pedals or the ability to control the vehicle.
(Continued)
• Never put floor mats or other floor coverings on top
of already installed floor mats. Additional floor
mats and other coverings will reduce the size of the
pedal area and interfere with the pedals.
• Check mounting of mats on a regular basis. Always
properly reinstall and secure floor mats that have
been removed for cleaning.
• Always make sure that objects cannot fall into the
driver footwell while the vehicle is moving. Objects
can become trapped under the brake pedal and accelerator pedal causing a loss of vehicle control.
• If required, mounting posts must be properly installed, if not equipped from the factory.
Failure to properly follow floor mat installation or
mounting can cause interference with the brake
pedal and accelerator pedal operation causing loss of
control of the vehicle.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 101
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle
Door Latches
Tires
Fluid Leaks
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear
patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects
lodged in the tread or sidewall. Inspect the tread for cuts
and cracks. Inspect sidewalls for cuts, cracks, and bulges.
Check the wheel nuts for tightness. Check the tires
(including spare) for proper cold inflation pressure.
Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel,
engine coolant, oil, or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasoline
fumes are detected or if fuel, power steering fluid (if
equipped), or brake fluid leaks are suspected, the cause
should be located and corrected immediately.
Lights
Have someone observe the operation of brake lights and
exterior lights while you work the controls. Check turn
signal and high beam indicator lights on the instrument
panel.
Check for positive closing, latching, and locking.
2
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 MIRRORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped . . .110
▫ Outside Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
▫ Outside Mirrors Folding Feature —
If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
▫ Power Folding Outside Mirrors —
If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Heated Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped . . .119
▫ “Slide-On-Rod” And Extender Features Of
Sun Visor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
▫ Driver’s Automatic Dimming Mirror —
If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 䡵 BLIND SPOT MONITORING (BSM) —
IF EQUIPPED. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
▫ Outside Mirrors With Turn Signal And
Approach Lighting — If Equipped . . . . . . . . .116
▫ Rear Cross Path. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
▫ Tilt Mirrors In Reverse — If Equipped . . . . . . .117
▫ Modes Of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
▫ Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
▫ General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
3
104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
䡵 SEATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 䡵 TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD . . . . . . . . .147
▫ Power Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 䡵 LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
▫ Power Lumbar — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . .134
▫ Headlight Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
▫ Heated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
▫ Automatic Headlights — If Equipped . . . . . . .149
▫ Front Ventilated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . .137
▫ Headlights On With Wipers (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
▫ Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
▫ Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
䡵 DRIVER MEMORY SEAT — IF EQUIPPED . . . .143
▫ Programming The Memory Feature . . . . . . . . .144
▫ Linking And Unlinking The Remote Keyless
Entry Transmitter To Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
▫ Memory Position Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
▫ Easy Entry/Exit Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
▫ Headlight Time Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
▫ Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control —
If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
▫ Adaptive Bi-Xenon High Intensity Discharge
Headlights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
▫ Daytime Running Lights (DRL). . . . . . . . . . . .152
▫ Lights-On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
▫ Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105
▫ Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
▫ Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
▫ Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
▫ Headlights On With Wipers (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
▫ Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ High/Low Beam Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ Front Map/Reading Lights — If Equipped . . .155
▫ Courtesy Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
▫ Ambient Light — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . .157
▫ Rain Sensing Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
䡵 TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN . . .164
䡵 POWER TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING
COLUMN — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
䡵 HEATED STEERING WHEEL —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
▫ Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 䡵 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . .168
䡵 WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS . . . . . .160 䡵 ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
▫ Intermittent Wiper System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
▫ To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
▫ Wiper Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
▫ To Set A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
▫ Mist Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
3
106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
▫ To Deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
▫ To Resume Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
▫ Setting The Following Distance In ACC . . . . . .185
▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
▫ Overtake Aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
▫ To Accelerate For Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
▫ ACC Operation At Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
䡵 ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC) — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
▫ Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Menu . . . . . . .190
▫ Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Operation . . . .177
▫ Activating Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC). . . .178
▫ To Activate/Deactivate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
▫ To Set A Desired ACC Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
▫ Display Warnings And Maintenance . . . . . . . .191
▫ Precautions While Driving With ACC . . . . . . .194
▫ General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
▫ Normal (Fixed Speed) Electronic Speed
Control Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
▫ To Cancel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181 䡵 FORWARD COLLISION WARNING (FCW)
WITH MITIGATION — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . .203
▫ To Turn Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
▫ Forward Collision Warning (FCW) With
▫ To Resume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Mitigation Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107
▫ Turning FCW ON Or OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
▫ ParkSense® Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
▫ Changing FCW And Active Braking Status. . . .206
▫ Enabling And Disabling ParkSense® . . . . . . . .224
▫ FCW Limited Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
▫ Service The ParkSense® Park Assist System . . .225
▫ Service FCW Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
▫ Cleaning The ParkSense® System . . . . . . . . . .226
䡵 LANESENSE — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
▫ ParkSense® System Usage Precautions. . . . . . .226
▫ LaneSense Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207 䡵 PARKVIEW® REAR BACK UP CAMERA —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Turning LaneSense ON Or OFF. . . . . . . . . . . .208
䡵 OVERHEAD CONSOLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ LaneSense Warning Message. . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
▫ Front Map/Reading Lights — If Equipped
▫ Changing LaneSense Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
▫ Courtesy Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 PARKSENSE® FRONT AND REAR PARK
ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
▫ Sunglasses Bin Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . .228
. . .231
. . .231
. . .232
. . .233
▫ ParkSense® Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214 䡵 GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED . . .233
▫ ParkSense® Warning Display . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
▫ Before You Begin Programming HomeLink® . .234
3
108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Programming A Rolling Code . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
▫ Opening Power Shade — Express . . . . . . . . . .244
▫ Programming A Non-Rolling Code . . . . . . . . .237
▫ Opening Power Shade — Manual Mode . . . . .245
▫ Canadian/Gate Operator Programming . . . . . .238
▫ Closing Power Shade — Express . . . . . . . . . . .245
▫ Using HomeLink® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
▫ Closing Power Shade — Manual Mode . . . . . .245
▫ Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
▫ Venting Sunroof — Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
▫ Troubleshooting Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
▫ Pinch Protect Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
▫ General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
䡵 COMMANDVIEW® SUNROOF WITH POWER
SHADE — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
▫ Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
▫ Opening Sunroof — Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
▫ Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode . . . . . . . . .244
▫ Closing Sunroof — Express. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
▫ Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . .244
▫ Ignition OFF Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
䡵 ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS . . . . . . . . . . .247
䡵 CUPHOLDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
▫ Front Seat Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
▫ Rear Seat Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109
䡵 STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254 䡵 CARGO AREA FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
▫ Glove Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
▫ Trunk Mat — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
▫ Console Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
▫ Grocery Bag Hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
▫ Door Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
▫ Cargo Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
▫ Rear Seat Armrest Storage — If Equipped . . . .257 䡵 REAR WINDOW FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
▫ Cargo Area — Vehicles Equipped With
60/40 Split-Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
▫ Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
▫ Power Sunshade — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .261
䡵 LOAD LEVELING SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED . .262
3
110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• The Automatic Dimming Mirror feature can be turned
on or off using the Uconnect® System. Refer to
Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
“Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your InstruA single ball joint mirror is provided in the vehicle. It is
ment Panel” for further information.
a twist on mirror that has a fixed position at the windshield. The mirror installs on the windshield button with
a counterclockwise rotation and requires no tools for
mounting. The mirror head can be adjusted up, down,
left, and right for various drivers. The mirror should be
adjusted to center on the view through the rear window.
MIRRORS
This mirror automatically adjusts for headlight glare
from vehicles behind you.
NOTE:
• The Automatic Dimming Mirror feature is disabled
when the vehicle is in reverse gear to improve rear
view viewing.
Automatic Dimming Mirror
If equipped, the rearview mirror contains an ASSIST and
a 9-1-1 button.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111
NOTE: The ASSIST and 9–1–1 features operate through • Vehicle Customer Care – Total support for all other
the Uconnect® Access service. These buttons will only
vehicle issues.
operate as long as your Uconnect® Access service is 9-1-1 Call
active. Refer to your “Uconnect® System supplement
1. Press the 9-1-1 Call button on the Rearview Mirror.
manual” for further information.
ASSIST Call
The ASSIST Button is used to automatically connect you
to any one of the following support centers:
NOTE: In case the 9-1-1 Call button is pushed in error,
there will be a 10 second delay before the 9-1-1 Call
system initiates a call to a 9-1-1 operator. To cancel the
9-1-1 Call connection, press the 9-1-1 Call button on the
Rearview Mirror or press the cancellation button on the
Phone Screen. Termination of the 9-1-1 Call will turn the
green LED light on the Rearview Mirror off.
• Roadside Assistance – If you get a flat tire, or need a
tow, just press the Assist button and you’ll be connected to someone who can help. Roadside Assistance
will know what vehicle you’re driving and its location.
2. The LED light located between the Assist and 9-1-1
Additional fees may apply for roadside Assistance.
buttons on the Rearview Mirror will turn green once a
• Uconnect® Access Customer Care – In-vehicle support
connection to a 9-1-1 operator has been made.
for Uconnect® Access and Uconnect® Access Via
Mobile features.
3
112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
3. Once a connection between the vehicle and a 9-1-1 the vehicle. The vehicle’s 9-1-1 Call system will attempt to
operator is made, the 9-1-1 Call system may transmit remain connected with the 9-1-1 operator until the 9-1-1
the following important vehicle information to a 9-1-1 operator terminates the connection.
operator:
5. The 9-1-1 operator may attempt to contact appropriate
• Indication that the occupant placed a 9-1-1 Call.
emergency responders and provide them with important vehicle information and GPS coordinates.
• The vehicle brand.
• The last known GPS coordinates of the vehicle.
4. You should be able to speak with the 9-1-1 operator
through the vehicle audio system to determine if
additional help is needed.
NOTE: Once a connection is made between the vehicle’s
9-1-1 Call system and the 9-1-1 operator, the 9-1-1 operator
may be able to open a voice connection with the vehicle to
determine if additional help is needed. Once the 9-1-1
operator opens a voice connection with the vehicle’s 9-1-1
Call system, the operator should be able to speak with you
or other vehicle occupants and hear sounds occurring in
WARNING!
• If anyone in the vehicle could be in danger (e.g.,
fire or smoke is visible, dangerous road conditions
or location), do not wait for voice contact from a
9-1-1 operator. All occupants should exit the vehicle
immediately and move to a safe location.
• The 9-1-1 Call system is embedded into the vehicle’s electrical system. Do not add aftermarket
electrical equipment to the vehicle’s electrical system. This may prevent your vehicle from sending a
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113
WARNING! (Continued)
signal to initiate an emergency call. To avoid interference that can cause the 9-1-1 Call system to fail,
never add aftermarket equipment (e.g., two-way
mobile radio, CB radio, data recorder, etc.) to your
vehicle’s electrical system or modify the antennas
on your vehicle. IF YOUR VEHICLE LOSES BATTERY POWER FOR ANY REASON (INCLUDING
DURING OR AFTER AN ACCIDENT), THE
UCONNECT FEATURES, APPS AND SERVICES,
AMONG OTHERS, WILL NOT OPERATE.
• Modifications to any part of the 9-1-1 Call system
could cause the air bag system to fail when you
need it. You could be injured if the air bag system
is not there to help protect you.
9-1-1 Call System Limitations
Vehicles sold in Canada and Mexico DO NOT have 9-1-1
Call system capabilities.
9-1-1 or other emergency line operators in Canada and
Mexico may not answer or respond to 9-1-1 system calls.
If the 9-1-1 Call system detects a malfunction, any of the
following may occur at the time the malfunction is
detected, and at the beginning of each ignition cycle:
• The Rearview Mirror light located between the Assist
and 9-1-1 buttons will continuously be illuminated
red.
• The Phone Screen will display the following message
“Vehicle phone requires service. Please contact your
dealer.”
• An In-Vehicle Audio message will state “Vehicle phone
requires service. Please contact your dealer.”
3
114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• Ignoring the Rearview Mirror light could mean you
will not have 9-1-1 Call services. If the Rearview
Mirror light is illuminated, have an authorized
dealer service the 9-1-1 Call system immediately.
• The Occupant Restraint Control module turns on
the Air Bag Warning Light on the instrument panel
if a malfunction in any part of the system is
detected. If the Air Bag Warning Light is illuminated, the air bag system may not be working
properly and the 9-1-1 system may not be able to
send a signal to a 9-1-1 operator. If the Air Bag
Warning Light is illuminated, have an authorized
dealer service the ORC system immediately.
Even if the 9-1-1 Call system is fully functional, factors
beyond Chrysler Group LLC’s control may prevent or
stop the 9-1-1 Call system operation. These include, but
are not limited to, the following factors:
• Delayed accessories mode is active.
• The ignition is in the OFF position.
• The vehicle’s electrical systems are not intact.
• The 9-1-1 Call system software and/or hardware are
damaged during a crash.
• The vehicle battery loses power or becomes disconnected during a vehicle crash.
• Wireless and/or Global Positioning Satellite signals
are unavailable or obstructed.
• Equipment malfunction at the 9-1-1 operator facility.
• Operator error by the 9-1-1 operator.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115
• Wireless network congestion.
• Weather.
• Buildings, structures, geographic terrain, or tunnels.
CAUTION!
To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning, never
spray any cleaning solution directly onto the mirror.
Apply the solution onto a clean cloth and wipe the
mirror clean.
NOTE: Never place anything on or near the vehicle’s
wireless and GPS antennas. You could prevent wireless
and GPS signal reception, which can prevent your vehicle Outside Mirrors
from placing an emergency call. Wireless and GPS signal
reception is required for the 9-1-1 Call system to function To receive maximum benefit, adjust the outside mirror(s)
to center on the adjacent lane of traffic and a slight
properly.
overlap of the view obtained from the inside mirror.
General Information
NOTE: The passenger side convex outside mirror will
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.
give a much wider view to the rear, and especially of the
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1)
lane next to your vehicle.
This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2)
this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
3
116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side
convex mirror will look smaller and farther away
than they really are. Relying too much on your
passenger side convex mirror could cause you to
collide with another vehicle or other object. Use your
inside mirror when judging the size or distance of a
vehicle seen in the passenger side convex mirror.
Outside Mirrors Folding Feature — If Equipped
Driver’s Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
This feature is controlled by the inside automatic dimming mirror and will automatically adjust for headlight
glare when the inside mirror adjusts.
NOTE: This feature is also available on the passenger’s
side when equipped with turn signal and approach
lighting.
Outside Mirrors With Turn Signal And Approach
Lighting — If Equipped
Driver and passenger outside mirrors with turn signal
Some models have outside mirrors that are hinged. The
and approach lighting contain four LEDs, which are
hinge allows the mirror to pivot forward and rearward to
located in the upper outer corner of each mirror.
resist damage. The hinge has three detent positions: full
Three of the LEDs are turn signal indicators, which flash
forward, full rearward and normal.
with the corresponding turn signal lights in the front and
rear of the vehicle. Turning on the Hazard Warning
flashers will also activate these LEDs.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117
The fourth LED supplies illuminated entry lighting,
which turns on in both mirrors when you use the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter or open any door. This
LED shines outward to illuminate the front and rear door
handles. It also shines downward to illuminate the area
in front of the doors.
Tilt Mirrors In Reverse — If Equipped
Tilt Mirrors in Reverse provides automatic outside mirror
positioning which will aid the driver’s view of the
ground rearward of the front doors. The outside mirrors
will move slightly downward from the present position
when the vehicle is shifted into REVERSE. The outside
The Illuminated Entry lighting fades to off after about 30 mirrors will then return to the original position when the
seconds or it will fade to off immediately once the vehicle is shifted out of the REVERSE position. Each
stored memory setting will have an associated Tilt Mirignition is placed into the RUN position.
rors in Reverse position.
NOTE: The approach lighting will not function when the
NOTE: The Tilt Mirrors in Reverse feature is not turned
gear selector is moved out of the PARK position.
on when delivered from the factory. The Tilt Mirrors in
Reverse feature can be turned on and off using the
Uconnect® System. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
3
118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The power mirror controls consist of mirror select butThe power mirror controls are located on the driver’s tons and a four-way mirror control switch. To adjust a
mirror, press either the L (left) or R (right) button to select
door trim panel.
the mirror that you want to adjust.
Power Mirrors
NOTE: A light in the select button will illuminate indicating the mirror is activated and can be adjusted.
Using the mirror control switch, press on any of the four
arrows for the direction that you want the mirror to
move.
Power mirror preselected positions can be controlled by
the optional Memory Seat Feature. Refer to “Driver
Memory Seat” in “Understanding The Features Of Your
Vehicle” for further information.
Power Mirror Control
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119
Power Folding Outside Mirrors — If Equipped
Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped
The switch for the power folding mirrors is located
between the power mirror switches L (left) and R (right).
Press the switch once and the mirrors will fold in,
pressing the switch a second time will return the mirrors
to the normal driving position.
An illuminated vanity mirror is located on the sun visor.
To use the mirror, rotate the sun visor downward and
swing the mirror cover upward. The light turns on
automatically. Closing the mirror cover turns off the light.
NOTE: If the vehicle speed is greater than 10 mph
(16 km/h) the folding feature will be disabled.
If the mirrors are in the folded position, and vehicle
speed is equal or greater than 10 mph (16 km/h), they
will automatically unfold.
Heated Mirrors — If Equipped
These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice. This
feature can be activated whenever you turn on the
rear window defroster (if equipped). Refer to “Rear
Window Features” in “Understanding The Features Of
Your Vehicle” for further information.
Illuminated Vanity Mirror
3
120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
“Slide-On-Rod” And Extender Features Of Sun
Visor
To use the “Slide-On-Rod” feature of the sun visor, rotate
the sun visor downward and swing the sun visor so it is
parallel to the side window, grab the sun visor and pull
rearwards until the sun visor is in the desired position. To
use the extender feature of the sun visor, grab the
extender which is located at the rear of the visor and pull
rearward.
Slide-On-Rod Feature
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 121
BLIND SPOT MONITORING (BSM) — IF EQUIPPED
The Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) system uses two radarbased sensors, located inside the rear bumper fascia, to
detect highway licensable vehicles (automobiles, trucks,
motorcycles, etc.) that enter the blind spot zones from the
rear/front/side of the vehicle.
Rear Detection Zones
When the vehicle is started, the BSM warning light will
momentarily illuminate in both outside rear view mirrors
to let the driver know that the system is operational. The
BSM system sensors operate when the vehicle is in any
forward gear or REVERSE and enters stand by mode
when the vehicle is in PARK.
BSM Warning Light
3
122 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The BSM detection zone covers approximately one lane
width on both sides of the vehicle 12 ft (3.8 m). The zone
length starts at the outside rear view mirror and extends
approximately 10 ft (3 m) beyond the rear bumper of the
vehicle. The BSM system monitors the detection zones on
both sides of the vehicle when the vehicle speed reaches
approximately 6 mph (10 km/h) or higher and will alert the
driver of vehicles in these areas.
NOTE:
• The BSM system does NOT alert the driver about
rapidly approaching vehicles that are outside the detection zones.
• The BSM system detection zone DOES NOT change if
your vehicle is towing a trailer. Therefore, visually verify
the adjacent lane is clear for both your vehicle and trailer
before making a lane change. If the trailer or other object
(i.e., bicycle, sports equipment) extends beyond the side
of your vehicle, this may result in the BSM warning light
remaining illuminated the entire time the vehicle is in a
forward gear.
The area on the rear fascia where the radar sensors are
located must remain free of snow, ice, and dirt/road
contamination so that the BSM system can function
properly. Do not block the area of the rear fascia where
the radar sensors are located with foreign objects (bumper stickers, bicycle racks, etc.).
Sensor Location (Driver Side Shown)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 123
The BSM system notifies the driver of objects in the
detection zones by illuminating the BSM warning light
located in the outside mirrors in addition to sounding an
audible (chime) alert and reducing the radio volume.
Refer to “Modes Of Operation” for further information.
3
The BSM system monitors the detection zone from three
different entry points (side, rear, front) while driving to
see if an alert is necessary. The BSM system will issue an
alert during these types of zone entries.
Entering From The Side
Vehicles that move into your adjacent lanes from either
side of the vehicle.
Side Monitoring
124 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Entering From The Rear
Overtaking Traffic
Vehicles that come up from behind your vehicle on either If you pass another vehicle slowly with a relative speed of
side and enter the rear detection zone with a relative less than 15 m.p.h. (24 km/h) and the vehicle remains in the
blind spot for approximately 1.5 seconds, the warning light
speed of less than 30 m.p.h. (48 km/h).
will be illuminated. If the difference in speed between the
two vehicles is greater than 15 m.p.h. (24 km/h), the
warning light will not illuminate.
Rear Monitoring
Overtaking/Approaching
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 125
The BSM system is designed not to issue an alert on The BSM system will not alert you of objects that are
stationary objects such as guardrails, posts, walls, foliage, traveling in the opposite direction of the vehicle in
berms, etc. However, occasionally the system may alert adjacent lanes.
on such objects. This is normal operation and your
vehicle does not require service.
Stationary Objects
Overtaking/Passing
3
126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
system is not designed to detect pedestrians, bicyclists, or animals. Even if your vehicle is equipped
with the BSM system, always check your vehicle’s
mirrors, glance over your shoulder, and use your turn
signal before changing lanes. Failure to do so can
result in serious injury or death.
Rear Cross Path
Opposing Traffic
WARNING!
The Blind Spot Monitoring system is only an aid to
help detect objects in the blind spot zones. The BSM
(Continued)
The Rear Cross Path (RCP) feature is intended to aid the
drivers when backing out of parking spaces where their
vision of oncoming vehicles may be blocked. Proceed
slowly and cautiously out of the parking space until the
rear end of the vehicle is exposed. The RCP system will
then have a clear view of the cross traffic and if an
oncoming vehicle is detected, alert the driver.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127
NOTE: In a parking lot situation, oncoming vehicles can
be obscured by vehicles parked on either side. If the
sensors are blocked by other structures or vehicles, the
system will not be able to alert the driver.
When RCP is on and the vehicle is in REVERSE, the
driver is alerted using both the visual and audible
alarms, including reducing the radio volume.
WARNING!
RCP Detection Zones
RCP monitors the rear detection zones on both sides of
the vehicle, for objects that are moving toward the side of
the vehicle with a minimum speed of approximately
3 mph (5 km/h), to objects moving a maximum of
approximately 20 mph (32 km/h), such as in parking lot
situations.
RCP is not a Back Up Aid system. It is intended to be
used to help a driver detect an oncoming vehicle in a
parking lot situation. Drivers must be careful when
backing up, even when using RCP. Always check
carefully behind your vehicle, look behind you, and
be sure to check for pedestrians, animals, other
vehicles, obstructions, and blind spots before backing up. Failure to do so can result in serious injury or
death.
3
128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Modes Of Operation
Blind Spot Alert Lights/Chime
When operating in Blind Spot Alert Lights/Chime mode,
the BSM system will provide a visual alert in the appropriate side view mirror based on a detected object. If the
turn signal is then activated, and it corresponds to an
alert present on that side of the vehicle, an audible chime
Blind Spot Alert Lights Only
will also be sounded. Whenever a turn signal and deWhen operating in Blind Spot Alert mode, the BSM tected object are present on the same side at the same
system will provide a visual alert in the appropriate side time, both the visual and audio alerts will be issued. In
view mirror based on a detected object. However, when addition to the audible alert the radio (if on) volume will
the system is operating in Rear Cross Path mode, the be reduced.
system will respond with both visual and audible alerts
when a detected object is present. Whenever an audible NOTE:
alert is requested, the radio volume is reduced.
• Whenever an audible alert is requested by the BSM
system, the radio volume is reduced.
Three selectable modes of operation are available in the
Uconnect® System. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings/
Customer Programmable Features” in “Understanding
Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
• If the hazard flashers are on, the system will request
the appropriate visual alert only.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129
When the system is in RCP, the system shall respond with
both visual and audible alerts when a detected object is
present. Whenever an audible alert is requested, the radio
volume is reduced. Turn/hazard signal status is ignored;
the RCP state always requests the chime.
Blind Spot Alert Off
General Information
This vehicle has systems that operate on radio frequency
that comply with Part 15 of the Federal Communications
Commission (FCC) rules and with Industry Canada
Standards RSS- GEN/210/220/310.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
When the BSM system is turned off there will be no
1. The device may not cause harmful interference.
visual or audible alerts from either the BSM or RCP
2. The device must accept any interference received,
systems.
including interference that may cause undesired opNOTE: The BSM system will store the current operating
eration of the device.
mode when the vehicle is shut off. Each time the vehicle
is started the previously stored mode will be recalled and Changes or modifications to any of these systems by
other than an authorized service facility could void
used.
authorization to use this equipment.
3
130 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
SEATS
Power Seats
Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint System of the On models equipped with power seats, the switch is
vehicle.
located on the outboard side of the seat near the floor.
Use this switch to move the driver’s seat up or down,
forward or rearward or to recline the seatback.
WARNING!
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts. In a collision, people riding in these areas are
more likely to be seriously injured or killed.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 131
WARNING!
Power Seat Switches
1 — Seat Control
2 — Seatback Control — (If Equipped)
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
3
132 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not place any article under a power seat or impede
its ability to move as it may cause damage to the seat
controls. Seat travel may become limited if movement
is stopped by an obstruction in the seat’s path.
Adjusting The Seat Forward Or Rearward
The seat can be adjusted both forward and rearward.
Push the seat switch forward or rearward, the seat will
move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch
when the desired position has been reached.
Adjusting The Seat Up Or Down
The height of the seats can be adjusted up or down. Pull
upward or push downward on the seat switch, the seat
will move in the direction of the switch. Release the
switch when the desired position is reached.
Tilting The Seat Up Or Down
The angle of the seat cushion can be adjusted in four
directions. Pull upward or push downward on the front
or rear of the seat switch, the front or rear of the seat
cushion will move in the direction of the switch. Release
the switch when the desired position is reached.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 133
Reclining The Seatback
WARNING! (Continued)
The angle of the seatback can be adjusted forward or
rearward. Push the seatback switch forward or rearward,
the seat will move in the direction of the switch. Release
the switch when the desired position is reached.
WARNING!
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
(Continued)
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
CAUTION!
Do not place any article under a power seat or impede
its ability to move as it may cause damage to the seat
controls. Seat travel may become limited if movement
is stopped by an obstruction in the seat’s path.
3
134 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Power Lumbar — If Equipped
Vehicles equipped with power driver or passenger seats
may also be equipped with power lumbar. The power
lumbar switch is located on the outboard side of the
power seat. Push the switch forward or rearward to
increase or decrease the lumbar support. Push the switch
upward or downward to raise or lower the lumbar
support.
Power Lumbar Switch
Heated Seats — If Equipped
On some models, the front and rear seats may be
equipped with heaters in both the seat cushions and
seatbacks.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 135
The front driver and passenger heated seats are operated Front Heated Seats
using the Uconnect® System.
The front heated seats control buttons are located within
the climate or controls screen of the touchscreen.
WARNING!
• Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes,
spinal cord injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion or other physical condition must exercise care
when using the seat heater. It may cause burns
even at low temperatures, especially if used for
long periods of time.
• Do not place anything on the seat or seatback that
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion.
This may cause the seat heater to overheat. Sitting
in a seat that has been overheated could cause
serious burns due to the increased surface temperature of the seat.
You can choose from HI, LO or OFF heat settings. The
indicator lights in each switch indicate the level of heat in
use. Two indicator lights will illuminate for HI, one for
LO and none for OFF.
• Press the heated seat button
setting ON.
once to turn the HI
• Press the heated seat button
the LO setting ON.
a second time to turn
• Press the heated seat button
the heating elements OFF.
a third time to turn
If the HI-level setting is selected, the system will automatically switch to LO-level after approximately 60 minutes of continuous operation. At that time, the display
3
136 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
will change from HI to LO, indicating the change. The Rear Heated Seats
LO-level setting will turn OFF automatically after ap- On some models, the two outboard seats are equipped
proximately 45 minutes.
with heated seats. The heated seat switches for these
seats are located on the rear of the center console. There
NOTE:
that allow the rear
are two heated seat switches
• Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt within passengers to operate the seats independently.
two to five minutes.
You can choose from HI, LO or OFF heat settings. The
• The engine must be running for the heated seats to indicator lights in each switch indicate the level of heat in
operate.
use. Two indicator lights will illuminate for HI, one for
LO and none for OFF.
Vehicles Equipped With Remote Start
once to select HI-level
On models that are equipped with remote start, the • Press the heated seat button
heating.
heated seats can be programed to come on during a
remote start.
• Press the heated seat button
a second time to
select LO-level heating.
This feature can be programmed through the Uconnect®
system. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understand- • Press the heated seat button
a third time to turn
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
the heating elements OFF.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 137
NOTE:
Front Ventilated Seats — If Equipped
• Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt within Located in the seat cushion and seat back are small fans
that draw the air from the passenger compartment and
two to five minutes.
move air through fine perforations in the seat cover to
• The engine must be running for the heated seats to help keep the driver and front passenger cooler in higher
operate.
ambient temperatures. The fans operate at two speeds,
When the HI-level setting is selected, the heater will HI and LO.
provide a boosted heat level during the first four minutes The front ventilated seats control buttons are located
of operation. Then, the heat output will drop to the within the Uconnect® system. You can gain access to the
normal HI-level. If the HI-level setting is selected, the control buttons through the climate screen or the controls
system will automatically switch to LO-level after ap- screen.
proximately 60 minutes of continuous operation. At that
once to choose HI.
time, the number of illuminated LEDs changes from two • Press the ventilated seat button
to one, indicating the change. The LO-level setting will • Press the ventilated seat button
a second time to
turn OFF automatically after approximately 45 minutes.
choose LO.
• Press the ventilated seat button
turn the ventilated seat OFF.
a third time to
3
138 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The engine must be running for the ventilated
seats to operate.
Vehicles Equipped With Remote Start
On models that are equipped with remote start, the
ventilated seats can be programed to come on during a
remote start.
WARNING!
The head restraints for all occupants must be properly adjusted prior to operating the vehicle or occupying a seat. Head restraints should never be adjusted while the vehicle is in motion. Driving a
vehicle with the head restraints improperly adjusted
or removed could cause serious injury or death in the
event of a collision.
This feature can be programmed through the Uconnect®
system. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
Reactive Head Restraints — Front Seats
Head Restraints
The front driver and passenger seats are equipped with
Head restraints are designed to reduce the risk of injury Reactive Head Restraints (RHR). In the event of a rear
by restricting head movement in the event of a rear impact the RHRs will automatically extend forward
impact. Head restraints should be adjusted so that the top minimizing the gap between the back of the occupants
of the head restraint is located above the top of your ear. head and the RHR.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 139
The RHRs will automatically return to their normal
position following a rear impact. If the RHRs do not
return to their normal position see your authorized
dealer immediately.
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head
restraint. To lower the head restraint, press the adjustment button, located at the base of the head restraint, and
push downward on the head restraint.
NOTE: To remove the head restraint, raise it as far as it
can go then push the release button and the adjustment
button at the base of each post while pulling the head
Adjustment Button
restraint up. To reinstall the head restraint, put the head
restraint posts into the holes and push downward. Then 1 — Release Button
adjust the head restraint to the appropriate height.
2 — Adjustment Button
3
140 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• A loose head restraint thrown forward in a collision or hard stop could cause serious injury or
death to occupants of the vehicle. Always securely
stow removed head restraints in a location outside
the occupant compartment.
• ALL the head restraints MUST be reinstalled in the
vehicle to properly protect the occupants. Follow
the re-installation instructions above prior to operating the vehicle or occupying a seat.
• Do not place items over the top of the Reactive
Head Restraint, such as coats, seat covers or portable DVD players. These items may interfere with
the operation of the Reactive Head Restraint in the
event of a collision and could result in serious
injury or death.
Rear Head Restraints
The center head restraint has two adjustable positions, up
or down. When the center seat is being occupied the head
restraint should be in the raised position. When there are
no occupants in the center seat the head restraint can be
lowered for maximum visibility for the driver.
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head
restraint. To lower the head restraint, press the adjustment button, located at the base of the head restraint, and
push downward on the head restraint.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 141
Folding Rear Seat
The rear seatbacks can be folded forward to provide an
additional storage area. To fold the rear seatback, pull on
the loops located on the upper seatback.
NOTE: These loops can be tucked away when not in use.
Adjustment Button
NOTE:
• The head restraint should only be removed by qualified
technicians, for service purposes only. If the center rear
head restraints requires removal, see your authorized
dealer.
• The outboard head restraints are not adjustable.
Rear Seatback Loop
3
142 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
After releasing the seatback, it can be folded forward.
WARNING!
• Be certain that the seatback is securely locked into
position. If the seatback is not securely locked into
position, the seat will not provide the proper stability for child seats and/or passengers. An improperly latched seat could cause serious injury.
• The cargo area in the rear of the vehicle (with the
rear seatbacks in the locked-up or folded down
position) should not be used as a play area by
children when the vehicle is in motion. They could
be seriously injured in a collision. Children should
be seated and using the proper restraint system.
Folded Rear Seatback
When the seatback is folded to the upright position, make
sure it is latched by strongly pulling on the top of the
seatback above the seat strap.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 143
The memory seat switch is located on the driver’s door
trim panel. The switch consists of three buttons: The (S)
This feature allows the driver to store up to two different
button, which is used to activate the memory save
memory profiles for easy recall through a memory
function and the (1) and (2) buttons which are used to
switch. Each memory profile contains desired position
recall either of two pre-programmed memory profiles.
settings for the driver seat, side mirrors, adjustable
pedals (if equipped), and power tilt and telescopic steering column (if equipped) and a set of desired radio
station presets. Your Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter can also be programmed to recall the same positions when the UNLOCK button is pressed.
DRIVER MEMORY SEAT — IF EQUIPPED
NOTE:
• Only one RKE transmitter can be linked to each of the
memory positions.
• Passive Entry door handles cannot be linked to the
memory function. Use either the memory recall switch
or the RKE transmitter (if linked to the memory
feature) to recall memory positions 1 or 2.
Memory Seat Switch
3
144 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Programming The Memory Feature
To create a new memory profile, perform the following:
Linking And Unlinking The Remote Keyless Entry
Transmitter To Memory
Your RKE transmitters can be programmed to recall one
of two pre-programmed memory profiles by pressing the
2. Adjust all memory profile settings to desired prefer- UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter.
ences (i.e., seat, side mirror, adjustable pedals [if
NOTE: Before programming your RKE transmitters you
equipped], power tilt and telescopic steering column
must select the “Memory To FOB” feature through the
[if equipped], and radio station presets).
Uconnect® system screen. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings”
3. Press and release the S (Set) button on the memory in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further
information.
switch.
1. Place the ignition into the RUN position.
4. Within five seconds, press and release either of the To program your RKE transmitters, perform the followmemory buttons (1) or (2). The Driver Information ing:
Display (DID) will display which memory position 1. Cycle the vehicles ignition to the Off position.
has been set.
2. Select desired memory profile (1) or (2). The system
NOTE: Memory profiles can be set without the vehicle
will recall any stored settings for this profile. Wait for
in PARK, but the vehicle must be in PARK to recall a
the system to complete the memory recall before
memory profile.
continuing to Step 3.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 145
NOTE: If a memory profile has not already been set, Memory Position Recall
refer to ⬙Programming The Memory Feature⬙ in this
NOTE: The vehicle must be in PARK to recall memory
section for instructions on how to set a memory profile.
positions. If a recall is attempted when the vehicle is not
3. Once the profile has been recalled, press and release in PARK, a message will display in the DID (if equipped).
the SET (S) button on the memory switch, then press To recall the memory settings for driver one, press
and release button (1) or (2) accordingly. “Memory MEMORY button number (1) on the driver’s door or the
Profile Set” (1 or 2) will display in the instrument UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter linked to
cluster.
memory position 1.
4. Press and release the LOCK button on the RKE To recall the memory setting for driver two, press
transmitter within 10 seconds.
MEMORY button number (2) on the driver’s door or the
NOTE: Your RKE transmitters can be unlinked to your UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter linked to
memory settings by pressing the SET (S) button, and memory position 2.
within 10 seconds, followed by pressing the UNLOCK A recall can be cancelled by pressing any of the MEMORY
button on the RKE transmitter.
buttons (S, 1, or 2) on the driver’s door during a recall. When
a recall is cancelled, the driver seat, adjustable pedals (if
equipped), and power tilt and telescopic steering column (if
equipped) stop moving. A delay of one second will occur
before another recall can be selected.
3
146 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• The Easy Entry/Easy Exit feature is disabled when the
driver seat position is less than 0.9 in (22.7 mm)
This feature provides automatic driver seat positioning to
forward of the rear stop. At this position, there is no
enhance driver mobility when entering and exiting the
benefit to the driver by moving the seat for Easy Exit
vehicle.
or Easy Entry.
The distance the driver seat moves depends on where
Each stored memory setting will have an associated Easy
you have the driver seat positioned when you cycle the
Entry and Easy Exit position.
vehicles ignition to the OFF position.
NOTE: The Easy Entry/Exit feature is not enabled when
• When you cycle the vehicles ignition to the OFF
the vehicle is delivered from the factory. The Easy
position, the driver seat will move about 2.4 in
Entry/Exit feature is enabled (or later disabled) through
(60 mm) rearward if the driver seat position is greater
the programmable features in the Uconnect® system.
than or equal to 2.7 in (67.7 mm) forward of the rear
Refer to “Uconnect® Settings/Customer Programmable
stop. The seat will return to its previously set position
Features” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
when you cycle the vehicles ignition to the ACC or
further information.
RUN position.
Easy Entry/Exit Seat
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 147
TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD
Two latches must be released to open the hood.
2. Move to the outside of the vehicle and push the safety
catch to the left. The safety catch is located under the
center front edge of the hood.
1. Pull the hood release lever located under the left side
of the instrument panel.
3
Hood Safety Latch
Hood Release Lever
Use the hood prop rod (if equipped) to secure the hood in
the open position.
148 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
To prevent possible damage, do not slam the hood to
close it. Lower the hood until it is open approximately 6 in (15 cm), and then drop it. This should
secure both latches. Never drive your vehicle unless
the hood is fully closed, with both latches engaged.
WARNING!
Be sure the hood is fully latched before driving your
vehicle. If the hood is not fully latched, it could open
when the vehicle is in motion and block your vision.
Failure to follow this warning could result in serious
injury or death.
LIGHTS
Headlight Switch
The headlight switch is located on the left side of
the instrument panel. This switch controls the
operation of the headlights, parking lights, instrument panel lights, instrument panel light dimming, interior lights and fog lights.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 149
Automatic Headlights — If Equipped
This system automatically turns the headlights on or off
according to ambient light levels. To turn the system on,
rotate the headlight switch counterclockwise to the
AUTO position. When the system is on, the headlight
time delay feature is also on. This means the headlights
will stay on for up to 90 seconds after you place the
ignition into the OFF position. To turn the automatic
system off, move the headlight switch out of the AUTO
position.
Headlight Switch
Rotate the headlight switch clockwise to the first detent
for parking light and instrument panel light operation.
Rotate the headlight switch to the second detent for
headlight, parking light and instrument panel light operation.
NOTE: The engine must be running before the headlights
will come on in the automatic mode.
3
150 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To activate the delay feature, place the ignition in the OFF
position while the headlights are still on. Then, turn off
the headlights within 45 seconds. The delay interval
When this feature is active, the headlights will turn on
begins when the headlight switch is turned off.
after the wipers are turned on if the headlight switch is
placed in the AUTO position and programmable feature If you turn the headlights or parking lights on, or place
is set to ON. In addition, the headlights will turn off the ignition in ACC or RUN, the system will cancel the
when the wipers are turned off if they were turned on by delay.
this feature.
If you turn the headlights off before the ignition, they will
Headlights On With Wipers (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only)
NOTE: The Headlights On with Wipers feature can be turn off in the normal manner.
turned on or off using the Uconnect® System. Refer to NOTE:
“Uconnect® Settings/Customer Programmable Features” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for • The lights must be turned off within 45 seconds of
placing the ignition in the OFF position to activate this
further information.
feature.
Headlight Time Delay
• The headlight delay time is programmable using the
This feature provides the safety of headlight illumination
Uconnect® System, refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in
for up to 90 seconds (programmable) when leaving your
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further
vehicle in an unlit area.
information.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 151
If the windshield or Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control mirror is replaced, the mirror must be re-aimed to ensure
The Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control system pro- proper performance. See your local authorized dealer.
vides increased forward lighting at night by automating To Activate
high beam control through the use of a digital camera
mounted on the windshield. This camera detects vehicle 1. Turn the headlight switch to the AUTO headlight
position.
specific light and automatically switches from high beams to
low beams until the approaching vehicle is out of view.
2. Push the multifunction lever away from you (toward
front of vehicle) to engage the high beam mode.
NOTE:
Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control — If
Equipped
• The Automatic High Beam Headlamp Control can be NOTE: This system will not activate until the vehicle is
turned on or off using the Uconnect® System. Refer to at or above 15 mph (24 km/h).
“Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instru- To Deactivate
ment Panel” for further information.
1. Pull the multifunction lever toward you (or rearward
• Broken, muddy, or obstructed headlights and taillights
in car) to manually deactivate the system (normal
of vehicles in the field of view will cause headlights to
operation of low beams).
remain on longer (closer to the vehicle). Also, dirt, film,
and other obstructions on the windshield or camera 2. Push back on the multifunction lever once again to
reactivate the system.
lens will cause the system to function improperly.
3
152 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Adaptive Bi-Xenon High Intensity Discharge
Headlights — If Equipped
Daytime Running Lights (DRL)
The LED Daytime Running Lights will come on when the
This system automatically swivels the headlight beam engine starts, headlights are off, and the parking brake is
pattern horizontally to provide increased illumination in off. The headlight switch must be used for normal
the direction the vehicle is steering.
nighttime driving.
NOTE: If allowed by law in the country in which the
vehicle was purchased the Daytime Running Lights can
• Each time the Adaptive Headlight System is turned on,
be turned on and off using the Uconnect® System, refer
the headlights will initialize by performing a brief
to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrusequence of rotations.
ment Panel” for further information.
• The Adaptive Headlight System is active only when
Lights-On Reminder
the vehicle is moving forward.
If the headlights or parking lights are on after the ignition
The Adaptive Headlight System can be turned On or Off
is placed in the OFF position, a chime will sound to alert
using the Uconnect® System, refer to “Uconnect® Setthe driver when the driver’s door is opened.
tings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
NOTE:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 153
To activate the front fog lights, turn on the parking
lights or the low beam headlights and press the
Front Fog Lights — If Equipped
headlight switch. To turn off the front fog lights, either
The front fog light switch is built into the headlight press the headlight switch a second time or turn off the
switch.
headlight switch.
Fog Lights — If Equipped
NOTE: The fog lights will operate with the low beam
headlights or parking lights on. However, selecting the
high beam headlights will turn off the fog lights.
Fog Light Switch
3
154 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Multifunction Lever
Turn Signals
The multifunction lever controls the operation of the turn Move the multifunction lever up or down and the arrows
signals, headlight beam selection and passing lights. The on each side of the instrument cluster flash to show
multifunction lever is located on the left side of the proper operation of the front and rear turn signal lights.
steering column.
NOTE:
• If either light remains on and does not flash, or there is
a very fast flash rate, check for a defective outside light
bulb. If an indicator fails to light when the lever is
moved, it would suggest that the indicator bulb is
defective.
• A “Turn Signal On” message will appear in the Driver
Information Display (DID) and a continuous chime
will sound if the vehicle is driven more than 1 mile
(1.6 km) with either turn signal on.
Multifunction Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 155
Lane Change Assist
Front Map/Reading Lights — If Equipped
Tap the lever up or down once, without moving beyond The front map/reading lights are mounted in the overthe detent, and the turn signal (right or left) will flash head console.
three times then automatically turn off.
High/Low Beam Switch
Push the multifunction lever away from you to switch
the headlights to high beam. Pull the multifunction lever
toward you to switch the headlights back to low beam.
Flash-To-Pass
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by
lightly pulling the multifunction lever toward you. This
will turn on the high beams headlights until the lever is
released.
Front Map/Reading Lights
3
156 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Each light can be turned on by pressing a switch on either
side of the console. These buttons are backlit for night
time visibility. To turn the lights off, press the switch a
second time. The lights will also turn on when the
UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) is
pressed.
Courtesy Lights
The courtesy lights can be turned on by pressing the top
corner of the lens. To turn the lights off, press the lens a
second time.
Courtesy Lights
Front Map/Reading Light Switches
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 157
Ambient Light — If Equipped
Interior Lights
The overhead console is equipped with an ambient light The interior lights come on when a door is opened.
feature. This light casts illumination for improved visibilTo protect the battery, the interior lights will turn off
ity of the floor and center console area.
automatically 10 minutes after the ignition is moved to
the LOCK position. This will occur if the interior lights
were switched on manually or are on because a door is
open. This includes the glove box light and the trunk
light. To restore interior light operation, either place the
ignition in the ON/RUN position or cycle the light
switch.
Ambient Light
3
158 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
With the parking lights or headlights on, rotating the left
The dimmer control is part of the headlight switch and is dimmer control upward will increase the brightness of
the instrument panel lights and lighted cupholders (if
located on the left side of the instrument panel.
equipped).
Dimmer Controls
Dimmer Controls
Instrument Panel Dimmer
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 159
Ambient Light Control
Dome Light Position
Rotate the right dimmer control upward or downward to Rotate the left dimmer control completely upward to the
increase or decrease the brightness of the door handle second detent to turn on the interior lights. The interior
lights and ambient light located in the overhead console. lights will remain on when the dimmer control is in this
position.
Interior Light Defeat (OFF)
Rotate the left dimmer control to the extreme bottom
“OFF” position. The interior lights will remain off when
the doors are open.
Parade Mode (Daytime Brightness Feature)
Rotate the instrument panel dimmer control upward to
the first detent. This feature brightens all text displays
such as the odometer, Driver Information Display (DID),
and radio when the position lights or headlights are on.
Door Handle/Ambient Light Dimmer
3
160 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS
Intermittent Wiper System
The multifunction lever operates the windshield wipers
and washer when the ignition is placed in the ON/RUN
or ACC position. The multifunction lever is located on
the left side of the steering column.
Use the intermittent wiper when weather conditions
make a single wiping cycle with a variable pause between cycles desirable. Rotate the end of the multifunction lever to the first detent position, and then turn the
end of the lever to select the desired delay interval. There
are four delay settings, which allow you to regulate the
wipe interval from a minimum of one cycle every second
to a maximum of approximately 36 seconds between
cycles. The delay intervals will double in duration when
the vehicle speed is 10 mph (16 km/h) or less.
Wiper Operation
Rotate the end of the multifunction lever to the first
detent, past the intermittent settings for low-speed wiper
operation, or to the second detent past the intermittent
settings for high-speed wiper operation.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Control
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 161
CAUTION!
• Turn the windshield wipers off when driving
through an automatic car wash. Damage to the
windshield wipers may result if the wiper control
is left in any position other than off.
• In cold weather, always turn off the wiper switch
and allow the wipers to return to the “Park” position before turning off the engine. If the wiper
switch is left on and the wipers freeze to the
windshield, damage to the wiper motor may occur
when the vehicle is restarted.
• Always remove any buildup of snow that prevents
the windshield wiper blades from returning to the
off position. If the windshield wiper control is
turned off and the blades cannot return to the off
position, damage to the wiper motor may occur.
Mist Feature
Rotate the end of the lever downward to the Mist
position to activate a single wipe cycle to clear off road
mist or spray from a passing vehicle. The wipers will
continue to operate until you release the multifunction
lever.
NOTE: The mist feature does not activate the washer
pump; therefore, no washer fluid will be sprayed on the
windshield. The wash function must be used in order to
spray the windshield with washer fluid.
Windshield Washers
To use the washer, push the multifunction lever inward
(toward the steering column) and hold it for as long as
washer spray is desired.
3
162 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
If you activate the washer while the windshield wiper
control is in the delay range, the wipers will operate for
two wipe cycles after releasing the lever and then resume
the intermittent interval previously selected.
Headlights On With Wipers (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only)
When this feature is active, the headlights will turn on
after the wipers are turned on if the headlight switch is
If you activate the washer while the windshield wiper is placed in the AUTO position and programmable feature
turned off, the wipers will operate for three wipe cycles is set to ON. In addition, the headlights will turn off
when the wipers are turned off if they were turned on by
and then turn off.
this feature.
WARNING!
Sudden loss of visibility through the windshield
could lead to a collision. You might not see other
vehicles or other obstacles. To avoid sudden icing of
the windshield during freezing weather, warm the
windshield with the defroster before and during
windshield washer use.
NOTE: The Headlights On with Wipers feature can be
turned on or off using the Uconnect® System. Refer to
“Uconnect® Settings/Customer Programmable Features” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 163
The Rain Sensing feature can be turned on and off using
This feature senses moisture on the windshield and the Uconnect® System, refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in
automatically activates the wipers for the driver. The “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further infeature is especially useful for road splash or over spray formation.
from the windshield washers of the vehicle ahead. Rotate NOTE:
the end of the multifunction lever to one of four settings
• The Rain Sensing feature will not operate when the
to activate this feature.
wiper speed is in the low or high position.
The sensitivity of the system can be adjusted with the
multifunction lever. Wiper delay position 1 is the least • The Rain Sensing feature may not function properly
when ice or dried salt water is present on the windsensitive, and wiper delay position 4 is the most sensitive.
shield.
Setting 3 should be used for normal rain conditions.
Settings 1 and 2 can be used if the driver desires less wiper • Use of Rain-X® or products containing wax or silicone
sensitivity. Setting 4 can be used if the driver desires more
may reduce rain sensor performance.
sensitivity. The rain sense wipers will automatically change
between an intermittent wipe, slow wipe and a fast wipe
depending on the amount of moisture that is sensed on the
windshield. Place the wiper switch in the OFF position
when not using the system.
Rain Sensing Wipers
3
164 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The Rain Sensing system has protective features for the • Remote Start Mode Inhibit — On vehicles equipped
wiper blades and arms. It will not operate under the
with Remote Starting system, Rain Sensing wipers are
not operational when the vehicle is in the remote start
following conditions:
mode. Once the operator is in the vehicle and has
• Low Temperature Wipe Inhibit — The Rain Sensing
placed the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position,
feature will not operate when the ignition is placed in
rain sensing wiper operation can resume, if it has been
the RUN position, the vehicle is stationary and the
selected, and no other inhibit conditions (mentioned
outside temperature is below 32°F (0°C), unless the
previously) exist.
wiper control on the multifunction lever is moved, the
vehicle speed becomes greater than 0 mph (0 km/h) or TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN
the outside temperature rises above freezing.
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
• Neutral Wipe Inhibit — The Rain Sensing feature will upward or downward. It also allows you to lengthen or
not operate when the ignition is placed in the RUN shorten the steering column. The tilt/telescoping lever is
position, the automatic transmission gear selector is in located below the steering wheel at the end of the
the NEUTRAL position and the vehicle speed is less steering column.
than 3 mph (5 km/h), unless the wiper control on the
multifunction lever is moved or the shift lever is
moved out of the NEUTRAL position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 165
To unlock the steering column, pull the lever downward.
To tilt the steering column, move the steering wheel
upward or downward as desired. To lengthen or shorten
the steering column, pull the steering wheel outward or
push it inward as desired. To lock the steering column in
position, push the lever upward until fully engaged.
WARNING!
Tilt/Telescoping Control Handle
Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
Adjusting the steering column while driving or driving with the steering column unlocked, could cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Failure to
follow this warning may result in serious injury or
death.
3
166 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
POWER TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING
COLUMN — IF EQUIPPED
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
upward or downward. It also allows you to lengthen or
shorten the steering column. The power tilt/telescoping
steering column switch is located below the multifunction lever on the steering column.
Power Tilt/Telescoping Steering Switch
To tilt the steering column, move the switch up or down
as desired. To lengthen or shorten the steering column,
pull the switch toward you or push the switch away from
you as desired.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 167
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Driver Memory Seat,
you can use your Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter or the memory switch on the driver’s door trim panel
to return the tilt/telescopic steering column to preprogrammed positions. Refer to “Driver Memory Seat”
in this section.
WARNING!
Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
Adjusting the steering column while driving or driving with the steering column unlocked, could cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Failure to
follow this warning may result in serious injury or
death.
HEATED STEERING WHEEL — IF EQUIPPED
The steering wheel contains a heating element that helps
warm your hands in cold weather. The heated steering
wheel has only one temperature setting. Once the heated
steering wheel has been turned on it will operate for up to
80 minutes before automatically shutting off. The heated
steering wheel can shut off early or may not turn on when
the steering wheel is already warm.
The heated steering wheel control button is located within
the Uconnect® system. You can gain access to the control
button through the climate screen or the controls screen.
• Press the heated steering wheel button
turn the heating element ON.
once to
• Press the heated steering wheel button
time to turn the heating element OFF.
a second
NOTE: The engine must be running for the heated
steering wheel to operate.
3
168 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Vehicles Equipped With Remote Start
WARNING! (Continued)
On models that are equipped with remote start, the
heated steering wheel can be programmed to come on
during a remote start through the Uconnect® system.
Refer to “Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your
Instrument Panel” for further information.
• Do not place anything on the steering wheel that
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or steering
wheel covers of any type and material. This may
cause the steering wheel heater to overheat.
ADJUSTABLE PEDALS — IF EQUIPPED
WARNING!
• Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes,
spinal cord injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical conditions must exercise
care when using the steering wheel heater. It may
cause burns even at low temperatures, especially if
used for long periods.
(Continued)
The adjustable pedals system is designed to allow a
greater range of driver comfort for steering wheel tilt and
seat position. This feature allows the brake and accelerator pedals to move toward or away from the driver to
provide improved position with the steering wheel.
The switch is located on the front side of the driver’s seat
cushion side shield.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 169
Press the switch rearward to move the pedals rearward
(toward the driver).
• The pedals can be adjusted with the ignition OFF.
• The pedals cannot be adjusted when the vehicle is in
REVERSE or when the Electronic Speed Control System is on. The following messages will be displayed on
vehicles equipped with the Driver Information Display (DID) if the pedals are attempted to be adjusted
when the system is locked out (“Adjustable Pedal
Disabled — Cruise Control Engaged” or “Adjustable
Pedal Disabled — Vehicle In Reverse”).
Adjustable Pedals Switch
NOTE:
Press the switch forward to move the pedals forward
• Always adjust the pedals to a position that allows full
(toward the front of the vehicle).
pedal travel.
• Further small adjustments may be necessary to find
the best possible seat/pedal position.
3
170 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• For vehicles equipped with Driver Memory Seat, you
WARNING!
can use your Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
or the memory switch on the driver’s door trim panel Do not adjust the pedals while the vehicle is moving.
to return the adjustable pedals to pre-programmed You could lose control and have an accident. Always
positions. Refer to “Driver Memory Seat” in “Under- adjust the pedals while the vehicle is parked.
standing The Features Of Your Vehicle” for further
information.
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED
CAUTION!
Do not place any article under the adjustable pedals
or impede its ability to move as it may cause damage
to the pedal controls. Pedal travel may become limited if movement is stopped by an obstruction in the
adjustable pedal’s path.
When engaged, the Electronic Speed Control takes over
accelerator operations at speeds greater than 25 mph
(40 km/h).
The Electronic Speed Control buttons are located on the
right side of the steering wheel.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 171
NOTE: In order to ensure proper operation, the Electronic Speed Control System has been designed to shut
down if multiple Speed Control functions are operated at
the same time. If this occurs, the Electronic Speed Control
System can be reactivated by pushing the Electronic
Speed Control ON/OFF button and resetting the desired
vehicle set speed.
To Activate
Electronic Speed Control Buttons
1 — ON/OFF
2 — SET+/ACCEL
3 — RESUME
4 — SET-/DECEL
5 — CANCEL
Push the ON/OFF button to activate the electronic speed
control. CRUISE CONTROL READY will appear on the
instrument cluster to indicate the electronic speed control
is on. To turn the system off, push the ON/OFF button a
second time. CRUISE CONTROL OFF will appear on the
instrument cluster to indicate the electronic speed control
is off. The system should be turned off when not in use.
3
172 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally
set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.
You could lose control and have an accident. Always
leave the system OFF when you are not using it.
To Set A Desired Speed
To Deactivate
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing the CANCEL
button, or normal brake pressure while slowing the
vehicle will deactivate the Electronic Speed Control without erasing the set speed from memory.
Pressing the ON/OFF button or turning the ignition
switch OFF erases the set speed from memory.
To Resume Speed
Turn the Electronic Speed Control ON. When the vehicle
To resume a previously set speed, push the RES (+)
has reached the desired speed, press the SET (+) or
button and release. Resume can be used at any speed
SET (-) button and release. Release the accelerator and the
above 20 mph (32 km/h).
vehicle will operate at the selected speed. Once a speed
has been set a message CRUISE CONTROL SET TO MPH
(km/h) will appear indicating what speed was set. A
CRUISE indicator lamp, along with set speed will also
appear and stay on in the instrument cluster when the
speed is set.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 173
To Vary The Speed Setting
Metric Speed (km/h)
• Pressing the SET + button once will result in a 1 km/h
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can inbutton results in an increase of 1 km/h.
crease speed by pushing the SET + button.
The drivers preferred units can be selected through the • If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
continue to increase until the button is released, then
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Underthe new set speed will be established.
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
The speed increment shown is dependant on the chosen To Decrease Speed
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can deU.S. Speed (mph)
crease speed by pushing the SET - button.
To Increase Speed
• Pressing the SET + button once will result in a 1 mph The drivers preferred units can be selected through the
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
button results in an increase of 1 mph.
• If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
continue to increase until the button is released, then
the new set speed will be established.
3
174 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The speed decrement shown is dependant on the chosen To Accelerate For Passing
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
Press the accelerator as you would normally. When the
pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.
U.S. Speed (mph)
• Pressing the SET - button once will result in a 1 mph Using Electronic Speed Control On Hills
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the The transmission may downshift on hills to maintain the
button results in a decrease of 1 mph.
vehicle set speed.
• If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will NOTE: The Electronic Speed Control system maintains
continue to decrease until the button is released, then speed up and down hills. A slight speed change on
the new set speed will be established.
moderate hills is normal.
Metric Speed (km/h)
On steep hills, a greater speed loss or gain may occur so
• Pressing the SET - button once will result in a 1 km/h it may be preferable to drive without Electronic Speed
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the Control.
button results in a decrease of 1 km/h.
• If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
continue to decrease until the button is released, then
the new set speed will be established.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 175
WARNING!
Electronic Speed Control can be dangerous where the
system cannot maintain a constant speed. Your vehicle could go too fast for the conditions, and you
could lose control and have an accident. Do not use
Electronic Speed Control in heavy traffic or on roads
that are winding, icy, snow-covered or slippery.
ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC) — IF
EQUIPPED
ACC will allow you to keep cruise control engaged in
light to moderate traffic conditions without the constant
need to reset your cruise control. ACC utilizes a radar
sensor and a forward facing camera designed to detect a
vehicle directly ahead of you.
NOTE:
• If the sensor does not detect a vehicle ahead of you,
ACC will maintain a fixed set speed.
• If the ACC sensor detects a vehicle ahead, ACC will
apply limited braking or acceleration (not to exceed
the original set speed) automatically to maintain a
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) increases the driving
preset following distance, while matching the speed of
convenience provided by cruise control while traveling
the vehicle ahead.
on highways and major roadways. However, it is not a
safety system and not designed to prevent collisions.
Electronic Speed Control function performs differently.
Please refer to the proper section within this chapter.
3
176 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The Cruise Control system has two control modes:
• Adaptive Cruise Control mode for maintaining an
appropriate distance between vehicles.
• Normal (fixed speed) electronic speed control mode
for cruising at a constant preset speed. For additional
information, refer to “Normal (Fixed Speed) Cruise
Control Mode” in this section.
NOTE: Normal (fixed speed) electronic speed control
will not react to preceding vehicles. Always be aware of
the mode selected.
You can change the mode by using the Cruise Control
buttons. The two control modes function differently.
Always confirm which mode is selected.
WARNING!
• Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is a convenience
system. It is not a substitute for active driving
involvement. It is always the driver’s responsibility
to be attentive of road, traffic, and weather conditions, vehicle speed, distance to the vehicle ahead;
and, most importantly, brake operation to ensure
safe operation of the vehicle under all road conditions. Your complete attention is always required
while driving to maintain safe control of your vehicle. Failure to follow these warnings can result in a
collision and death or serious personal injury.
• The ACC system:
• Does not react to pedestrians, oncoming vehicles,
and stationary objects (e.g., a stopped vehicle in a
traffic jam or a disabled vehicle).
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 177
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Cannot take street, traffic, and weather conditions into account, and may be limited upon
adverse sight distance conditions.
• Does not always fully recognize complex driving
conditions, which can result in wrong or missing
distance warnings.
• Will bring the vehicle to a complete stop while
following a target vehicle and hold the vehicle for 2
seconds in the stop position. If the target vehicle
does not start moving within two seconds the ACC
system will display a message that the system will
release the brakes and that the brakes must be
applied manually. An audible chime will sound
when the brakes are released.
You should switch off the ACC system:
• When driving in fog, heavy rain, heavy snow, sleet,
heavy traffic, and complex driving situations (i.e.,
in highway construction zones).
• When entering a turn lane or highway off ramp;
when driving on roads that are winding, icy, snowcovered, slippery, or have steep uphill or downhill
slopes.
• When towing a trailer up or down steep slopes.
• When circumstances do not allow safe driving at a
constant speed.
(Continued)
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Operation
The speed control buttons (located on the right side of the
steering wheel) operates the ACC system.
3
178 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Any chassis/suspension or tire size modifications
to the vehicle will effect the performance of the Adaptive
Cruise Control and Forward Collision Warning System.
Activating Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
You can only engage ACC if the vehicle speed is above
0 mph (0 km/h).
The minimum Set Speed for the ACC system is 20 mph
(32 km/h).
Adaptive Cruise Control Buttons
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
— NORMAL (FIXED SPEED) CRUISE CONTROL ON/OFF
— SET+/ACCEL
— RESUME
— SET-/DECEL
— DISTANCE SETTING — INCREASE
— ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC) ON/OFF
— DISTANCE SETTING — DECREASE
— CANCEL
When the system is turned on and in the READY state,
the Driver Information Display (DID) displays “ACC
Ready.”
When the system is OFF, the DID displays “Adaptive
Cruise Control (ACC) Off.”
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 179
NOTE: You cannot engage ACC under the following To Activate/Deactivate
conditions:
Push and release the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
ON/OFF button. The ACC menu in the DID displays
• When you apply the brakes.
“ACC Ready.”
• When the parking brake is set.
• When the automatic transmission is in PARK, REVERSE or NEUTRAL.
• When the Vehicle speed is outside of the speed range.
• When the brakes are overheated.
• When the driver door is open.
• When the driver seat belt is unbuckled.
Adaptive Cruise Control Ready
3
180 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To turn the system OFF, push and release the Adaptive
Cruise Control (ACC) ON/OFF button again. At this
time, the system will turn off and the DID will display
“Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Off.”
WARNING!
Leaving the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) system on
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally
set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.
You could lose control and have a collision. Always
leave the system off when you are not using it.
To Set A Desired ACC Speed
When the vehicle reaches the speed desired, push the
SET + button or the SET - button and release. The DID
will display the set speed.
Adaptive Cruise Control Off
If the system is Set when the vehicle speed is below
20 mph (32 km/h), the Set Speed shall be defaulted to
20 mph (32 km/h). If the system is Set when the vehicle
speed is above 20 mph (32 km/h), the Set Speed shall be
the current speed of the vehicle.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 181
NOTE: ACC cannot be set if there is a stationary vehicle • The shift lever/gear selector is removed from the
Drive position.
in front of your vehicle in close proximity.
Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. If you do • The Electronic Stability Control/Traction Control Sysnot, the vehicle may continue to accelerate beyond the set
tem (ESC/TCS) activates.
speed. If this occurs:
• The vehicle parking brake is applied.
• The message “DRIVER OVERRIDE” will display in
• Driver seatbelt is unbuckled at low speeds.
the DID.
• Driver door is opened at low speeds.
• The system will not be controlling the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead. The vehicle • The driver switches ESC to full-off mode.
speed will only be determined by the position of the
NOTE:
accelerator pedal.
• If your vehicle stays at standstill for longer than two
To Cancel
seconds, then the system will cancel and the brake
The following conditions cancel the system:
force will be ramped-out. The driver will have to apply
the brakes to keep the vehicle at a standstill.
• The brake pedal is applied.
• The CANCEL button is pressed.
• An Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) event occurs.
• ACC cannot be resumed if there is a stationary vehicle
in-front of your vehicle in close proximity.
3
182 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To Turn Off
NOTE:
The system will turn off and erase the set speed in • If your vehicle stays at standstill for longer than two
memory if:
seconds, then the system will cancel and the brake
force will be ramped-out. The driver will have to apply
• The Normal (Fixed Speed) Electronic Speed Control
the brakes to keep the vehicle at a standstill.
ON/OFF button is pressed.
• ACC cannot be resumed if there is a stationary vehicle
• The ignition is turned off.
in-front of your vehicle in close proximity.
• The Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) On/Off button is
pressed.
WARNING!
To Resume
If there is a set speed in memory press the RES (resume)
button and then remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal. The DID will display the last set speed.
The Resume function should only be used if traffic
and road conditions permit. Resuming a set speed
that is too high or too low for prevailing traffic and
road conditions could cause the vehicle to accelerate
or decelerate too sharply for safe operation. Failure to
follow these warnings can result in a collision and
death or serious personal injury.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 183
To Vary The Speed Setting
Metric Speed (km/h)
• Pressing the SET + button once will result in a 1 km/h
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
While ACC is set, you can increase the set speed by
button results in an increase of 1 km/h.
pressing the SET + button.
The drivers preferred units can be selected through the • If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
continue to increase in 10 km/h increments until the
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “ Underbutton is released. The increase in set speed is reflected
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
in the DID.
The speed increment shown is dependant on the chosen
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
To Decrease Speed
To Increase Speed
U.S. Speed (mph)
While ACC is set, the set speed can be decreased by
pressing the SET - button.
• Pressing the SET + button once will result in a 1 mph
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the The drivers preferred units can be selected through the
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “ Underbutton results in an increase of 1 mph.
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
• If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
continue to increase in 5 mph increments until the
button is released. The increase in set speed is reflected
in the DID.
3
184 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The speed decrement shown is dependant on the chosen • If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
continue to decrease in 10 km/h decrements until the
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
button is released. The decrease in set speed is reU.S. Speed (mph)
flected in the DID.
• Pressing the SET - button once will result in a 1 mph NOTE:
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
• When you override and push the SET + button or
button results in a decrease of 1 mph.
SET - buttons, the new Set Speed will be the current
• If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
speed of the vehicle.
continue to decrease in 5 mph decrements until the button
is released. The decrease in set speed is reflected in the • When you use the SET - button to decelerate, if the
DID.
engine’s braking power does not slow the vehicle
sufficiently to reach the set speed, the brake system
Metric Speed (km/h)
will automatically slow the vehicle.
• Pressing the SET - button once will result in a 1 km/h
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
button results in a decrease of 1 km/h.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 185
• The ACC system decelerates the vehicle to a full stop Using this distance setting and the vehicle speed, ACC
when following a target vehicle. If an ACC host vehicle calculates and sets the distance to the vehicle ahead. This
follows a target vehicle to a standstill, after two distance setting displays in the DID.
seconds the driver will either have to press the RES
(resume) button, or apply the accelerator pedal to
reengage the ACC to the existing Set Speed.
• The ACC system maintains set speed when driving up
hill and down hill. However, a slight speed change on
moderate hills is normal. In addition, downshifting
may occur while climbing uphill or descending downhill. This is normal operation and necessary to maintain set speed. When driving up hill and down hill, the
ACC system will cancel if the braking temperature
exceeds normal range (overheated).
Setting The Following Distance In ACC
The specified following distance for ACC can be set by
varying the distance setting between four bars (longest),
three bars (long), two bars (medium) and one bar (short).
Distance Setting 4 Bars (Longest)
3
186 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Distance Setting 3 Bars (Long)
Distance Setting 2 Bars (Medium)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 187
To decrease the distance setting, press the Distance
Setting — Decrease button and release. Each time the
button is pressed, the distance setting decreases by one
bar (shorter).
If there is no vehicle ahead, the vehicle will maintain the
set speed. If a slower moving vehicle is detected in the
same lane, the DID displays the “Sensed Vehicle Indicator” icon, and the system adjusts vehicle speed automatically to maintain the distance setting, regardless of the set
speed.
The vehicle will then maintain the set distance until:
Distance Setting 1 Bar (Short)
• The vehicle ahead accelerates to a speed above the set
To increase the distance setting, press the Distance Setspeed.
ting — Increase button and release. Each time the button
is pressed, the distance setting increases by one bar • The vehicle ahead moves out of your lane or view of
the sensor.
(longer).
3
188 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• The distance setting is changed.
• The system disengages. (Refer to the information on
ACC Activation).
The maximum braking applied by ACC is limited; however, the driver can always apply the brakes manually, if
necessary.
NOTE: The brake lights will illuminate whenever the
ACC system applies the brakes.
A Proximity Warning will alert the driver if ACC predicts
that its maximum braking level is not sufficient to
maintain the set distance. If this occurs, a visual alert
Brake Alert
“BRAKE” will flash in the DID and a chime will sound NOTE: The “Brake!” Screen in the DID is a warning for
while ACC continues to apply its maximum braking the driver to take action and does not necessarily mean
capacity.
that the Forward Collision Warning system is applying
the brakes autonomously.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 189
If the target vehicle does not start moving within two
seconds of your vehicle coming to a standstill, the ACC with
When driving with ACC engaged and following a Target
Stop system will cancel and the brakes will release. A cancel
vehicle, the system will provide an additional acceleramessage will display on the DID and produce a warning
tion to assist in passing vehicles in front. This additional
chime. Driver intervention will be required at this moment.
acceleration is triggered when the driver utilizes the left
or right turn signal. The Overtake Aid will only provide While ACC with Stop is holding your vehicle at a
additional acceleration if the vehicle moves with the standstill, if the driver seatbelt is unbuckled or the driver
corresponding turn signal and until the current set speed door is opened, the ACC with Stop system will cancel
is reached. The ACC system will automatically detect and the brakes will release. A cancel message will display
traffic direction in the respective lane when the right or on the DID and produce a warning chime. Driver intervention will be required at this moment.
left turn signal is utilized.
Overtake Aid
ACC Operation At Stop
If the ACC system brings your vehicle to a standstill
while following a target vehicle, if the target vehicle starts
moving within two seconds of your vehicle coming to a
standstill, your vehicle will resume motion without the
need for any driver action.
WARNING!
When the ACC system is resumed, the driver must
ensure that there are no pedestrians, vehicles or
objects in the path of the vehicle. Failure to follow
these warnings can result in a collision and death or
serious personal injury.
3
190 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Menu
Press the SET + or the SET- button (located on the
steering wheel) and the following will display in the DID:
The DID displays the current ACC system settings. The
DID is located in the center of the instrument cluster. The ACC SET
information it displays depends on ACC system status.
When ACC is set, the set speed will display in the
Press the ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC) ON/ instrument cluster.
OFF button (located on the steering wheel) until one of
The ACC screen may display once again if any ACC
the following displays in the DID:
activity occurs, which may include any of the following:
Adaptive Cruise Control Off
• System Cancel
When ACC is deactivated, the display will read “Adap• Driver Override
tive Cruise Control Off.”
• System Off
Adaptive Cruise Control Ready
When ACC is activated but the vehicle speed setting has • ACC Proximity Warning
not been selected, the display will read “Adaptive Cruise • ACC Unavailable Warning
Control Ready.”
• The DID will return to the last display selected after
five seconds of no ACC display activity
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 191
highly reflective areas (i.e. tunnels with reflective tiles, or
ice and snow). The ACC system will recover after the
“Wipe Front Radar Sensor In Front Of Vehicle”
vehicle has left these areas. Under rare conditions, when
Warning
the radar is not tracking any vehicles or objects in its path
The “ACC/FCW Unavailable Wipe Front Radar Sensor” this warning may temporarily occur.
warning will display and also a chime will indicate when
NOTE: If the “ACC/FCW Unavailable Wipe Front Radar
conditions temporarily limit system performance.
Sensor” warning is active Normal (Fixed Speed) Cruise
This most often occurs at times of poor visibility, such as Control is still available. For additional information refer
in snow or heavy rain. The ACC system may also become to “Normal (Fixed Speed) Cruise Control Mode” in this
temporarily blinded due to obstructions, such as mud, section.
dirt or ice. In these cases, the DID will display “ACC/
FCW Unavailable Wipe Front Radar Sensor” and the If weather conditions are not a factor, the driver should
examine the sensor. It may require cleaning or removal of
system will deactivate.
an obstruction. The sensor is located in the center of the
The “ACC/FCW Unavailable Wipe Front Radar Sensor” vehicle behind the lower grille.
message can sometimes be displayed while driving in
Display Warnings And Maintenance
3
192 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To keep the ACC System operating properly, it is impor- When the condition that deactivated the system is no
tant to note the following maintenance items:
longer present, the system will return to the “Adaptive
Cruise Control Off” state and will resume function by
• Always keep the sensor clean. Carefully wipe the
simply reactivating it.
sensor lens with a soft cloth. Be cautious not to damage
the sensor lens.
NOTE:
• Do not remove any screws from the sensor. Doing so • If the “ACC/FCW Unavailable Wipe Front Radar
could cause an ACC system malfunction or failure and
Sensor” message occurs frequently (e.g. more than
require a sensor realignment.
once on every trip) without any snow, rain, mud, or
other obstruction, have the radar sensor realigned at
• If the sensor or front end of the vehicle is damaged due
your authorized dealer.
to a collision, see your authorized dealer for service.
• Installing a snow plow, front-end protector, an after• Do not attach or install any accessories near the sensor,
market grille or modifying the grille is not recomincluding transparent material or aftermarket grilles.
mended. Doing so may block the sensor and inhibit
Doing so could cause an ACC system failure or
ACC/FCW operation.
malfunction.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 193
Under rare conditions, when the camera is not tracking
any vehicles or objects in its path this warning may
The “ACC/FCW Limited Functionality Clean Front
temporarily occur.
Windshield” warning will display and also a chime will
indicate when conditions temporarily limit system per- If weather conditions are not a factor, the driver should
formance. This most often occurs at times of poor visibil- examine the windshield and the camera located on the
ity, such as in snow or heavy rain and fog. The ACC back side of the inside rear view mirror. They may
system may also become temporarily blinded due to require cleaning or removal of an obstruction.
obstructions, such as mud, dirt, or ice on windshield and
When the condition that created limited functionality is
fog on the inside of glass. In these cases, the DID will
no longer present, the system will return to full functiondisplay “ACC/FCW Limited Functionality Clean Front
ality.
Windshield” and the system will have degraded performance.
NOTE: If the “ACC/FCW Limited Functionality Clean
Front Windshield” message occurs frequently (e.g. more
The “ACC/FCW Limited Functionality Clean Front
than once on every trip) without any snow, rain, mud, or
Windshield” message can sometimes be displayed while
other obstruction, have the windshield and forward
driving in adverse weather conditions. The ACC/FCW
facing camera inspected at your authorized dealer.
system will recover after the vehicle has left these areas.
“Clean Front Windshield” Warning
3
194 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Service ACC/FCW Warning
If the system turns off, and the DID displays “ACC/FCW
Unavailable Service Required” or “Cruise/FCW Unavailable Service Required”, there may be an internal system
fault or a temporary malfunction that limits ACC functionality. Although the vehicle is still drivable under
normal conditions, ACC will be temporarily unavailable.
If this occurs, try activating ACC again later, following an
ignition cycle. If the problem persists, see your authorized dealer.
Offset Driving
ACC may not detect a vehicle in the same lane that is offset
from your direct line of travel, or a vehicle merging in from
a side lane. There may not be sufficient distance to the
vehicle ahead. The offset vehicle may move in and out of the
line of travel, which can cause your vehicle to brake or
accelerate unexpectedly.
Precautions While Driving With ACC
In certain driving situations, ACC may have detection
issues. In these cases, ACC may brake late or unexpectedly. The driver needs to stay alert and may need to
intervene.
Towing A Trailer
Towing a trailer is not advised when using ACC.
Offset Driving Condition Example
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 195
Turns And Bends
When driving on a curve with ACC engaged, the system
may decrease the vehicle speed and acceleration for
stability reasons, with no target vehicle detected. Once
the vehicle is out of the curve the system will resume
your original Set Speed. This is a part of normal ACC
system functionality.
3
NOTE: On tight turns ACC performance may be limited.
Turn Or Bend Example
196 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Using ACC On Hills
Lane Changing
When driving on hills, ACC may not detect a vehicle in
your lane. Depending on the speed, vehicle load, traffic
conditions, and the steepness of the hills, ACC performance may be limited.
ACC may not detect a vehicle until it is completely in the
lane in which you are traveling. In the illustration shown,
ACC has not yet detected the vehicle changing lanes and
it may not detect the vehicle until it’s too late for the ACC
system to take action. ACC may not detect a vehicle until
it is completely in the lane. There may not be sufficient
distance to the lane-changing vehicle. Always be attentive and ready to apply the brakes if necessary.
ACC Hill Example
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 197
Narrow Vehicles
Some narrow vehicles traveling near the outer edges of
the lane or edging into the lane are not detected until they
have moved fully into the lane. There may not be
sufficient distance to the vehicle ahead.
Lane Changing Example
Narrow Vehicle Example
3
198 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Stationary Objects And Vehicles
General Information
ACC does not react to stationary objects and stationary
vehicles. For example, ACC will not react in situations
where the vehicle you are following exits your lane and
the vehicle ahead is stopped in your lane. Always be
attentive and ready to apply the brakes if necessary.
This vehicle has systems that operate on radio frequency
that comply with Part 15 of the Federal Communications
Commission (FCC) rules and with Industry Canada
Standards RSS- GEN/210/220/310.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1. The device may not cause harmful interference.
2. The device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
Changes or modifications to any of these systems by
other than an authorized service facility could void
authorization to use this equipment.
Stationary Object And Stationary Vehicle Example
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 199
Normal (Fixed Speed) Electronic Speed Control
Mode
In addition to Adaptive Cruise Control mode, a Normal
(Fixed Speed) Electronic Speed Control mode is available
for cruising at fixed speeds. The Normal (Fixed Speed)
Electronic Speed Control mode is designed to maintain a
set cruising speed without requiring the driver to operate
the accelerator. Electronic Speed Control can only be
operated if the vehicle speed is above 20 mph (32 km/h).
WARNING!
In the normal Cruise Control mode, the system will not
react to vehicles ahead. In addition, the proximity warning does not activate and no alarm will sound even if
you are too close to the vehicle ahead since neither the
presence of the vehicle ahead nor the vehicle-to vehicle
distance is detected. Be sure to maintain a safe distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead. Always be
aware which mode is selected.
To change between the different control modes, press the
ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC) ON/OFF button To Set A Desired Speed
which turns the ACC and the NORMAL (Fixed Speed)
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL OFF. Pressing of the
Turn the Normal (Fixed Speed) Electronic
NORMAL (Fixed Speed) ELECTRONIC SPEED CONSpeed Control ON. When the vehicle has
TROL ON/OFF button will result in turning ON (changreached the desired speed, press the SET (+) or
ing to) the Normal (Fixed Speed) Electronic Speed ConSET (-) button and release. Release the acceltrol mode.
erator and the vehicle will operate at the selected speed.
3
200 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Once a speed has been set a message (CRUISE CON- The speed increment shown is dependant on the speed of
TROL SET TO MPH/KM) will appear indicating what U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h) units:
speed was set. This light will turn on when the electronic
U.S. Speed (mph)
speed control is SET.
• Pressing the SET + button once will result in a 1 mph
To Vary The Speed Setting
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
To Increase Speed
button results in an increase of 1 mph.
When the Normal (Fixed Speed) Electronic Speed Con- • If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
trol is set, you can increase speed by pressing the SET +
continue to increase in 5 mph increments until the
button.
button is released. The increase in set speed is reflected
in the DID display.
The drivers preferred units can be selected through the
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Under- Metric Speed (km/h)
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
• Pressing the SET + button once will result in a 1 km/h
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
button results in an increase of 1 km/h.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 201
• If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will • If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
continue to increase in 10 km/h increments until the
continue to decrease in 5 mph decrements until the
button is released. The decrease in set speed is rebutton is released. The increase in set speed is reflected
flected in the DID display.
in the DID display.
To Decrease Speed
Metric Speed (km/h)
When the Normal (Fixed Speed) Cruise Control is set, • Pressing the SET - button once will result in a 1 km/h
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
you can decrease speed by pressing the SET - button.
button results in a decrease of 1 km/h.
The drivers preferred units can be selected through the
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Under- • If the button is continually pressed, the set speed will
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
continue to decrease in 10 km/h decrements until the
button is released. The decrease in set speed is reThe speed decrement shown is dependant on the speed
flected in the DID display.
of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h) units:
U.S. Speed (mph)
• Pressing the SET - button once will result in a 1 mph
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
button results in a decrease of 1 mph.
3
202 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To Cancel
To Resume Speed
The following conditions will cancel the Normal (Fixed To resume a previously set speed, push the RES button
Speed) Electronic Speed Control without clearing the and release. Resume can be used at any speed above
memory:
20 mph (32 km/h).
• The brake pedal is applied.
To Turn Off
• The CANCEL button is pressed.
The system will turn off and erase the set speed in
memory if:
• The Electronic Stability Control/Traction Control Sys• The Normal (Fixed Speed) Electronic Speed Control
tem (ESC/TCS) activates.
ON/OFF button is pressed.
• The vehicle parking brake is applied.
• The ignition is turned off.
• The braking temperature exceeds normal range (over• The Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) On/Off button is
heated).
pressed.
• The shift lever/gear selector is removed from the
Drive position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 203
FORWARD COLLISION WARNING (FCW) WITH
MITIGATION — IF EQUIPPED
Forward Collision Warning (FCW) With Mitigation
Operation
The Forward Collision Warning (FCW) system with
mitigation provides the driver with audible warnings,
visual warnings (within the DID), and may apply a brake
jerk to warn the driver when it detects a potential frontal
collision. The warnings and limited braking are intended
to provide the driver with enough time to react, avoid or
mitigate the potential collision.
NOTE: FCW monitors the information from the forward
looking sensors as well as the Electronic Brake Controller
(EBC), to calculate the probability of a forward collision.
When the system determines that a forward collision is
probable, the driver will be provided with audible and
visual warnings and may provide a brake jerk warning. If
the driver does not take action based upon these progressive warnings, then the system will provide a limited
level of active braking to help slow the vehicle and
mitigate the potential forward collision. If the driver
reacts to the warnings by braking and the system determines that the driver intends to avoid the collision by
braking but has not applied sufficient brake force, the
system will compensate and provide additional brake
force as required. If a Forward Collision Warning with
Mitigation event begins at a speed below 20 mph
(32 km/h), the system may provide the maximum or
partial braking to mitigate the potential forward collision. If the Forward Collision Warning with Mitigation
event stops the vehicle completely, the system will hold
the vehicle at standstill for two seconds and then release
the brakes.
3
204 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
• The minimum speed for FCW activation is 1 mph
(2 km/h).
• The FCW alerts may be triggered on objects other than
vehicles such as guard rails or sign posts based on the
course prediction. This is expected and is a part of
normal FCW activation and functionality.
FCW Message
• It is unsafe to test the FCW system. To prevent such
misuse of the system, after four Active Braking events
within an ignition cycle, the Active Braking portion of
FCW will be deactivated until the next ignition cycle.
When the system determines a collision with the vehicle • The FCW system is intended for on-road use only. If
in front of you is no longer probable, the warning
the vehicle is taken off-road, the FCW system should
message will be deactivated.
be deactivated to prevent unnecessary warnings to the
surroundings.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 205
WARNING!
Forward Collision Warning (FCW) is not intended to
avoid a collision on its own, nor can FCW detect
every type of potential collision. The driver has the
responsibility to avoid a collision by controlling the
vehicle via braking and steering. Failure to follow
this warning could lead to serious injury or death.
Turning FCW ON Or OFF
To turn the FCW system back ON, press the forward
collision button again to turn the system ON (led turns
off).
Changing the FCW status to “Off” prevents the system
from warning you of a possible collision with the vehicle
in front of you.
Changing the Active Braking status to “Off” prevents the
system from providing limited autonomous braking, or
additional brake support if the driver is not braking
adequately in the event of a potential frontal collision.
NOTE: The default status of FCW is “On”, this allows
the system to warn you of a possible collision with the NOTE: The FCW system state is kept in memory from
one ignition cycle to the next. If the system is turned OFF,
vehicle in front of you.
it will remain off when the vehicle is restarted.
The forward collision button is located on the switch
panel below the Uconnect® display.
To turn the FCW system OFF, press the forward collision
button once to turn the system OFF (led turns on).
3
206 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Changing FCW And Active Braking Status
NOTE:
The FCW Sensitivity And Active Braking Settings are • The system will retain the last setting selected by the
programmable through the Uconnect® System. Refer to
driver after ignition shut down.
“Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding Your Instru• FCW may not react to irrelevant objects such as
ment Panel” for further information.
overhead objects, ground reflections, objects not in the
The default status of FCW is the “Far” setting and the
path of the car, stationary objects that are far away,
Active Braking is the “On” setting, this allows the system
oncoming traffic, or leading vehicles with the same or
to warn you of a possible collision with the vehicle in
higher rate of speed.
front of you when you are farther away and it applies
limited braking. This gives you the most reaction time to • FCW will be disabled like ACC, with the unavailable
screens.
avoid a possible collision.
Changing the FCW status to the “Near” setting, allows
the system to warn you of a possible collision with the
vehicle in front of you when you are much closer. This
setting provides less reaction time than the “Far” setting,
which allows for a more dynamic driving experience.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 207
FCW Limited Warning
LANESENSE — IF EQUIPPED
If the DID displays “ACC/FCW Limited Functionality”
or “ACC/FCW Limited Functionality Clean Front Windshield” momentarily, there may be a condition that limits
FCW functionality. Although the vehicle is still drivable
under normal conditions, the active braking may not be
fully available. Once the condition that limited the system performance is no longer present, the system will
return to its full performance state. If the problem persists, see your authorized dealer.
LaneSense Operation
The LaneSense system is operational at speeds above
37 mph (60 km/h) and below 112 mph (180 km/h). The
LaneSense system uses a forward looking camera to
detect lane markings and measure vehicle position
within the lane boundaries.
When both lane markings are detected and the driver
unintentionally drifts out of the lane (no turn signal
applied), the LaneSense system provides a haptic warnService FCW Warning
ing in the form of torque applied to the steering wheel to
If the system turns off, and the DID displays:
prompt the driver to remain within the lane boundaries.
If the driver continues to unintentionally drift out of the
• ACC/FCW Unavailable Service Required
lane, the LaneSense system provides a visual warning
• Cruise/FCW Unavailable Service Required
through the Driver Information Display (DID) to prompt
This indicates there is an internal system fault. Although the driver to remain within the lane boundaries.
the vehicle is still drivable under normal conditions, have The driver may manually override the haptic warning by
the system checked by an authorized dealer.
applying torque into the steering wheel at any time.
3
208 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
When only a single lane marking is detected and the
driver unintentionally drifts across the lane marking (no
turn signal applied), the LaneSense system provides a
visual warning through the DID to prompt the driver to
remain within the lane. When only a single lane marking
is detected, a haptic (torque) warning will not be provided.
NOTE: When operating conditions have been met, the
LaneSense system will monitor if the driver’s hands are
on the steering wheel and provides an audible warning
to the driver when the driver’s hands are not detected on
the steering wheel. The system will cancel if the driver
does not return their hands to the wheel.
Turning LaneSense ON Or OFF
The default status of LaneSense is “OFF”.
The LaneSense button is located on the center stack
below the Uconnect® display.
LaneSense Button Location
To turn the LaneSense system ON, press the LaneSense
button to turn the system ON (LED turns off). A “Lane
Sense On” message is shown in the DID.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 209
To turn the LaneSense system OFF, press the LaneSense
button once to turn the system OFF (LED turns on).
NOTE: The LaneSense system will retain the last system
state ON or OFF from the last ignition cycle when the
ignition is changed to the ON/RUN position.
LaneSense Warning Message
The LaneSense system will indicate the current lane drift
condition through the Driver Information Display (DID).
7.0 Driver Information Display (DID) Screen — If
Equipped
System ON (Gray Lines/White Indicator)
When the LaneSense system is ON; the lane lines are gray
Left
Lane
Departure — Only Left Lane Detected
when both of the lane boundaries have not been detected
and the LaneSense indicator is solid white.
• When the LaneSense system is ON, the LaneSense
indicator is solid white when only the left lane marking has been detected and the system is ready to
provide visual warnings in the DID if an unintentional
lane departure occurs.
3
210 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• When the LaneSense system senses the lane has been
approached and is in a lane departure situation, the
left thick lane line flashes yellow (on/off), the left thin
line remains solid yellow and the LaneSense indicator
changes from solid white to flashing yellow.
Lane Approached (Flashing Yellow Thick Line, Solid
Yellow Thin Line/Flashing Yellow Indicator)
NOTE: The LaneSense system operates with the similar
behavior for a right lane departure when only the right
lane marking has been detected.
Left Lane Departure — Both Lanes Detected
• When the LaneSense system is ON, the lane lines turn
from gray to white to indicate that both of the lane
markings have been detected. The LaneSense indicator
is solid green when both lane markings have been
detected and the system is “armed” to provide visual
warnings in the DID and a torque warning in the
steering wheel if an unintentional lane departure occurs.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 211
• For example: If approaching the left side of the lane
the steering wheel will turn to the right.
3
Lanes Sensed (White Lines/Green Indicator)
• When the LaneSense system senses a lane drift situation, the left thick lane line and left thin line turn solid
yellow. The LaneSense indicator changes from solid
green to solid yellow. At this time torque is applied to
the steering wheel in the opposite direction of the lane
boundary.
Lane Sensed (Solid Yellow Thick Line, Solid Yellow
Thin Line/Solid Yellow Indicator)
212 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• When the LaneSense system senses the lane has been
approached and is in a lane departure situation, the
left thick lane line flashes yellow (on/off) and the left
thin line remains solid yellow. The LaneSense indicator
changes from solid yellow to flashing yellow. At this
time torque is applied to the steering wheel in the
opposite direction of the lane boundary.
• For example: If approaching the left side of the lane
the steering wheel will turn to the right.
Lane Approached (Flashing Yellow Thick Line, Solid
Yellow Thin Line/Flashing Yellow Indicator)
NOTE: The LaneSense system operates with the similar
behavior for a right lane departure.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 213
Changing LaneSense Status
NOTE:
The LaneSense system settings can be configured through • When enabled the system operates above 37 mph
the Uconnect® system screen.
(60 km/h) and below 112 mph (180 km/h).
Follow these steps to change the LaneSense settings:
• Use of the turn signal suppresses the warnings.
1. Press the “Controls” button on touchscreen located on • The system will not apply torque to the steering wheel
the bottom of the Uconnect® display.
whenever a safety system engages. (anti-lock brakes,
traction control system, electronic stability control,
2. Press the “Settings” button.
forward collision warning, etc.)
3. Press the “Safety & Driving Assistance” button.
PARKSENSE® FRONT AND REAR PARK
When in the Safety & Driving Assistance screen, you can
ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED
configure the intensity of the torque warning and the
warning zone sensitivity (early/late) through the person- The ParkSense® Park Assist system provides visual and
audible indications of the distance between the rear
alization settings.
and/or front fascia and a detected obstacle when backing
up or moving forward, e.g. during a parking maneuver.
Refer to ParkSense® System Usage Precautions for limitations of this system and recommendations.
3
214 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
ParkSense® will retain the last system state (enabled or The six ParkSense® sensors, located in the front fascia/
disabled) from the last ignition cycle when the ignition is bumper, monitor the area in front of the vehicle that is
within the sensors’ field of view. The sensors can detect
changed to the ON/RUN position.
obstacles from approximately 12 in (30 cm) up to 47 in
ParkSense® can be active only when the gear selector is (120 cm) from the front fascia/bumper in the horizontal
in REVERSE or DRIVE. If ParkSense® is enabled at one direction, depending on the location, type and orientation
of these gear selector positions, the system will remain of the obstacle.
active until the vehicle speed is increased to approximately 7 mph (11 km/h) or above. The system will ParkSense® Warning Display
become active again if the vehicle speed is decreased to The ParkSense® Warning screen will only be displayed if
speeds less than approximately 6 mph (9 km/h).
Sound and Display is selected from the Customer Programmable Features section of the Uconnect® SysParkSense® Sensors
tem. Refer to ⬙Uconnect® Settings” in “Understanding
The four ParkSense® sensors, located in the rear fascia/ Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
bumper, monitor the area behind the vehicle that is The ParkSense® Warning screen is located within the
within the sensors’ field of view. The sensors can detect Driver Information Display (DID). It provides visual warnobstacles from approximately 12 in (30 cm) up to 59 in ings to indicate the distance between the rear fascia/
(150 cm) from the rear fascia/bumper in the horizontal bumper and/or front fascia/bumper and the detected
direction, depending on the location, type and orienta- obstacle. Refer to “Driver Information Display (DID)” for
tion of the obstacle.
further information.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 215
If an obstacle is detected in the left and/or right rear
region, the display will show a single flashing arc in the
Rear Park Assist
left and/or right rear region and will produce a fast
When the vehicle is in REVERSE, the DID will display the sound tone. As the vehicle moves closer to the obstacle,
park assist ready system status.
the display will show the single arc moving closer to the
The system will indicate a detected obstacle by showing vehicle and the tone will change from fast to continuous.
a single arc in one or more regions based on the obstacle’s
distance and location relative to the vehicle.
ParkSense® Display
If an obstacle is detected in the center rear region, the
display will show a single solid arc in the center rear
region and will produce a one-half second tone. As the
vehicle moves closer to the obstacle, the display will
show the single arc moving closer to the vehicle and the
sound tone will change from slow, to fast, to continuous.
Single 1/2 Second Tone/Solid Arc
3
216 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Slow Tone/Solid Arc
Slow Tone/Solid Arc
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 217
3
Fast Tone/Flashing Arc
Fast Tone/Flashing Arc
218 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The vehicle is close to the obstacle when the warning
display shows one flashing arc and sounds a continuous
tone. The following chart shows the warning alert operation when the system is detecting an obstacle:
Continuous Tone/Flashing Arc
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 219
Rear
Distance
(in/cm)
Arcs — Left
Arcs —
Center
Arcs —
Right
Audible
Alert
Chime
WARNING ALERTS
59-47 in
47-39 in
(150(120120 cm)
100 cm)
Greater
than
79 in
(200 cm)
None
79-59 in
(200150 cm)
39-25 in
(100-65 cm)
None
None
None
None
None
6th Solid
5th Solid
4th Solid
None
None
None
None
3rd
Flashing
None
None
Single 1/2Second
Tone
(for rear
center
only)
Slow
(for rear
center
only)
Slow
(for rear
center
only)
Fast
(for rear
center
only)
25-12 in
(65-30 cm)
2nd
Flashing
2nd
Flashing
2nd
Flashing
Fast
Less than
12 in
(30 cm)
1st Flashing
1st Flashing
1st Flashing
Continuous
3
220 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Rear
Distance
(in/cm)
Radio
Volume
Reduced
Greater
than
79 in
(200 cm)
No
79-59 in
(200150 cm)
Yes
WARNING ALERTS
59-47 in
47-39 in
(150(120120 cm)
100 cm)
Yes
Yes
39-25 in
(100-65 cm)
25-12 in
(65-30 cm)
Less than
12 in
(30 cm)
Yes
Yes
Yes
If an obstacle is detected in the center front region, the
display will show a single arc in the center front region.
As the vehicle moves closer to the obstacle, the display
Front Park Assist
will show the single arc moving closer to the vehicle. A
When the vehicle is in DRIVE the ParkSense® Warning fast sound tone will be produced when reaching the 2nd
screen will be displayed when an obstacle is detected.
flashing arc and will change to a continuous sound tone
The system will indicate a detected obstacle by showing when the 1st flashing arc appears.
a single arc in one or more regions based on the obstacle’s
distance and location relative to the vehicle.
NOTE: ParkSense® will reduce the volume of the radio,
if on, when the system is sounding an audio tone.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 221
If an obstacle is detected in the left and/or right front
region, the display will show a single flashing arc in the
left and/or right front region and will produce a fast
sound tone. As the vehicle moves closer to the obstacle,
the display will show the single arc moving closer to the
vehicle and the tone will change from fast to continuous.
3
Fast Tone/Flashing Arc
No Tone/Solid Arc
222 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The vehicle is close to the obstacle when the warning
display shows one flashing arc and sounds a continuous
tone. The following chart shows the warning alert operation when the system is detecting an obstacle:
Continuous Tone/Flashing Arc
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 223
Front Distance
(in/cm)
Arcs — Left
Arcs — Center
Arcs — Right
Audible Alert
Chime
Radio Volume
Reduced
Greater than
47 in (120 cm)
None
None
None
None
No
WARNING ALERTS
47-39 in
39-25 in
(120-100 cm)
(100-65 cm)
None
None
4th Solid
3rd Flashing
None
None
None
None
No
No
25-12 in
(65-30 cm)
2nd Flashing
2nd Flashing
2nd Flashing
Fast
Less than
12 in (30 cm)
1st Flashing
1st Flashing
1st Flashing
Continuous
Yes
Yes
NOTE: ParkSense® will reduce the volume of the radio, Front Park Assist Audible Alerts
if on, when the system is sounding an audio tone.
ParkSense® will turn off the Front Park Assist audible
alert (chime) after approximately three seconds when an
obstacle has been detected, the vehicle is stationary, and
brake pedal is applied.
3
224 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Adjustable Chime Volume Settings
Enabling And Disabling ParkSense®
Front and Rear chime volume settings can be selected ParkSense® can be enabled and disabled with the
from the Customer-Programmable Features section of the ParkSense® switch, located on the switch panel below
Uconnect® System, refer to “Uconnect Settings” in “Un- the Uconnect® display.
derstanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
If the Uconnect® System is equipped, chime volume
settings will not be accessible from the DID.
The chime volume settings include LOW, MEDIUM, and
HIGH. The factory default volume setting is MEDIUM.
ParkSense® will retain its last known configuration state
through ignition cycles.
ParkSense® Switch
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 225
When the ParkSense® switch is pressed to disable the
system, the instrument cluster will display the
“PARKSENSE OFF” message for approximately five seconds. Refer to “Driver Information Display (DID)” for
further information. When the gear selector is moved to
REVERSE and the system is disabled, the DID will
display the “PARKSENSE OFF” message for as long as
the vehicle is in REVERSE.
The ParkSense® switch LED will be ON when ParkSense®
is disabled or requires service. The ParkSense® switch LED
will be OFF when the system is enabled. If the ParkSense®
switch is pressed, and requires service, the ParkSense®
switch LED will blink momentarily, and then the LED will
be ON.
Service The ParkSense® Park Assist System
During vehicle start up, when the ParkSense® System
has detected a faulted condition, the instrument cluster
will actuate a single chime, once per ignition cycle, and it
will display the ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE
REAR SENSORS⬙, ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE
FRONT SENSORS⬙, or the ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED⬙ message for five seconds.
When the shift lever/gear selector is moved to Reverse
and the system has detected a faulted condition, the
Driver Information Display (DID) will display a
⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS⬙,
⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE FRONT SENSORS⬙
or ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED⬙
pop up message for five seconds. After five seconds, a car
graphic will be displayed with ⬙UNAVAILABLE⬙ at either the front or rear sensor location depending on where
the fault is detected. The system will continue to provide
arc alerts for the side that is functioning properly. These
3
226 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
arc alerts will interrupt the ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS⬙, ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE FRONT SENSORS⬙, or ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED⬙ messages if an object
is detected within the five second pop-up duration. The
car graphic will remain displayed for as long as the
vehicle is in REVERSE. Refer to “Driver Information
Display (DID)” for further information.
Cleaning The ParkSense® System
Clean the ParkSense® sensors with water, car wash soap
and a soft cloth. Do not use rough or hard cloths. Do not
scratch or poke the sensors. Otherwise, you could damage the sensors.
ParkSense® System Usage Precautions
NOTE:
If ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE REAR SENSORS⬙
• Ensure that the front and rear bumper are free of snow,
or ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE WIPE FRONT SENice, mud, dirt and debris to keep the ParkSense®
SORS⬙ appears in the Driver Information Display (DID)
system operating properly.
make sure the outer surface and the underside of the rear
fascia/bumper and/or front fascia/bumper is clean and • Construction equipment, large trucks, and other vibrations could affect the performance of ParkSense®.
clear of snow, ice, mud, dirt or other obstruction and then
cycle the ignition. If the message continues to appear see
• When you turn ParkSense® off, the instrument cluster
an authorized dealer.
will display “PARKSENSE OFF.” Furthermore, once
If the ⬙PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE SERVICE REQUIRED⬙
you turn ParkSense® off, it remains off until you turn
message appears in the DID, see an authorized dealer.
it on again, even if you cycle the ignition key.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 227
• When you move the gear selector to the REVERSE
position and ParkSense® is turned off, the instrument
cluster will display “PARKSENSE OFF” for as long as
the vehicle is in REVERSE.
• ParkSense®, when on, will reduce the volume of the
radio when it is sounding a tone.
• Clean the ParkSense® sensors regularly, taking care
not to scratch or damage them. The sensors must not
be covered with ice, snow, slush, mud, dirt or debris.
Failure to do so can result in the system not working
properly. The ParkSense® system might not detect an
obstacle behind or in front of the fascia/bumper, or it
could provide a false indication that an obstacle is
behind or in front of the fascia/bumper.
• Use the ParkSense® switch to turn the ParkSense®
system off if objects such as bicycle carriers, trailer
hitches, etc. are placed within 12 in (30 cm) from the
rear fascia/bumper. Failure to do so can result in the
system misinterpreting a close object as a sensor
problem, causing the “PARKSENSE UNAVAILABLE
SERVICE REQUIRED” message to be displayed in the
instrument cluster.
3
CAUTION!
• ParkSense® is only a parking aid and it is unable to
recognize every obstacle, including small obstacles.
Parking curbs might be temporarily detected or not
detected at all. Obstacles located above or below
the sensors will not be detected when they are in
close proximity.
• The vehicle must be driven slowly when using
ParkSense® in order to be able to stop in time
when an obstacle is detected. It is recommended
that the driver looks over his/her shoulder when
using ParkSense®.
228 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Drivers must be careful when backing up even
when using ParkSense®. Always check carefully
behind your vehicle, look behind you, and be sure
to check for pedestrians, animals, other vehicles,
obstructions, and blind spots before backing up.
You are responsible for safety and must continue to
pay attention to your surroundings. Failure to do so
can result in serious injury or death.
• Before using ParkSense®, it is strongly recommended that the ball mount and hitch ball assembly is disconnected from the vehicle when the
vehicle is not used for towing. Failure to do so can
result in injury or damage to vehicles or obstacles
because the hitch ball will be much closer to the
obstacle than the rear fascia when the loudspeaker
sounds the continuous tone. Also, the sensors
(Continued)
could detect the ball mount and hitch ball assembly, depending on its size and shape, giving a false
indication that an obstacle is behind the vehicle.
PARKVIEW® REAR BACK UP CAMERA — IF
EQUIPPED
Your vehicle may be equipped with the ParkView® Rear
Back Up Camera that allows you to see an on-screen
image of the rear surroundings of your vehicle whenever
the shift lever/gear selector is put into REVERSE. The
ParkView® camera is located on the rear of the vehicle
above the rear license plate. The image will be displayed
in the touchscreen display along with a caution note to
“check entire surroundings” across the top of the screen.
After five seconds this note will disappear.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 229
NOTE: The ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera has programmable modes of operation that may be selected
through the Uconnect® System. Refer to “Uconnect®
Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
When the Vehicle is shifted out of Reverse (with camera
delay turned OFF) the rear camera mode is exited and the
last touchscreen appears again.
When enabled, active guide lines are overlaid on the image
to illustrate the width of the vehicle and its projected backup
If your vehicle is equipped with the Camera Delay feature path based on the steering wheel position.
and it is turned ON, the rear camera image will be
Different colored zones indicate the distance to the rear of
displayed for up to 10 seconds when the vehicle is shifted
the vehicle.
out of REVERSE unless the forward vehicle speed exceeds
8 mph (13 km/h), the transmission is shifted into ⬙PARK⬙ The following table shows the approximate distances for
each zone:
or the vehicle’s ignition is cycled to the OFF position.
Zone
Red
Yellow
Green
Distance to the rear of the vehicle
0 - 1 ft (0 - 30 cm)
1 ft - 6.5 ft (30 cm - 2 m)
6.5 ft or greater (2 m or greater)
3
230 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
CAUTION! (Continued)
Drivers must be careful when backing up even when
using the ParkView® Rear Back Up Camera. Always
check carefully behind your vehicle, and be sure to
check for pedestrians, animals, other vehicles, obstructions, or blind spots before backing up. You are
responsible for the safety of your surroundings and
must continue to pay attention while backing up.
Failure to do so can result in serious injury or death.
CAUTION!
• To avoid vehicle damage, ParkView® should only
be used as a parking aid. The ParkView® camera is
unable to view every obstacle or object in your
drive path.
(Continued)
• To avoid vehicle damage, the vehicle must be
driven slowly when using ParkView® to be able to
stop in time when an obstacle is seen. It is recommended that the driver look frequently over his/her
shoulder when using ParkView®.
NOTE: If snow, ice, mud, or any foreign substance builds
up on the camera lens, clean the lens, rinse with water,
and dry with a soft cloth. Do not cover the lens.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 231
OVERHEAD CONSOLE
Front Map/Reading Lights — If Equipped
The overhead console contains courtesy/reading lights
and storage for sunglasses. Universal Garage Door
Opener (HomeLink®) and power sunroof switches may
also be included, if equipped.
Lights are mounted in the overhead console. Each light
can be turned on by pressing the switch on either side of
the console. These buttons are backlit for night time
visibility.
Overhead Console
Front Map/Reading Lights
3
232 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To turn the lights off, press the switch a second time. The
lights also turn on when a door is opened. The lights will
also turn on when the UNLOCK button on the RKE is
pressed.
Front Map/Reading Light Switches
Courtesy Lights
The courtesy lights can be turned on by pressing the top
corner of the lens. To turn the lights off, press the lens a
second time.
Courtesy Lights
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 233
Sunglasses Bin Door
GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED
At the front of the console a compartment is provided for
the storage of a pair of sunglasses. The storage compartment access is a “push/push” design. Push the chrome
pad on the door to open. Push the chrome pad on the
door to close.
HomeLink® replaces up to three hand-held transmitters
that operate devices such as garage door openers, motorized gates, lighting or home security systems. The
HomeLink® unit is powered by your vehicles 12 Volt
battery.
The HomeLink® buttons, located on either the overhead
console, headliner or sunvisor, designate the three different HomeLink® channels. The HomeLink® indicator is
located above the center button.
Sunglasses Bin Door
3
234 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Before You Begin Programming HomeLink®
Be sure that your vehicle is parked outside of the garage
before you begin programming.
For more efficient programming and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal it is recommended that
a new battery be placed in the hand-held transmitter of
the device that is being programmed to the HomeLink®
system.
Overhead Console HomeLink® Buttons
NOTE: HomeLink® is disabled when the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
To erase the channels place the ignition in the ON/RUN
position and push and hold the two outside HomeLink®
buttons (I and III) for up 20 seconds or until the red
indicator flashes.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 235
NOTE:
• Erasing all channels should only be performed when
programming HomeLink® for the first time. Do not
erase channels when programming additional buttons.
• If you have any problems, or require assistance, please
call toll-free 1-800-355-3515 or, on the Internet at
HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
Programming A Rolling Code
For programming garage door openers that were manufactured after 1995. These garage door openers can be
Training The Garage Door Opener
identified by the “LEARN” or “TRAIN” button located
where the hanging antenna is attached to the garage door 1 — Door Opener
opener. It is NOT the button that is normally used to 2 — Training Button
open and close the door. The name and color of the
button may vary by manufacturer.
3
236 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
1. Place the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 inches (3 to
8 cm) away from the HomeLink® button you wish to
program while keeping the HomeLink® indicator
light in view.
attached to the garage door opener/device motor.
Firmly push and release the “LEARN” or “TRAINING” button. On some garage door openers/devices
there may be a light that blinks when the garage door
opener/device is in the LEARN/TRAIN mode.
NOTE: You have 30 seconds in which to initiate the next
3. Push and hold the HomeLink® button you want to
step after the LEARN button has been pushed.
program while you push and hold the hand-held
transmitter button.
6. Return to the vehicle and push the programmed
HomeLink® button twice (holding the button for two
4. Continue to hold both buttons and observe the indiseconds each time). If the garage door opener/device
cator light. The HomeLink® indicator will flash slowly
activates, programming is complete.
and then rapidly after HomeLink® has received the
frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Re- NOTE: If the garage door opener/device does not actilease both buttons after the indicator light changes vate, push the button a third time (for two seconds) to
from slow to rapid.
complete the training.
5. At the garage door opener motor (in the garage), To program the remaining two HomeLink® buttons,
locate the “LEARN” or “TRAINING” button. This can repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is erase the channels.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 237
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink® Button
(Rolling Code)
Programming A Non-Rolling Code
For programming Garage Door Openers manufactured
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained, before 1995.
follow these steps:
1. Place the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 inches (3 to
2. Push and hold the desired HomeLink® button until
8 cm) away from the HomeLink® button you wish to
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds.
program while keeping the HomeLink® indicator
Do not release the button.
light in view.
3. Without releasing the button proceed with “Program- 3. Push and hold the Homelink® button you want to
ming A Rolling Code” step 2 and follow all remaining
program while you push and hold the hand-held
steps.
transmitter button.
4. Continue to hold both buttons and observe the indicator light. The Homelink® indicator will flash slowly
and then rapidly after HomeLink® has received the
frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons after the indicator light changes
from slow to rapid.
3
238 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
5. Push and hold the programmed HomeLink® button
and observe the indicator light.
• If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete and the garage door/device should
activate when the HomeLink® button is pushed.
• To program the two remaining HomeLink® buttons,
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
erase the channels.
3. Without releasing the button proceed with “Programming A Non-Rolling Code” step 2 and follow all
remaining steps.
Canadian/Gate Operator Programming
For programming transmitters in Canada/United States
that require the transmitter signals to “time-out” after
several seconds of transmission.
Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter signals to time-out (or quit) after several seconds of transmission – which may not be long enough for HomeLink®
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained, to pick up the signal during programming. Similar to this
follow these steps:
Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to
time-out in the same manner.
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink® Button
(Non-Rolling Code)
2. Push and hold the desired HomeLink® button until
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds.
Do not release the button.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 239
It may be helpful to unplug the device during the cycling 4. Watch for the HomeLink® indicator to change flash
process to prevent possible overheating of the garage
rates. When it changes, it is programmed. It may take
door or gate motor.
up to 30 seconds or longer in rare cases. The garage
door may open and close while you are programming.
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
5. Push and hold the programmed HomeLink® button
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 inches (3 to
and observe the indicator light.
8 cm) away from the HomeLink® button you wish to
•
If the indicator light stays on constantly, programprogram while keeping the HomeLink® indicator
ming is complete and the garage door/device should
light in view.
activate when the HomeLink® button is pushed.
3. Continue to push and hold the HomeLink® button,
• To program the two remaining HomeLink® buttons,
while you push and release (“cycle”) your hand-held
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
transmitter every two seconds until HomeLink® has
erase the channels.
successfully accepted the frequency signal. The indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly when If you unplugged the garage door opener/device for
programming, plug it back in at this time.
fully trained.
3
240 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink® Button
(Canadian/Gate Operator)
Using HomeLink®
To operate, push and release the programmed HomeLink®
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained, button. Activation will now occur for the programmed
follow these steps:
device (i.e., garage door opener, gate operator, security
system, entry door lock, home/office lighting, etc.,). The
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
hand-held transmitter of the device may also be used at any
2. Push and hold the desired HomeLink® button until time.
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds.
Security
Do not release the button.
It is advised to erase all channels before you sell or turn
3. Without releasing the button proceed with “Canadian/ in your vehicle.
Gate Operator Programming” step 2 and follow all
To do this, push and hold the two outside buttons for 20
remaining steps.
seconds until the red indicator flashes. Note that all
channels will be erased. Individual channels cannot be
erased.
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver is disabled when
the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 241
Troubleshooting Tips
If you are having trouble programming HomeLink®,
here are some of the most common solutions:
• Replace the battery in the original hand-held transmitter.
• Push the LEARN button on the Garage Door Opener
to complete the training for a Rolling Code.
• Did you unplug the device for programming and
remember to plug it back in?
If you have any problems, or require assistance, please
call toll-free 1-800-355-3515 or, on the Internet at
HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
WARNING!
• Vehicle exhaust contains carbon monoxide, a dangerous gas. Do not run your vehicle in the garage
while programming the transceiver. Exhaust gas
can cause serious injury or death.
• Your motorized door or gate will open and close
while you are programming the universal transceiver. Do not program the transceiver if people,
pets or other objects are in the path of the door or
gate. Only use this transceiver with a garage door
opener that has a “stop and reverse” feature as
required by Federal safety standards. This includes
most garage door opener models manufactured
after 1982. Do not use a garage door opener without
these safety features. Call toll-free 1-800-355-3515
or, on the Internet at HomeLink.com for safety
information or assistance.
3
242 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
General Information
COMMANDVIEW® SUNROOF WITH POWER
This device complies with FCC rules Part 15 and Industry SHADE — IF EQUIPPED
Canada RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following The CommandView® sunroof switch is located to the left
between the sun visors on the overhead console.
two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference that may be
received including interference that may cause undesired operation.
The power shade switch is located to the right between
the sun visors on the overhead console.
NOTE:
• The transmitter has been tested and it complies with FCC
and IC rules. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could
void the user’s authority to operate the device.
• The term IC before the certification/registration number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met.
CommandView® Sunroof And Power Shade Switches
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 243
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never leave children unattended in a vehicle, or
with access to an unlocked vehicle. Never leave the
Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or in a location
accessible to children. Do not leave the ignition of
a vehicle equipped with Keyless Enter-N-Go™ in
the ACC or ON/RUN mode. Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped
by the power sunroof while operating the power
sunroof switch. Such entrapment may result in
serious injury or death.
• In a collision, there is a greater risk of being thrown
from a vehicle with an open sunroof. You could
also be seriously injured or killed. Always fasten
your seat belt properly and make sure all passengers are also properly secured.
• Do not allow small children to operate the sunroof.
Never allow your fingers, other body parts, or any
object, to project through the sunroof opening.
Injury may result.
(Continued)
Opening Sunroof — Express
Press the switch rearward and release it within one-half
second. The sunroof and sunshade will open automatically from any position. The sunroof and sunshade will
open fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express
Open”. During Express Open operation, any movement
of the sunroof switch will stop the sunroof.
3
244 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode
Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode
To open the sunroof, press and hold the switch rearward
to full open. Any release of the switch will stop the
movement. The sunroof and sunshade will remain in a
partially opened condition until the switch is pushed and
held rearward again.
To close the sunroof, press and hold the switch in the
forward position. Any release of the switch will stop the
movement and the sunroof will remain in a partially
closed condition until the switch is pushed and held
forward again.
Closing Sunroof — Express
Opening Power Shade — Express
Press the switch forward and release it within one-half
second and the sunroof will close automatically from any
position. The sunroof will close fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express Close”. During Express
Close operation, any movement of the switch will stop
the sunroof.
Press the shade switch rearward and release it within
one-half second and the shade will automatically open to
the halfway position and stop automatically. Press the
switch a second time from the halfway position and the
shade will automatically open to the full open position
and stop automatically. This is called “Express Open”.
During Express Open operation, any movement of the
shade switch will stop the shade.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 245
NOTE: If the sunroof is open, the shade will close to the
half-open position. Pressing the shade close button again
To open the shade, press and hold the switch rearward.
will automatically close both the sunroof and shade
The shade will open and stop automatically at the
completely.
half-open position. Press and hold the shade switch
rearward again and the shade will open automatically to Closing Power Shade — Manual Mode
the full-open position. Any release of the switch will stop
To close the shade, press and hold the switch in the
the movement and the shade will remain in a partially
forward position. Any release of the switch will stop the
opened condition until the switch is pushed and held
movement and the shade will remain in a partially closed
rearward again.
condition until the switch is pushed and held forward
Closing Power Shade — Express
again.
Opening Power Shade — Manual Mode
Press the switch forward and release it within one-half
second and the shade will close automatically from any
position. If the sunroof is completely closed the shade
will close fully and stop automatically. This is called
“Express Close”. During Express Close operation, any
movement of the switch will stop the shade.
Venting Sunroof — Express
Press and release the ⬙Vent⬙ button within one-half second and the sunroof will open to the vent position. This
is called “Express Vent”, and it will occur regardless of
sunroof position. During Express Vent operation, any
movement of the switch will stop the sunroof.
3
246 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If the sunshade is in the closed position when the
vent switch is pressed, the sunshade will automatically
cycle to the halfway open position prior to the sunroof
opening to the Vent position.
Pinch Protect Feature
This feature will detect an obstruction in the opening of
the sunroof during Express Close operation. If an obstruction in the path of the sunroof is detected, the
sunroof will automatically retract. Remove the obstruction if this occurs. Next, press the switch forward and
release to Express Close.
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows
together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs
with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to
minimize the buffeting or open any window.
Sunroof Maintenance
NOTE: If three consecutive sunroof close attempts result
in Pinch Protect reversals, the fourth close attempt will be Use only a non-abrasive cleaner and a soft cloth to clean
a Manual Close movement with Pinch Protect disabled. the glass panel.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 247
outlets are labeled with either a “key” or a “battery”
symbol to indicate how the outlet is powered. Power
The power sunroof switch will remain active for up to
outlets labeled with a “key” are powered when the
approximately ten minutes after the ignition switch is
ignition switch is in the ON or ACC position, while the
turned to the LOCK position. Opening either front door
outlets labeled with a “battery” are connected directly to
will cancel this feature.
the battery and powered at all times.
NOTE: Ignition Off time is programmable through
NOTE:
the Uconnect® System. Refer to “Uconnect® Settings/
Customer Programmable Features” in “Understanding • All accessories connected to the “battery” powered
Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
outlets should be removed or turned off when the
vehicle is not in use to protect the battery against
ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS
discharge.
Your vehicle is equipped with one 12 Volt (13 Amp) • To ensure proper cigar lighter operation, a MOPAR®
power outlet on the instrument panel and one 12 Volt
knob and element must be used.
(10 Amp) power outlet in the center console that can be
used to power cellular phones, small electronics and The front power outlet is located inside the storage area
other low powered electrical accessories. The power on the center stack of the instrument panel.
Ignition OFF Operation
3
248 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
In addition to the front power outlet, there is also a power
outlet located in the storage area of the center console.
Front Power Outlet
WARNING!
Do not place ashes inside the cubby bin located on
the center console on vehicles not equipped with the
ash receiver tray. A fire leading to bodily injury could
result.
Center Console Power Outlet
NOTE: If the Media Hub is in use, do not exceed the
maximum power of 100 Watts (8 Amps) for the center
console power outlet. When the Media Hub is not in use,
the outlet can deliver up to 120 Watts (10 Amps).
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 249
If the power rating is exceeded, the fuse protecting the NOTE: The instrument panel power outlet and dual rear
system will need to be replaced.
console USB ports can be changed to “battery” powered
all the time by moving the #12 20 Amp fuse from “IGN”
to “B+”. Refer to “Rear Power Distribution Center
Cover” in “Rear Power Distribution Center (Fuses)”.
WARNING!
Power Outlet Fuse Locations
1 — #12 Fuse 20 Amp Yellow Instrument Panel Power Outlet /
Dual USB Charge Only Ports
2 — #38 Fuse 15 Amp Blue Center Console Power Outlet / Media
Hub
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Only devices designed for use in this type of outlet
should be inserted into any 12 Volt outlet.
• Do not touch with wet hands.
• Close the lid when not in use and while driving the
vehicle.
• If this outlet is mishandled, it may cause an electric
shock and failure.
3
250 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Many accessories that can be plugged in draw
power from the vehicle’s battery even when not in
use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough, the vehicle’s battery will
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life and/or
prevent the engine from starting.
• Accessories that draw higher power (i.e., coolers,
vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.) will degrade the battery even more quickly. Only use these intermittently and with greater caution.
• After the use of high power draw accessories or
long periods of the vehicle not being started (with
accessories still plugged in), the vehicle must be
driven a sufficient length of time to allow the
alternator to recharge the vehicle’s battery.
• Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs
only. Do not hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket from the plug. Improper use of the
power outlet can cause damage.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 251
CUPHOLDERS
Front Seat Cupholders
The cupholders are located in the forward edge of the
center console.
3
Front Cupholders
Retractable Cover
252 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Press the “Cold” symbol once to turn on the cupholder;
Your vehicle may be equipped with heated and cooled press the symbol a second time to turn the cupholder off.
cupholders. The cupholders are designed to help keep Press the “Hot” symbol once to activate the cupholder;
press the symbol a second time to turn off the cupholder.
warm beverages warm and cold beverages cool.
Heated And Cooled Cupholders — If Equipped
WARNING!
Heated And Cooled Cupholder Switches
When using the cupholder in the “Hot” position,
avoid contact with the heated portion of the cupholder in order to reduce the possibility of burns.
Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes,
spinal cord injuries, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion or other physical condition must exercise particular care in order to prevent serious burn injury.
Keep the cupholder free of debris or stray objects
when operated in the Heat position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 253
Rear Seat Cupholders
Lighted Cupholders — If Equipped
The rear seat cupholders are located in the center armrest
between the rear seats. The cupholders are positioned
forward in the armrest and side-by-side to provide convenient access to beverage cans or bottles while maintaining
a resting place for the rear occupant’s elbows.
On some vehicles the rear cupholders are equipped with
a light ring that illuminates the cupholders for the rear
passengers. The light ring is controlled by the Dimmer
Control. Refer to “Lights” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for further information.
Rear Seat Cupholders
Light Ring In Rear Cupholder
3
254 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
STORAGE
Console Features
There is a cubby bin located forward of the gear selector.
The cubby bin is covered with a push-push actuated
The glove compartment is located on the passenger side
door. Push inward on the door to open it, push the door
of the instrument panel.
a second time to close it.
Glove Compartment
Two separate storage compartments are also located
underneath the center console armrest.
Glove Compartment
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 255
small items like an ipod or phone. Below the upper tray,
the lower storage compartment is made for larger items,
like CDs and tissue boxes. In addition, the 12 volt power
outlet, USB and Aux jack are located here.
3
Center Console
Inside the center console armrest, there is a removable
upper storage tray that can be slid forward/rearward on
rails for access to the lower storage area. This tray has an
integrated coin holder, along with additional area for
Upper Storage Tray
256 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Do not operate this vehicle with a console compartment lid in the open position. Driving with the
console compartment lid open may result in injury in
a collision.
Door Storage
The door panels contain storage areas.
Front Door Trim Storage
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 257
Rear Seat Armrest Storage — If Equipped
Cargo Area — Vehicles Equipped With
For rear passengers there is a storage bin located in the 60/40 Split-Folding Rear Seat
armrest. Lift upward on the latch to open the storage The 60/40 split-folding rear seat provides cargo-carrying
versatility. The seatbacks fold down easily by pulling
compartment.
nylon tabs between the seatbacks and the bolsters. When
the seats are folded down, they provide a continuous,
nearly-flat extension of the load floor.
When the seatback is folded to the upright position, make
sure it is latched by strongly pulling on the top of the
seatback above the seat strap.
Rear Armrest Storage
3
258 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING!
• Be certain that the seatback is securely locked into
position. If the seatback is not securely locked into
position, the seat will not provide the proper stability for child seats and/or passengers. An improperly latched seat could cause serious injury.
• The cargo area in the rear of the vehicle (with the
rear seatbacks in the locked-up or folded down
position) should not be used as a play area by
children when the vehicle is in motion. They could
be seriously injured in a collision. Children should
be seated and using the proper restraint system.
• To help protect against personal injury, passengers
should not be seated in the rear cargo area. The rear
cargo space is intended for load carrying purposes
only, not for passengers, who should sit in seats
and use seat belts.
The weight and position of cargo and passengers can
change the vehicle center of gravity and vehicle
handling. To avoid loss of control resulting in personal injury, follow these guidelines for loading your
vehicle:
• Always place cargo evenly on the cargo floor. Put
heavier objects as low and as far forward as possible.
• Place as much cargo as possible in front of the rear
axle. Too much weight or improperly placed weight
over or behind the rear axle can cause the rear of
the vehicle to sway.
• Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the top of
the seatback. This could impair visibility or become a dangerous projectile in a sudden stop or
collision.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 259
CARGO AREA FEATURES
Trunk Mat — If Equipped
A trunk mat covers the bottom of the cargo area. The
trunk mat is used to protect the interior of the trunk from
mud, snow, and debris.
3
Grocery Bag Hooks
The rear cargo area is equipped with grocery bag hooks,
located on either side of the rear cargo area.
Grocery Bag Hooks
CAUTION!
Do not exceed the maximum weight limit 50 lbs
(22 kg) of the grocery bag hook. Damage may occur to
hook and mounting surface.
260 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Cargo Net
REAR WINDOW FEATURES
The rear cargo area is equipped with a cargo net.
Rear Window Defroster
The rear window defroster button is located on
the climate control. Press this button to turn on the
rear window defroster and the heated outside mirrors (if
equipped). An indicator in the button will illuminate
when the rear window defroster is on. The rear window
defroster automatically turns off after approximately 10
minutes. For an additional five minutes of operation,
press the button a second time.
Rear Cargo Net
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 261
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
Power Sunshade — If Equipped
Your vehicle may be equipped with a power sunshade
that will reduce the amount of sunlight that will shine
through the rear windshield.
The power sunshade can be operated using the
Uconnect® System.
Press the “Controls” button and then press the “Rear
Sunshade” button to raise the power sunscreen. Press the
“Sunshade” button a second time to lower the sunshade.
If the sunshade is in the raised position and the vehicle is
placed in REVERSE, the sunshade will automatically
fully lower. When the transmission is shifted out of
REVERSE the sunshade will automatically return to the
fully raised position after a brief delay.
NOTE: The rear sunshade control switch can be locked
out along with the rear passenger window controls from
the driver switch window lockout switch.
3
262 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The power sunshade can also be operated by passengers
in the rears seats. The power sunshade switch is located
on the back of the center console between the heated seat
switches. Press the switch once to raise the sunshade.
Press the switch a second time to lower the sunshade.
LOAD LEVELING SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED
The automatic load leveling system will provide a levelriding vehicle under most passenger and cargo loading
conditions.
A hydraulic pump contained within the shock absorbers
raises the rear of the vehicle to the correct height. It takes
approximately 1 mile (1.6 km) of driving for the leveling
to complete depending on road surface conditions.
If the leveled vehicle is not moved for approximately 15
hours, the leveling system will bleed itself down. The
vehicle must be driven to reset the system.
Power Sunshade Switch
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CONTENTS
䡵 INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES . . . . . . . . . .265
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS . . . . .267
䡵 DRIVER INFORMATION DISPLAY (DID) . . . . .276
▫ Engine Oil Life Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
▫ DID Selectable Menu Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
䡵 SETTING THE ANALOG CLOCK . . . . . . . . . . .284
䡵 Uconnect® SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
▫ Buttons On The Faceplate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .285
▫ Buttons On The Touchscreen. . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
▫ Customer Programmable Features —
Uconnect® 8.4 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
䡵 Uconnect® RADIOS — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . .307
䡵 iPod®/USB/MP3 CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
䡵 STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS . . . . . .308
▫ Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
䡵 CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
䡵 RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES . .310
䡵 CLIMATE CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
4
264 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
▫ Dual Zone Automatic Climate Controls
With Touchscreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
▫ Climate Control Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
▫ Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . . . .318
▫ Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
䡵 Uconnect® VOICE RECOGNITION
QUICK TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
▫ Introducing Uconnect® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
▫ Get Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
▫ Basic Voice Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
▫ Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .326
▫ Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
▫ Phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
▫ Voice Text Reply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
▫ Climate (8.4A/8.4AN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
▫ Navigation (8.4A/8.4AN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
▫ Uconnect® Access* (8.4A/8.4AN) . . . . . . . . . .332
▫ Register (8.4A/8.4AN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
▫ Mobile App (8.4A/8.4AN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .334
▫ Voice Texting (8.4A/8.4AN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
▫ Yelp® (8.4A/8.4AN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .336
▫ SiriusXM Travel Link™ (8.4A/8.4AN) . . . . . . .337
▫ General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
▫ Additional Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 265
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
— Air Outlet
— Driver Information Display (DID) Controls
— Driver Information Display (DID)
— Speed Controls
— Uconnect® System
— Analog Clock
7 — Glove Compartment
8 — Uconnect® System Hard Controls
9 — Switch Bank
10 — Climate Control Hard Controls
11 — Engine Start/Stop Button
12 — Trunk Release Button
13 — Headlight Switch
14 — Adaptive Cruise Control
15 —Uconnect® Phone Controls
266 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 267
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS
1. Tachometer
This gauge measures engine revolutions-per-minute
(RPM x 1000).
2. High Beam Indicator
This indicator shows that the high beam headlights are on. Push the multifunction lever forward to switch the headlights to high beam, and pull
toward yourself (normal position) to return to low beam.
3. Brake Warning Light
If the light remains on when the parking brake has been
disengaged, and the fluid level is at the full mark on the
master cylinder reservoir, it indicates a possible brake
hydraulic system malfunction or that a problem with the
Brake Booster has been detected by the Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS)/Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system.
In this case, the light will remain on until the condition
has been corrected. If the problem is related to the brake
booster, the ABS pump will run when applying the brake
and a brake pedal pulsation may be felt during each stop.
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic
system. A leak in either half of the dual brake system is
indicated by the Brake Warning Light, which will turn on
when the brake fluid level in the master cylinder has
dropped below a specified level.
This light monitors various brake functions,
including brake fluid level and parking brake
application. If the brake light turns on, it may
indicate that the parking brake is applied, that
the brake fluid level is low, or that there is a problem with The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
the anti-lock brake system reservoir.
4
268 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp
cornering maneuvers, which change fluid level conditions. The vehicle should have service performed, and
the brake fluid level checked.
Operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked by
turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to the
ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for approximately two seconds. The light should then turn off
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is neces- unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is
detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light
sary.
inspected by an authorized dealer.
WARNING!
Driving a vehicle with the red brake light on is
dangerous. Part of the brake system may have failed.
It will take longer to stop the vehicle. You could have
a collision. Have the vehicle checked immediately.
Vehicles equipped with the Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS), are also equipped with Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD). In the event of an EBD failure, the
Brake Warning Light will turn on along with the ABS
Light. Immediate repair to the ABS system is required.
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is
applied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 269
4. Air Bag Warning Light
This light will turn on for four to eight seconds
as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first
turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on
during starting, stays on, or turns on while
driving, have the system inspected at an authorized
dealer as soon as possible. Refer to “Occupant Restraints”
in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for
further information.
5. Driver Information Display (DID) Area
driven. If your odometer needs to be repaired or serviced,
the repair technician should leave the odometer reading
the same as it was before the repair or service. If he/she
cannot do so, then the odometer must be set at zero, and
a sticker must be placed in the door jamb stating what the
mileage was before the repair or service. It is a good idea
for you to make a record of the odometer reading before
the repair/service, so that you can be sure that it is
properly reset, or that the door jamb sticker is accurate if
the odometer must be reset at zero.
The DID features an interactive display, for further
The odometer display shows the total distance the ve- information refer to “Driver Information Display (DID).”
hicle has been driven. The trip odometer shows indi- 6. Park/Headlight ON Indicator — If Equipped
vidual trip mileage.
This indicator will illuminate when the park
NOTE: U.S. Federal regulations require that upon translights or headlights are turned on.
fer of vehicle ownership, the seller certify to the purchaser the correct mileage that the vehicle has been
4
270 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
7. Front Fog Light Indicator — If Equipped
This indicator will illuminate when the front
fog lights are on.
8. Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light — If Equipped
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked monthly when cold and
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended
by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle
placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle
has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those
tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been
equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when
one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving
on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect
the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper
tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to
maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has
not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS
low tire pressure telltale.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 271
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not
operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is
combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the
system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for
approximately one minute and then remain continuously
illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure
as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety
of reasons, including the installation of replacement or
alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the
TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more
tires or wheels on your vehicle, to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS
to continue to function properly.
CAUTION!
The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warning have been established for the tire size
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
sensor damage. Using aftermarket tire sealants may
cause the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
sensor to become inoperable. After using an aftermarket tire sealant it is recommended that you take
your vehicle to an authorized dealership to have your
sensor function checked.
4
272 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
9. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator system. If this light remains on after several ignition
Light — If Equipped
cycles, and the vehicle has been driven several miles
(kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see
This light indicates the Electronic Stability Conyour authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the
trol (ESC) is off.
problem diagnosed and corrected.
10. Speedometer
Indicates vehicle speed.
11. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Activation/
Malfunction Indicator Light — If Equipped
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light” in the instrument cluster will come on
when the ignition switch is turned to the
ON/RUN position. It should go out with the
engine running. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” comes on continuously with the engine
running, a malfunction has been detected in the ESC
NOTE:
• The “ESC Off Indicator Light” and the “ESC
Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” come on
momentarily each time the ignition switch is turned
to ON/RUN.
• Each time the ignition is turned to ON/RUN, the
ESC system will be ON, even if it was turned off
previously.
• The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking
sounds when it is active. This is normal; the sounds
will stop when ESC becomes inactive following the
maneuver that caused the ESC activation.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 273
12. Turn Signal Indicators
the conventional brake system will continue to operate
normally if the BRAKE warning light is not on.
The arrow will flash with the exterior turn
signal when the turn signal lever is operated. If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced
as soon as possible to restore the benefits of Anti-Lock
brakes. If the ABS light does not turn on when the
If the vehicle electronics sense that the vehicle is driven
ignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN position, have
more than 1 mile (1.6 km) with either turn signal on, a
the light inspected by an authorized dealer.
continuous chime will sound to alert you to turn the
signals off. If either indicator flashes at a rapid rate, check 14. Fuel Door Reminder
for a defective outside light bulb.
The arrow in this symbol is a reminder that the
13. Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Light
Fuel Filler Door is located on the left side of the
vehicle.
This light monitors the Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS). The light will turn on when the ignition 15. Fuel Gauge
switch is turned to the ON/RUN position and
The pointer shows the level of fuel in the fuel tank when
may stay on for as long as four seconds.
the ignition switch is in the ON/RUN position.
If the ABS light remains on or turns on while driving, it
indicates that the Anti-Lock portion of the brake system
is not functioning and that service is required. However,
4
274 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
16. Temperature Gauge
CAUTION! (Continued)
The temperature gauge shows engine coolant temperature. Any reading within the normal range indicates that
the engine cooling system is operating satisfactorily.
remains on the “H” and you hear continuous chimes,
turn the engine off immediately and call an authorized dealer for service.
The gauge pointer will likely indicate a higher temperature when driving in hot weather, up mountain grades,
or when towing a trailer. It should not be allowed to
exceed the upper limits of the normal operating range.
WARNING!
CAUTION!
Driving with a hot engine cooling system could
damage your vehicle. If the temperature gauge reads
“H” pull over and stop the vehicle. Idle the vehicle
with the air conditioner turned off until the pointer
drops back into the normal range. If the pointer
(Continued)
A hot engine cooling system is dangerous. You or
others could be badly burned by steam or boiling
coolant. You may want to call an authorized dealer
for service if your vehicle overheats. If you decide to
look under the hood yourself, see “Maintaining Your
Vehicle”. Follow the warnings under the Cooling
System Pressure Cap paragraph.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 275
17. Seat Belt Reminder Light
19. Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
When the ignition switch is first turned to ON/
RUN, this light will turn on for four to eight
seconds as a bulb check. During the bulb check, if
the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled, a chime will sound.
After the bulb check or when driving, if the driver’s seat
belt remains unbuckled, the Seat Belt Reminder Light
will illuminate and the chime will sound. Refer to
“Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) is part of
an Onboard Diagnostic system, called OBD, that
monitors engine and automatic transmission control systems. The light will illuminate when the key is in
the ON/RUN position, before engine start. If the bulb
does not come on when turning the key from OFF to
ON/RUN, have the condition checked promptly.
Certain conditions, such as poor fuel quality, etc., may
illuminate the MIL after engine start. The vehicle should
be serviced if the light stays on through several of your
18. Vehicle Security Light — If Equipped
typical driving cycles. In most situations, the vehicle will
This light will flash at a fast rate for approxi- drive normally and will not require towing.
mately 15 seconds, when the vehicle security
alarm is arming, and then will flash slowly
until the vehicle is disarmed.
4
276 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CAUTION!
Prolonged driving with the Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) on could cause damage to the engine
control system. It also could affect fuel economy and
driveability. If the MIL is flashing, severe catalytic
converter damage and power loss will soon occur.
Immediate service is required.
DRIVER INFORMATION DISPLAY (DID)
The Driver Information Display (DID) features an interactive display which is located in the instrument cluster.
This system conveniently allows the driver to select a
variety of useful information by pushing the arrow
buttons located on the left side of the steering wheel. The
DID Menu Items consists of the following:
• Speedometer
WARNING!
A malfunctioning catalytic converter, as referenced
above, can reach higher temperatures than in normal
operating conditions. This can cause a fire if you
drive slowly or park over flammable substances such
as dry plants, wood, cardboard, etc. This could result
in death or serious injury to the driver, occupants or
others.
• Vehicle Info
• Driver Assist — If Equipped
• Fuel Economy
• Trip
• Audio
• Messages
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 277
• Screen Setup
Up And Down Arrow Buttons:
The system allows the driver to select information by
pushing the following buttons mounted on the steering
wheel:
Using the Up or Down arrows allows you to
cycles through the Main Menu Items.
Changes the Main Screen area and Menu Title
area.
Left And Right Arrow Buttons:
Using the Left or Right arrow buttons allows
you to cycles through the submenu items of the
Main menu item.
DID Controls
4
278 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE:
For Screen Setup and Vehicle Settings:
• Holding the Up/Down or Left/Right arrow buttons • OK button allows user to enter menu and submenus.
will loop the user through the currently selected menu
• Within each submenu layer, the up/down arrows will
or options presented on the screen.
allow the user to select the item of interest.
• Main menu and submenu’s wrap for continuous
• Pushing the OK button makes the selection and a
scrolling.
confirmation screen will appear (returning the user to
• Upon returning to a main menu, the last submenu
the 1st page of the submenu).
screen viewed within that main menu will be dis• Pushing the left arrow button will exit each submenu
played.
layer and return to the main menu.
OK Button:
For the Trip and Fuel Economy menus (and new PerforFor Digital Speedometer
mance Timers):
• Pushing the OK button changes units (MPH or km/h). • Information is reset by pushing and holding the OK
button.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 279
Engine Oil Life Reset
Vehicles Equipped With Keyless Enter-N-Go™
Oil Change Required
1. Without pushing the brake pedal, push the ENGINE
START/STOP button and place the ignition to the
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change
ON/RUN position (do not start the engine).
indicator system. The “Oil Change Required” message
will display in the DID for five seconds after a single 2. Fully push the accelerator pedal, slowly, three times
chime has sounded, to indicate the next scheduled oil
within 10 seconds.
change interval. The engine oil change indicator system
is duty cycle based, which means the engine oil change 3. Without pushing the brake pedal, push the ENGINE
START/STOP button once to return the ignition to the
interval may fluctuate, dependent upon your personal
OFF/LOCK position.
driving style.
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you
time you place the ignition in the ON/RUN position. To start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not
turn off the message temporarily, push and release the reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
OK button. To reset the oil change indicator system (after
performing the scheduled maintenance), refer to the
following procedure.
4
280 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Secondary Method Of Navigating To The Oil Life 3. Push and release the RIGHT arrow button to access
Screen In The DID And Holding Ok
the ”Oil Life” screen.
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change 4. Push and hold the OK button until the “ Oil Life”
indicator system. The “Oil Change Required” message
screen displays.
will flash in the DID display for approximately 10
5. Push and release the DOWN arrow button to select “
seconds after a single chime has sounded to indicate the
Yes,” then push and release the OK button to select
next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change
reset of the Oil Life.
indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the
engine oil change interval may fluctuate, dependent 6. Push and release the Up arrow button to exit the
upon your personal driving style.
submenu screen.
Use the steering wheel DID controls for the following NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you
procedure(s):
start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not
1. Without pushing the brake pedal, place the ignition in reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
the ON/RUN position (do not start the engine).
2. Push and release the DOWN arrow button to scroll
downward through the main menu to “ Vehicle Info.”
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 281
DID Selectable Menu Items
• Oil Life
Push and release the UP or DOWN arrow buttons until • Battery Voltage
the desired Selectable Menu item is displayed in the DID.
• AWD Status
Follow the Menu or submenu prompts as desired.
Driver Assist
Speedometer
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Menu
Push and release the LEFT or RIGHT arrow button to
The DID displays the current ACC system settings. The
toggle between MPH or km/h.
information displayed depends on ACC system status.
Vehicle Info
Push the ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC) ON/
The Vehicle Info consists of the following sub menu:
OFF button (located on the steering wheel) until one of
the following displays in the DID:
• Tire Pressure Monitor
• Coolant Temp
Adaptive Cruise Control Off
• Trans Temp
When ACC is deactivated, the display will read “Adaptive Cruise Control Off.”
• Oil Temp
• Oil Pressure
4
282 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Adaptive Cruise Control Ready
• ACC Proximity Warning
When ACC is activated but the vehicle speed setting has • ACC Unavailable Warning
not been selected, the display will read “Adaptive Cruise • The DID will return to the last display selected after
Control Ready.”
five seconds of no ACC display activity.
Push the SET + or the SET- button (located on the steering For further information, refer to “Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) — If Equipped” in “Understanding The
wheel) and the following will display in the DID:
Features Of Your Vehicle.”
ACC SET
Fuel Economy
When ACC is set, the set speed will display in the
Push and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until
instrument cluster.
the Fuel Economy Menu item is highlighted in the DID.
The ACC screen may display once again if any ACC
activity occurs, which may include any of the following: • Two sub menu pages one with Current value displayed and one without the Current Value displayed:
• Distance Setting Change
– Current MPG (or L/100 km)
– Range (miles or km)
• System Cancel
– Average MPG (or L/100 km)
• Driver Override
– The Max and Min values will correspond to the
• System Off
particular engine requirements
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 283
• Lower end of gauge will be displayed in an amber Audio
color and turn green as Fuel Economy improves.
Push and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until
• MPG will have the gauge fill from the left (clockwise). the Audio Menu displays in the DID.
• L/100 km will have the gauge fill from the right Stored Messages
(counter clockwise).
Push and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until
• Hold OK to reset average fuel economy information. the Messages Menu item is highlighted in the DID. This
feature shows the number of stored warning messages.
Trip Info
Pushing the RIGHT arrow button will allow you to see
Push and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until what the stored messages are.
the Trip Menu item is highlighted in the DID (Toggle left Screen Setup
or right to select Trip A or Trip B). The Trip information
Push and release the UP or DOWN arrow button until
will display the following:
the Screen Setup Menu displays in the DID. Push and
• Distance
release the OK button to enter the sub-menus. The Screen
Setup feature allows you to change what information is
• Average Fuel Economy
displayed in the instrument cluster as well as the location
• Elapsed Time
that information is displayed.
Hold the OK button to reset feature information.
4
284 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
SETTING THE ANALOG CLOCK
Uconnect® SETTINGS
To set the analog clock at the top center of the instrument The Uconnect® system uses a combination of buttons on
panel, push and hold the button until the setting is the touchscreen and buttons on the faceplate located on
correct.
the center of the instrument panel that allows you to
access and change the customer programmable features.
CAUTION!
Do NOT attach any object to the touchscreen, doing
so can result in damage to the touchscreen.
Setting The Analog Clock
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 285
Buttons On The Faceplate
Buttons on the faceplate are located below the Uconnect®
system in the center of the instrument panel. In addition,
there is a Scroll/Enter control knob located on the right
side. Turn the control knob to scroll through menus and
change settings (i.e., 30, 60, 90), push the center of the
control knob one or more times to select or change a
setting (i.e., ON, OFF).
Your Uconnect® system may also have a Screen Off and
Back buttons on the faceplate.
Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN Buttons On The Touchscreen And
Buttons On The Faceplate
1 — Uconnect® Buttons On The Touchscreen
2 — Uconnect® Buttons On The Faceplate
Push the Screen Off button on the faceplate to turn off the
Uconnect® screen. Push the Screen Off button on the
faceplate a second time to turn the screen on.
Push the Back button on the faceplate to exit out of a
Menu or certain option on the Uconnect® system.
4
286 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Buttons On The Touchscreen
NOTE:
Buttons on the touchscreen are accessible on the • Only one touchscreen area may be selected at a time.
Uconnect® Touchscreen.
• Depending on the vehicles options, feature settings
Customer Programmable Features —
may vary.
Uconnect® 8.4 Settings
When making a selection, press the button on the touchPress the “Apps,” or the “Controls,” button on the touch- screen to enter the desired mode. Once in the desired
screen, then press the “Settings” button on the touchscreen mode, press and release the preferred setting until a
to display the menu setting screen. In this mode the check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that
Uconnect® system allows you to access programmable setting has been selected. Once the setting is complete,
features that may be equipped such as Display, Units, either press the Back Arrow button on the touchscreen to
Voice, Clock, Safety & Driving Assistance, Lights, Doors & return to the previous menu, or press the “X” button on
Locks, Auto-On Comfort & Remote Start, Engine Off the touchscreen to close out of the settings screen. PressOptions, Audio, Phone/Bluetooth®, SiriusXM Setup, Re- ing the Up or Down Arrow button on the right side of the
store Settings, Clear Personal Data and System Informa- screen will allow you to toggle up or down through the
tion.
available settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 287
Display
• Display Brightness With Headlights ON
After pressing the “Display” button on the touchscreen When in this display, you may select the brightness with the
the following settings will be available:
headlights on. Adjust the brightness with the “+” and “–”
setting buttons on the touchscreen or by selecting any point
• Display Mode
on the scale between the “+” and “–” buttons on the touchWhen in this display you may select one of the auto screen. Then press the back arrow button on the touchscreen.
display settings. To change Mode status, press and release the “Manual” or “Auto” button on the touchscreen. NOTE: To make changes to the ⬙Display Brightness with
Headlights ON⬙ setting, the headlights must be on and
Then press the back arrow button on the touchscreen.
the interior dimmer switch must not be in the ⬙party⬙ or
NOTE: When Day or Night is selected for the Display ⬙parade⬙ positions.
Mode, the usage of the Parade Mode feature will cause
the radio to activate the Display Brightness Day control • Display Brightness With Headlights OFF
even though the headlights are on.
When in this display, you may select the brightness with the
headlights off. Adjust the brightness with the “+” and “–”
setting buttons on the touchscreen or by selecting any point
on the scale between the “+” and “–” buttons on the touchscreen. Then press the back arrow button on the touchscreen.
4
288 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: To make changes to the ⬙Display Brightness with • Touchscreen Beep
Headlights OFF⬙ setting, the headlights must be off and
When in this display, you may turn on or shut off the
the interior dimmer switch must not be in the ⬙party⬙ or
sound heard when a touchscreen button (button on the
⬙parade⬙ positions.
touchscreen) is pressed. Press the “Touchscreen Beep”
• Set Theme — If Equipped
button on the touchscreen until a check-mark appears
next to the setting, showing that setting has been seThis feature will allow you to choose a theme for the display
lected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to
screen. The theme will change the background color, highreturn to the previous menu.
light color, and button color of the display screen.
• Control Screen Time-Out — If Equipped
• Set Language
When this feature is selected, the Controls Screen will
When in this display, you may select one of multiple
languages (English / Français / Español) for all display stay open for five seconds before the screen times out.
With the feature deselected, the screen will stay open
nomenclature, including the trip functions and the navigation system (if equipped). Press the Set Language until it is manually closed. Press the Control Screen
Time-Out button on the touchscreen until a check-mark
button on the touchscreen, then press the desired lanappears next to the setting, showing that setting has been
guage button on the touchscreen until a check-mark
selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen
appears next to the language, showing that setting has
to return to the previous menu.
been selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 289
• Navigation Turn-By-Turn In Cluster — If Equipped
• Distance
When this feature is selected, the turn-by-turn directions
will appear in the display as the vehicle approaches a
designated turn within a programmed route. To make
your selection, press the “Navigation Turn-By-Turn In
Cluster” button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark
appears next to the setting, showing that setting has been
selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen
to return to the previous menu.
Select from: “mi” or “km.”
Units
After pressing the “Units” button on the touchscreen you
may select each unit of measure independently displayed
in the Driver Information Display (DID), and navigation
system (if equipped). The following selectable units of
measure are listed below:
• Speed
Select from: “MPH” or “km/h.”
• Fuel Consumption
Select from: “MPG” (US), “MPG” (UK), “L/100 km” or
“km/L.”
• Pressure
Select from: “psi,” “kPa,” or “bar.”
• Temperature
Select from: “°C,” or “°F.”
After the desired setting has been selected, press the back
arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous
menu.
4
290 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Voice
Clock
After pressing the “Voice” button on the touchscreen the After pressing the “Clock” button on the touchscreen the
following settings will be available:
following settings will be available:
• Voice Response Length
• Sync Time With GPS
When in this display, you may change the Voice Response
Length settings. To change the Voice Response Length,
press the “Brief” or “Detailed” button on the touchscreen
until a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing
that setting has been selected. Press the back arrow button
on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
This feature will allow you to automatically have the
radio set the time. To change the Sync Time setting, press
the “Sync time with GPS” button on the touchscreen until
a check-mark appears next to the setting, showing that
setting has been selected. Press the back arrow button on
the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
• Show Command List
• Set Time Hours
When in this display, you may change the Show Command
List settings. To change the Show Command List settings,
press the “Always,” “With Help” or “Never” button on the
touchscreen until a check-mark appears next to the setting,
showing that setting has been selected. Press the back
arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous
menu.
This feature will allow you to adjust the hours. The “Sync
time with GPS” button on the touchscreen must be
unchecked. To make your selection, press the “+” or “–”
buttons on the touchscreen to adjust the hours up or
down. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to
return to the previous menu.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 291
• Set Time Minutes
• Show Time In Status Bar — If Equipped
This feature will allow you to adjust the minutes. The
“Sync time with GPS” button on the touchscreen must be
unchecked. To make your selection, press the “+” or “–”
buttons on the touchscreen to adjust the minutes up or
down. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to
return to the previous menu.
This feature will allow you to turn on or shut off the
digital clock in the status bar. To change the Show Time
Status setting press the “Show Time in Status Bar” button
on the touchscreen until a check-mark appears next to
setting, indicating that the setting has been selected. Press
the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the
previous menu or press the “X” button on the touchscreen to close out of the settings screen.
• Time Format
This feature will allow you to select the time format
display setting. Press the “Time Format” button on the
touchscreen until a check-mark appears next to the 12hrs
or 24hrs setting, showing that setting has been selected.
Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return
to the previous menu.
Safety & Driving Assistance
After pressing the “Safety & Driving Assistance” button on
the touchscreen the following settings will be available:
• Forward Collision Warning — If Equipped
The Front Collision Warning (FCW) feature provides an
audible and/or visual warning to potential forward
collisions. The feature can be can be set to Far, or set to
Near. The default status of FCW is the Far setting. This
4
292 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
means the system will warn you of a possible collision
with the vehicle in front of you when you are farther
away. This gives you the most reaction time. To change
the setting for more dynamic driving, select the Near
setting. This warns you of a possible collision when you
are much closer to the vehicle in front of you. To change
the FCW status, press and release the “Near” or “Far”
button. Then press the back arrow button on the touchscreen.
your selection, press the “Forward Collision Warning
Active Braking” button on the touchscreen, until a checkmark appears next to setting, indicating that the setting
had been selected. Press the back arrow button on the
touchscreen to return to the previous menu. For further
information, refer to “Forward Collision Warning (FCW)
With Mitigation” in “Understanding The Features Of
Your Vehicle.”
• LaneSense Warning — If Equipped
For further information, refer to “Adaptive Cruise Con- When this feature is selected, it sets the distance at which
trol (ACC)” in “Understanding The Features Of Your the steering wheel will provide feedback for potential
Vehicle”.
lane departures. The LDW sensitivity can be set to
• Forward Collision Warning (FCW) — Active Braking provide either an “Early,” “Medium,” or “Late” warning
zone start point.
The FCW system includes Advanced Brake Assist (ABA).
When this feature is selected, the ABA applies additional For further information, refer to “LaneSense Warning
brake pressure when the driver requests insufficient (LDW)” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vebrake pressure to avoid a potential frontal collision. The hicle”.
ABA system becomes active at 5 mph (8 km/h). To make
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 293
• LaneSense Strength — If Equipped
provide greater steering feel, requiring greater steering
effort. Press the “Comfort” button on the touchscreen to
When this feature is selected, it sets the strength of the
provide a balance of steering feel and steering effort.
steering wheel feedback for potential lane departures.
Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return
The amount of directional torque the steering system can
to the previous menu.
apply to the steering wheel to correct for vehicle lane
• ParkSense®
departure can be set at “Low,” “Medium” or “High.”
For further information, refer to “Lane Departure Warn- The ParkSense® system will scan for objects behind the
ing (LDW)” in “Understanding The Features Of Your vehicle when the transmission shift lever is in REVERSE
and the vehicle speed is less than 11 mph (18 km/h). It
Vehicle”.
will provide an alert (audible and/or visual) to indicate
• Power Steering — If Equipped
the proximity to other objects. The system can be enabled
When your vehicle is not equipped with Performance with Sound Only, or Sound and Display. To change the
Control, the Steering Feel Options feature will allow you ParkSense® status, press and release the “Sound Only”
to adjust the steering effort and feel. Press the “Sport” or “Sound and Display” button. Then press the back
button on the touchscreen to provide the greatest amount arrow button on the touchscreen. Refer to “ParkSense®”
of steering feel, requiring the highest amount of steering in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for
effort. Press the “Normal” button on the touchscreen to system function and operating information.
4
294 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Front ParkSense® Volume
on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to
setting, indicating that the setting had been selected.
The Front ParkSense® Chime Volume settings can be
Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return
selected from the DID or Uconnect® System. The chime
to the previous menu. ParkSense® will retain its last
volume settings include LOW, MEDIUM, and HIGH. The
known configuration state through ignition cycles.
factory default volume setting is MEDIUM. To make
your selection, press the “Front ParkSense® Vol.” button • Tilt Side Mirrors In Reverse
on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to When this feature is selected, the exterior sideview
setting, indicating that the setting had been selected.
mirrors will tilt downward when the ignition is in the
Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return RUN position and the transmission shift lever is in the
to the previous menu. ParkSense® will retain its last REVERSE position. The mirrors will move back to their
known configuration state through ignition cycles.
previous position when the transmission is shifted out of
REVERSE. To make your selection, press the “Tilt Side
• Rear ParkSense® Volume
Mirrors in Reverse” button on the touchscreen, until a
The Rear ParkSense® Chime Volume settings can be
check-mark appears next to setting, indicating that the
selected from the DID or Uconnect® System. The chime
setting had been selected. Press the back arrow button on
volume settings include LOW, MEDIUM, and HIGH. The
the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
factory default volume setting is MEDIUM. To make
your selection, press the “Rear ParkSense® Vol.” button
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 295
• Blind Spot Alert
Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer to verify sensor
alignment. Having a sensor that is misaligned will result
When this feature is selected, the Blind Spot Alert feature
in the BSM not operating to specification.
Provides alerts, visual and/or audible, to indicate objects in
your blind spot. The Blind Spot Alert feature can be • ParkView® Backup Camera Active Guidelines
activated in “Lights” mode. When this mode is selected,
Your vehicle may be equipped with the ParkView® Rear
the Blind Spot Monitor (BSM) system is activated and will
only show a visual alert in the exterior mirrors. When Back Up Camera Active Guidelines that allows you to see
“Lights & Chime” mode is activated, the Blind Spot active guidelines over the ParkView Back up camera
Monitor (BSM) will show a visual alert in the exterior display whenever the shift lever is put into REVERSE.
mirrors as well as an audible alert when the turn signal is The image will be displayed on the radio touchscreen
on. When “Off” is selected, the Blind Spot Monitor (BSM) display along with a caution note to “check entire sursystem is deactivated. To change the Blind Spot Alert roundings” across the top of the screen. After five secstatus, press the “Off,” “Lights” or “Lights & Chime” onds, this note will disappear. To make your selection,
button on the touchscreen. Then press the back arrow press the “ParkView Backup Camera Active Guidelines”
button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears
button on the touchscreen.
next to setting, indicating that the setting had been
NOTE: If your vehicle has experienced any damage in
selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen
the area where the sensor is located, even if the fascia is
to return to the previous menu.
not damaged, the sensor may have become misaligned.
4
296 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• ParkView® Backup Camera Delay
• Rain Sensing Auto Wipers
When the vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE (with camera
delay turned OFF), the rear camera mode is exited and
the navigation or audio screen appears again. When the
vehicle is shifted out of REVERSE (with camera delay
turned ON), the rear view image with dynamic grid lines
will be displayed for up to 10 seconds after shifting out of
“REVERSE” unless the forward vehicle speed exceeds
8 mph (12 km/h), the transmission is shifted into
“PARK” or the ignition is switched to the OFF position.
To set the ParkView® Backup Camera Delay press the
“Controls” button on the touchscreen, the “settings”
button on the touchscreen, then the “Safety & Driving
Assistance” button on the touchscreen. Press the
“Parkview Backup Camera Delay” button on the touchscreen to turn the ParkView® Delay ON or OFF.
When this feature is selected, the system will automatically activate the windshield wipers if it senses moisture
on the windshield. To make your selection, press the
“Rain Sensing Auto Wipers” button on the touchscreen,
until a check-mark appears next to setting, indicating that
the setting had been selected. Press the back arrow button
on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
• Hill Start Assist — If Equipped
When this feature is selected, the Hill Start Assist (HSA)
system is active. Refer to “Electronic Brake Control
System” in “Starting And Operating” for system function
and operating information. To make your selection, press
the “Hill Start Assist” button on the touchscreen, until a
check-mark appears next to setting, indicating that the
setting had been selected. Press the back arrow button on
the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 297
transmitter. To change the Illuminated Approach status,
press the “+” or “-” button on the touchscreen to select
After pressing the “Lights” button on the touchscreen the
your desired time interval. Press the back arrow button
following settings will be available.
on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu, or
• Headlight Off Delay
push the back button on the faceplate.
Lights
When this feature is selected, it allows adjustment of the
amount of time the headlights remain on after the engine
is shut off. To change the Headlights Off Delay setting,
press the “+” or “-” button on the touchscreen to select
your desired time interval, and choose either 0 sec, 30 sec,
60 sec or 90 seconds. Press the back arrow button on the
touchscreen to return to the previous menu, or push the
back button on the faceplate.
• Headlights With Wipers — If Equipped
When this feature is selected, and the headlight switch is
in the AUTO position, the headlights will turn on approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on.
The headlights will also turn off when the wipers are
turned off if they were turned on by this feature. To make
your selection, press the “Headlights With Wipers” button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next
• Headlight Illumination On Approach
to setting, indicating that the setting has been selected.
When this feature is selected, the headlights will activate Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return
and remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds when the doors to the previous menu, or push the back button on the
are unlocked with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) faceplate.
4
298 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Auto Dim High Beams — If Equipped
that the setting has been selected. Press the back arrow
button on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu, or
When this feature is selected, the high beam headlights
push the back button on the faceplate.
will activate/deactivate automatically under certain conditions. To make your selection, press the “Auto High • Flash Lights With Lock
Beams” button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark When this feature is selected, the hazard lights will flash
appears next to setting, indicating that the setting has when the doors are locked or unlocked with the Remote
been selected. Press the back arrow button on the touch- Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, or when using the
screen to return to the previous menu, or push the back passive entry feature. This feature may be selected with
button on the faceplate. Refer to “Lights — If Equipped” or without the sound horn on lock feature selected. To
in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for make your selection, press the “Flash Lights with Lock”
further information.
button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears
• Daytime Running Lights — If Equipped
next to setting, indicating that the setting has been
selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen
When this feature is selected, the headlights will turn on
to return to the previous menu, or push the back button
whenever the engine is running. To make your selection,
on the faceplate.
press the “Daytime Running Lights” button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to setting, indicating
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 299
passive entry feature. This feature may be selected with
or without the sound horn on lock feature selected. To
After pressing the “Doors & Locks” button on the touchmake your selection, press the “Flash Lights with Lock”
screen the following settings will be available:
button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears
• Auto Unlock On Exit
next to setting, indicating that the setting has been
When this feature is selected, all doors will unlock when selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen
the vehicle is stopped, the transmission is in the PARK or to return to the previous menu.
NEUTRAL position and the driver’s door is opened. To • Sound Horn With Lock
make your selection, press the “Auto Unlock On Exit”
button on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears When this feature is selected, the horn will sound when
next to the setting, showing that the setting has been the door locks are activated. To make your selection,
selected. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen press either the “Off,” “1st Press,” or “2nd Press” button
on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to
to return to the previous menu.
setting, showing that setting has been selected. Press the
• Flash Lights With Lock
back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the
When this feature is selected, the exterior lights will flash previous menu.
when the doors are locked or unlocked with the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, or when using the
Doors & Locks
4
300 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Sound Horn With Remote Start
When this feature is selected, the horn will sound when
the remote start is activated. To make your selection,
press the “Sound Horn with Remote Start” button on the
touchscreen until a check-mark appears next to setting,
showing that setting has been selected. Press the back
arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous
menu.
• 1st Press Of Key Fob Unlocks
When ⬙Driver Door⬙ is selected with 1st Press Of Key Fob
Unlocks, only the driver’s door will unlock with the first
press of the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
UNLOCK button. You must press the RKE transmitter
UNLOCK button twice to unlock the passenger’s doors.
When ⬙All Doors⬙ is selected for 1st Press Of Key Fob
Unlocks, all doors will unlock on the first press of the
RKE transmitter UNLOCK button.
NOTE: If the vehicle is programmed 1st Press Of Key Fob
Unlocks “All Doors,” all doors will unlock no matter
which Passive Entry equipped door handle is grasped. If
1st Press Of Key Fob Unlocks “Driver Door” is programmed, only the driver’s door will unlock when the
driver’s door is grasped. With Passive Entry, if 1st Press
Of Key Fob Unlocks “Driver Door” is programmed,
touching the handle more than once will only result in
the driver’s door opening. If “Driver Door” is selected,
once the driver door is opened, the interior door lock/
unlock switch can be used to unlock all doors (or use
RKE transmitter).
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 301
• Passive Entry
enhance driver mobility when entering and exiting the
vehicle. To make your selection, press the “Personal Settings Linked to Key Fob” button on the touchscreen, until
a check-mark appears next to setting, showing that setting
has been selected. Press the back arrow button on the
touchscreen to return to the previous menu, or push the
back button on the faceplate.
This feature allows you to lock and unlock the vehicles
door(s) without having to push the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter LOCK or UNLOCK buttons. To make
your selection, press the “Passive Entry” button on the
touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to the
setting, showing that the setting has been selected. Press
the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the NOTE: The seat will return to the memorized seat
previous menu. Refer to “Keyless Enter-N-Go™” in location (if Recall Memory with Remote Key Unlock is set
to ON) when the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
“Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle”.
is used to unlock the door. Refer to “Driver Memory
• Personal Settings Linked to Key Fob On/Off — If
Seat” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle”
Equipped
for further information.
This feature provides automatic recall of all settings stored
to a memory location (driver’s seat, exterior mirrors,
steering column position and radio station pre-sets) to
4
302 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Auto Comfort Systems — If Equipped
Engine Off Options
After pressing the “Auto-On Comfort” button on the After pressing the “Engine Off Options” button on the
touchscreen the following settings will be available:
touchscreen the following settings will be available:
• Auto-On Driver Heated/Ventilated Seat & Steering
Wheel With Vehicle Start — If Equipped
When this feature is selected the driver’s heated seat and
heated steering wheel will automatically turn ON when
temperatures are below 40° F (4.4° C). When temperatures are above 80° F (26.7° C) the driver vented seat will
turn ON. To make your selection, press the “Auto-On
Driver Heated/Ventilated Seat & Steering Wheel With
Vehicle Start” button to select from “Off,” “Remote Start”
or “All Starts” until a check-mark appears next to setting,
showing that setting has been selected. Press the back
arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous
menu.
• Easy Exit Seat — If Equipped
When this feature is selected, the Driver’s seat will
automatically move rearward once the engine is shut off.
To make your selection, press the “Easy Exit Seat” button
on the touchscreen, until a check-mark appears next to
setting, showing that setting has been selected. Press the
back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the
previous menu.
• Engine Off Power Delay
When this feature is selected, the power window switches,
radio, Uconnect® Phone system (if equipped), DVD video
system (if equipped), power sunroof (if equipped), and
power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes after
the ignition is cycled to OFF. Opening either front door will
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 303
cancel this feature. To change the Engine Off Power Delay
setting, press the “+” or “-” button on the touchscreen to
select your desired time interval, and choose from
“0 seconds,” “45 seconds,” “5 minutes” or “10 minutes.”
Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to
the previous menu.
• Headlight Off Delay
When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to
have the headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds
when exiting the vehicle. To change the Headlight Off
Delay status press the “+” or “–” button on the touchscreen to select your desired time interval. Press the back
arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous
menu.
• Balance/Fade
This feature allows you to adjust the Balance and Fade
settings. Press and drag the speaker icon, use the arrows
to adjust, or tap the ‘C’ icon to readjust to the center. Press
the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the
previous menu.
• Equalizer
This feature allows you to adjust the Bass, Mid and Treble
settings. Adjust the settings with the “+” and “–” setting
buttons on the touchscreen or by selecting any point on
the scale between the “+” and “–” buttons on the
touchscreen. Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
NOTE: Bass/Mid/Treble allow you to simply slide your
finger up or down to change the setting as well as press
After pressing the “Audio” button on the touchscreen the directly on the desired setting.
following settings will be available.
Audio
4
304 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Speed Adjusted Volume
button on the touchscreen, choose a level from –3 to +3.
Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return
This feature increases or decreases volume relative to
to the previous menu.
vehicle speed. To change the Speed Adjusted Volume
press the “Off,” “1,” “2” or “3” button on the touchscreen. • Loudness — If Equipped
Press the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return Loudness improves sound quality at lower volumes. To
to the previous menu.
make your selection, press the “Loudness” button on the
• Surround Sound — If Equipped
touchscreen, then choose “Yes” or “No.” Press the back
arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the previous
This feature provides simulated surround sound mode.
menu.
To make your selection, press the “Surround Sound”
button on the touchscreen, select “On” or “Off.” Press the Phone/Bluetooth®
back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the After pressing the “Phone/Bluetooth®” button on the
previous menu.
touchscreen the following settings will be available:
• AUX Volume Offset — If Equipped
• Paired Phones
This feature provides the ability to tune the audio level This feature shows which phones are paired to the
for portable devices connected through the AUX input. Phone/Bluetooth® system. For further information, refer
To make your selection, press the AUX Volume Match to the Uconnect® Supplement Manual.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 305
• Paired Audio Sources
• Subscription Information
This feature shows which audio devices are paired to the New vehicle purchasers or lessees will receive a free
Phone/Bluetooth® system. For further information, refer limited time subscription to SiriusXM Satellite Radio
with your radio. Following the expiration of the free
to the Uconnect® Supplement Manual.
services, it will be necessary to access the information on
SiriusXM Setup — If Equipped
the Subscription Information screen to re-subscribe.
After pressing the “SiriusXM Setup” button on the touchPress the “Subscription Info” button on the touchscreen
screen, the following settings will be available:
to access the Subscription Information screen.
• Channel Skip
Write down the SIRIUS ID numbers for your receiver. To
SiriusXM can be programmed to designate a group of reactivate your service, either call the number listed on
channels that are the most desirable to listen to or to the screen or visit the provider online.
exclude undesirable channels while scanning. To make
your selection, press the “Channel Skip” button on the NOTE: SiriusXM Travel Link is a separate subscription
touchscreen, select the channels you would like to skip and is available for U.S. residents only.
followed by pressing the back arrow button on the
touchscreen.
4
306 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Restore Settings
Clear Personal Data
After pressing the “Restore Settings” button on the After pressing the “Clear Personal Data Settings” button on
touchscreen the following settings will be available:
the touchscreen the following settings will be available:
• Restore Settings
• Clear Personal Data
When this feature is selected it will reset the Display,
Clock, Audio, and Radio Settings to their default settings.
To restore the settings to their default setting, press the
Restore Settings button. A pop-up will appear asking
⬙Are you sure you want to reset your settings to default?”
select “Yes” to restore, or “Cancel” to exit. Once the
settings are restored, a pop up appears stating ⬙settings
reset to default.⬙ Press the okay button on the touchscreen
to exit.
When this feature is selected it will remove personal data
including Bluetooth® devices and presets. To remove
personal information, press the “Clear Personal Data”
button and a pop-up will appear asking ⬙Are you sure
you want to clear all personal data?” select “OK” to
Clear, or “Cancel” to exit. Once the data has been cleared,
a pop up appears stating ⬙Personal data cleared”. Press
the back arrow button on the touchscreen to return to the
previous menu.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 307
System Information
After pressing the “System Information” button on the
touchscreen the following information will be available:
The Media hub also allows the use of an SD card. For further
information, refer to the Uconnect® Supplement Manual.
• System Information
When System Information is selected, a System Information
screen will appear displaying the system software version.
4
Uconnect® RADIOS — IF EQUIPPED
For detailed information about your Uconnect® radio,
refer to your Uconnect® Supplement Manual.
iPod®/USB/MP3 CONTROL
This feature allows an iPod® or an external USB device to
be plugged into the USB port.
iPod® control supports Mini, 4G, Photo, Nano, 5G iPod®
and iPhone® devices. Some iPod® software versions
may not fully support the iPod® control features. Please
visit Apple’s website for software updates.
AUX/USB/SD Card Ports
1 — Aux Jack
2 — USB Port
3 — SD Card Slot
308 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Located on the rear of the front center console are dual STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS
USB “Charge Only” ports.
The remote sound system controls are located on the rear
surface of the steering wheel at the three and nine o’clock
positions.
Rear USB Charging Ports
The USB “Charge Only” ports will recharge battery
operated USB devices when connected.
Remote Sound System Controls (Back View Of Steering
Wheel)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 309
The right-hand control is a rocker-type switch with a
push-button in the center and controls the volume and
mode of the sound system. Pushing the top of the rocker
switch will increase the volume, and pushing the bottom
of the rocker switch will decrease the volume.
The button located in the center of the left-hand control
will tune to the next preset station that you have programmed in the radio preset button.
CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE — IF EQUIPPED
Pushing the center button will make the radio switch To keep a CD/DVD in good condition, take the following
between the various modes available (AM/FM/SAT/ precautions:
AUX/VES, etc.).
1. Handle the disc by its edge; avoid touching the
surface.
The left-hand control is a rocker-type switch with a
push-button in the center. The function of the left-hand 2. If the disc is stained, clean the surface with a soft cloth,
control is different depending on which mode you are in.
wiping from center to edge.
The following describes the left-hand control operation in 3. Do not apply paper or tape to the disc; avoid scratcheach mode.
ing the disc.
Radio Operation
4. Do not use solvents such as benzene, thinner, cleaners,
or anti-static sprays.
Pushing the top of the switch will “Seek” up for the next
listenable station and pushing the bottom of the switch 5. Store the disc in its case after playing.
will “Seek” down for the next listenable station.
4
310 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be
7. Do not store the disc where temperatures may become
turned down or off during mobile phone operation when
too high.
not using Uconnect® (if equipped).
NOTE: If you experience difficulty in playing a particular
disc, it may be damaged (e.g., scratched, reflective coat- CLIMATE CONTROLS
6. Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight.
ing removed, a hair, moisture or dew on the disc) The air conditioning and heating system is designed to
oversized, or have protection encoding. Try a known make you comfortable in all types of weather. This
good disc before considering disc player service.
system can be operated through either the controls on the
instrument panel or through the Uconnect® system disRADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
play.
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in
When the Uconnect® system is in different modes (Rayour vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from
dio, Player, Settings, More, etc.) the driver and passenger
your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated
temperature settings will be indicated at the top of the
by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is
display.
not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 311
Dual Zone Automatic Climate Controls With
Touchscreen
Buttons On The Faceplate
Buttons On The Touchscreen
Buttons on the touchscreen are accessible on the Uconnect®
system screen.
The buttons on the faceplate are located below the
Uconnect® screen.
4
Uconnect® 8.4 Automatic Temperature Controls —
Buttons On The Touchscreen
Automatic Climate Controls — Buttons On The
Faceplate
312 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Button Descriptions (Applies To Both Buttons On The 4. AUTO Operation Button
Faceplate And Buttons On The Touchscreen)
Automatically controls the interior cabin temperature by
1. MAX A/C Button
adjusting airflow distribution and amount. Performing
Press and release to change the current setting, the this function will cause the system to switch between
indicator illuminates when MAX A/C is ON. Performing manual mode and automatic modes. Refer to “Automatic
this function again will cause the MAX A/C operation to Operation” for more information.
switch into manual mode and the MAX A/C indicator 5. Front Defrost Button
will turn off.
Press and release to change the current airflow setting to
2. A/C Button
Defrost mode. The indicator illuminates when this feaPress and release to change the current setting, the ture is ON. Air comes from the windshield and side
indicator illuminates when A/C is ON. Performing this window demist outlets. When the defrost button is
function again will cause the A/C operation to switch selected, the blower level will increase. Use Defrost mode
into manual mode and the A/C indicator will turn off. with maximum temperature settings for best windshield
and side window defrosting and defogging. Performing
3. Recirculation Button
this function will cause the ATC to switch into manual
Press and release to change the current setting, the mode. If the front defrost mode is turned off the climate
system will return the previous setting.
indicator illuminates when ON.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 313
6. Rear Defrost Button
CAUTION! (Continued)
Press and release this button to turn on the rear window
defroster and the heated outside mirrors (if equipped).
An indicator will illuminate when the rear window
defroster is on. The rear window defroster automatically
turns off after 10 minutes.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
7. Passenger Temperature Control Up Button
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
(Continued)
Provides the passenger with independent temperature
control. Push the button on the faceplate for warmer
temperature settings or on the touchscreen, press and
slide the temperature bar button towards the red arrow
for warmer temperature settings.
NOTE: Pressing this button while in Sync mode will
automatically exit Sync.
4
314 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
8. Passenger Temperature Control Down Button
10. Blower Control
Provides the passenger with independent temperature
control. Push the button on the faceplate for cooler
temperature settings or on the touchscreen, press and
slide the temperature bar button towards the blue arrow
for cooler temperature settings.
Blower control is used to regulate the amount of air forced
through the climate system. There are seven blower speeds
available. Adjusting the blower will cause automatic mode
to switch to manual operation. The speeds can be selected
using either the blower control knob on the faceplate or the
buttons on the touchscreen as follows:
NOTE: Pressing this button while in Sync mode will
Blower Control Knob On The Faceplate
automatically exit Sync.
The blower speed increases as you turn the blower
9. SYNC
control knob clockwise from the lowest blower setting.
Press the Sync button on the touchscreen to toggle the The blower speed decreases as you turn the blower
Sync feature On/Off. The Sync indicator is illuminated control knob counterclockwise.
when this feature is enabled. Sync is used to synchronize
the passenger temperature setting with the driver tem- Button On The Touchscreen
perature setting. Changing the passenger temperature Use the small blower icon to reduce the blower setting
setting while in Sync will automatically exit this feature. and the large blower icon to increase the blower setting.
Blower can also be selected by pressing the blower bar
area between the icons.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 315
11. Modes
• Bi-Level Mode
Air comes from the instrument panel outlets
The airflow distribution mode can be adjusted so air
and floor outlets. A slight amount of air is
comes from the instrument panel outlets, floor outlets,
directed
through the defrost and side window demisdefrost outlets and demist outlets. The Mode settings are
ter
outlets.
as follows:
• Panel Mode
NOTE: BI-LEVEL mode is designed under comfort conAir comes from the outlets in the instrument ditions to provide cooler air out of the panel outlets and
panel. Each of these outlets can be individu- warmer air from the floor outlets.
ally adjusted to direct the flow of air. The air vanes of
• Floor Mode
the center outlets and outboard outlets can be moved
Air comes from the floor outlets. A slight
up and down or side to side to regulate airflow
amount of air is directed through the defrost
direction. There is a shut off wheel located below the
and side window demister outlets.
air vanes to shut off or adjust the amount of airflow
• Mix Mode
from these outlets.
Air comes from the floor, defrost and side
window demist outlets. This mode works best
in cold or snowy conditions.
4
316 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: In Sync mode, this button will also automatically
adjust the passenger temperature setting at the same
Press and release this button to turn the Climate Control
time.
ON/OFF.
Climate Control Functions
13. Driver Temperature Control Down Button
A/C (Air Conditioning)
Provides the driver with independent temperature control. Push the button on the faceplate for cooler tempera- The Air Conditioning (A/C) button allows the operator
ture settings or on the touchscreen, press and slide the to manually activate or deactivate the air conditioning
temperature bar button towards the blue arrow for cooler system. When the air conditioning system is turned on,
cool dehumidified air will flow through the outlets into
temperature settings.
the cabin. For improved fuel economy, press the A/C
NOTE: In Sync mode, this button will also automatically
button to turn off the air conditioning and manually
adjust the passenger temperature setting at the same time.
adjust the blower and airflow mode settings. Also, make
14. Driver Temperature Control Up Button
sure to select only Panel, Bi-Level or Floor modes.
12. Climate Control OFF Button
Provides the driver with independent temperature con- NOTE:
trol. Push the button on the faceplate for warmer temperature settings or on the touchscreen, press and slide • If fog or mist appears on the windshield or side glass,
select Defrost mode and increase blower speed if
the temperature bar button towards the red arrow for
needed.
warmer temperature settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 317
• If your air conditioning performance seems lower than Recirculation Control
expected, check the front of the A/C condenser (loWhen outside air contains smoke, odors, or
cated in front of the radiator), for an accumulation of
high humidity, or if rapid cooling is desired,
dirt or insects. Clean with a gentle water spray from
you may wish to recirculate interior air by
the front of the radiator and through the condenser.
pressing the Recirculation control button. The
recirculation indicator will illuminate when this button is
MAX A/C
selected. Push the button a second time to turn off the
MAX A/C sets the control for maximum cooling perfor- Recirculation mode and allow outside air into the vehicle.
mance.
NOTE: In cold weather, use of recirculation mode may lead
Press and release to toggle between MAX A/C and the to excessive window fogging. The recirculation feature may
prior settings. The button illuminates when MAX A/C is be unavailable (button on the touchscreen greyed out) if
ON.
conditions exist that could create fogging on the inside of the
In MAX A/C, the blower level and mode position can be windshield. On systems with Manual Climate Controls, the
adjusted to desired user settings. Pressing other settings Recirculation mode is not allowed in Defrost mode to
will cause the MAX A/C operation to switch to the improve window clearing operation. Recirculation will be
disabled automatically if this mode is selected. Attempting
selected setting and MAX A/C to exit.
to use Recirculation while in this mode will cause the LED in
the control button to blink and then turn off.
4
318 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC)
NOTE:
• It is not necessary to move the temperature settings.
The system automatically adjusts the temperature,
1. Press the AUTO button on the faceplate or the AUTO
mode, and blower speed to provide comfort as quickly
button on the touchscreen on the Automatic Temperaas possible.
ture Control (ATC) Panel.
• The temperature can be displayed in U.S. or Metric
2. Next, adjust the temperature you would like the
units by selecting the US/M customer-programmable
system to maintain by adjusting the driver and pasfeature. Refer to the “Uconnect® System Settings” in
senger temperature control buttons. Once the desired
this section of the manual.
temperature is displayed, the system will achieve and
To provide you with maximum comfort in the Automatic
automatically maintain that comfort level.
mode, during cold start-ups the blower fan will remain
3. When the system is set up for your comfort level, it is on low until the engine warms up. The blower will
not necessary to change the settings. You will experi- increase in speed and transition into Auto mode.
ence the greatest efficiency by simply allowing the
system to function automatically.
Automatic Operation
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 319
Manual Operation Override
Operating Tips
The system allows for manual selection of blower speed, NOTE: Refer to the chart at the end of this section for
air distribution mode, A/C status and recirculation con- suggested control settings for various weather conditrol.
tions.
The blower fan speed can be set to any fixed speed by
adjusting the blower control. The fan will now operate at
a fixed speed until additional speeds are selected. This
allows the front occupants to control the volume of air
circulated in the vehicle and cancel the Auto mode.
Summer Operation
The engine cooling system must be protected with a
high-quality antifreeze coolant to provide proper corrosion protection and to protect against engine overheating.
A solution of 50% OAT (Organic Additive Technology)
The operator can also select the direction of the airflow coolant that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material
by selecting one of the available mode settings. A/C Standard MS.90032 and 50% water is recommended.
operation and Recirculation control can also be manually Refer to “Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your
Vehicle” for proper coolant selection.
selected in Manual operation.
NOTE: Each of these features operates independently
from each other. If any feature is controlled manually,
temperature control will continue to operate automatically.
4
320 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Winter Operation
Window Fogging
Use of the air Recirculation mode during winter months Interior fogging on the windshield can be quickly reis not recommended because it may cause window moved by turning the mode selector to Defrost. The
fogging.
Defrost/Floor mode can be used to maintain a clear
windshield and provide sufficient heating. If side winVacation Storage
dow fogging becomes objectionable, increase blower
Any time you store your vehicle or keep it out of service speed to improve airflow and clearing of the side win(i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air dows. Vehicle windows tend to fog on the inside in mild
conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in the but rainy or humid weather.
fresh air and high blower setting. This will ensure
adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility NOTE:
of compressor damage when the system is started again. • Recirculate without A/C should not be used for long
periods, as fogging may occur.
• Automatic Temperature Controls (ATC) will automatically adjust the climate control settings to reduce or
eliminate window fogging on the front windshield.
When this occurs, recirculation will be unavailable.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 321
Outside Air Intake
A/C Air Filter
Make sure the air intake, located directly in front of the
windshield, is free of obstructions such as leaves. Leaves
collected in the air intake may reduce airflow, and if they
enter the plenum, they could plug the water drains. In
winter months, make sure the air intake is clear of ice,
slush, and snow.
The climate control system filters outside air containing
dust, pollen and some odors. Strong odors cannot be
totally filtered out. Refer to “Maintenance Procedures” in
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for filter replacement instructions.
4
322 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Manual Control Setting Suggestions for Various Weather Conditions
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 323
Uconnect® VOICE RECOGNITION QUICK TIPS
If you see the
icon on your touchscreen, you have
the Uconnect® 8.4AN system. If not, you have a
Uconnect® 8.4A system.
Introducing Uconnect®
Start using Uconnect® Voice Recognition with these
helpful quick tips. It provides the key Voice Commands Get Started
and tips you need to know to control your Uconnect® 5.0 All you need to control your Uconnect® system with
or 8.4A/8.4AN system.
your voice are the buttons on your steering wheel.
1. Visit UconnectPhone.com to check mobile device and
feature compatibility and to find phone pairing instructions.
2. Reduce background noise. Wind and passenger conversations are examples of noise that may impact
recognition.
Uconnect® 8.4AN
4
324 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
3. Speak clearly at a normal pace and volume while
facing straight ahead. The microphone is positioned
on the rearview mirror and aimed at the driver.
4. Each time you give a Voice Command, you must first
push either the VR or Phone button, wait until after
the beep, then say your Voice Command.
5. You can interrupt the help message or system prompts
by pushing the VR or Phone button and saying a Voice
Command from current category.
Uconnect® Voice Command
1 — Push To Initiate Or To Answer A Phone Call, Send Or
Receive A Text
2 — For all radios: Push To Begin Radio or Media functions.
For 8.4A/8.4AN only: Push to begin Navigation, Apps And
Climate Functions
3 — Push To End Call
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 325
Basic Voice Commands
The basic Voice Commands below can be given at any
point while using your Uconnect® system.
Push the VR button
. After the beep, say:
• Cancel to stop a current voice session
4
• Help to hear a list of suggested Voice Commands
• Repeat to listen to the system prompts again
Notice the visual cues that inform you of your voice
recognition system’s status. Cues appear on the touchscreen.
Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN
326 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Radio
Use your voice to quickly get to the AM, FM or SiriusXM
Satellite Radio stations you would like to hear. (Subscription or included SiriusXM Satellite Radio trial required.)
Push the VR button
. After the beep, say:
• Tune to ninety-five-point-five FM
• Tune to Satellite Channel Hits 1
TIP: At any time, if you are not sure of what to say or
want to learn a Voice Command, push the VR button
and say “Help.” The system will provide you
with a list of commands.
Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN Radio
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 327
TIP: Press the Browse button on the touchscreen to see all
of the music on your iPod® or USB device. Your Voice
Uconnect® offers connections via USB, SD, Bluetooth®
Command must match exactly how the artist, album,
and auxiliary ports (If Equipped). Voice operation is only
song and genre information is displayed.
available for connected USB and iPod® devices. (Remote
CD player optional and not available on all vehicles.)
Media
4
. After the beep, say one of the
Push the VR button
following commands and follow the prompts to
switch your media source or choose an artist.
• Change source to Bluetooth®
• Change source to iPod®
• Change source to USB
• Play artist Beethoven; Play album Greatest Hits; Play
song Moonlight Sonata; Play genre Classical
Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN Media
328 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Phone
Making and answering hands-free phone calls is easy
with Uconnect®. When the Phonebook button is illuminated on your touchscreen, your system is ready. Check
UconnectPhone.com for mobile phone compatibility and
pairing instructions.
TIP: When providing a Voice Command, push the
Phone button
and say “Call,” then pronounce the
name exactly as it appears in your phone book. When
a contact has multiple phone numbers, you can say
“Call John Smith work.”
. After the beep, say one of
Push the Phone button
the following commands:
• Call John Smith
• Dial 123-456-7890 and follow the system prompts
• Redial (call previous outgoing phone number)
• Call back (call previous incoming phone number)
Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN Phone
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 329
Voice Text Reply
Uconnect® will announce incoming text messages. Push
and say Listen. (Must have comthe Phone button
patible mobile phone paired to Uconnect® system.)
1. Once an incoming text message is read to you, push
. After the beep, say: “Reply.”
the Phone button
2. Listen to the Uconnect® prompts. After the beep,
repeat one of the pre-defined messages and follow the
system prompts.
PRE-DEFINED VOICE TEXT REPLY RESPONSES
Yes.
Stuck in Traffic.
See you later.
Start without
No.
I’ll be Late.
me.
Okay.
Where are you? I will be minutes
Are you there
Call me.
late.
yet?
I’ll call you
I need
See you in
later.
directions.
of
minutes.
I’m on my way. Can’t talk right
now.
I’m lost.
Thanks.
TIP: Your mobile phone must have the full implementation of the Message Access Profile (MAP) to take
advantage of this feature. For details about MAP, visit
UconnectPhone.com. Apple iPhone® iOS6 or later supports reading incoming text messages only.
4
330 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Climate (8.4A/8.4AN)
Too hot? Too cold? Adjust vehicle temperatures handsfree and keep everyone comfortable while you keep
moving ahead. (If vehicle is equipped with climate
control.)
. After the beep, say one of the
Push the VR button
following commands:
• Set driver temperature to 70 degrees
• Set passenger temperature to 70 degrees
TIP: Voice Command for Climate may only be used to
adjust the interior temperature of your vehicle. Voice
Command will not work to adjust the heated seats or
steering wheel if equipped.
Uconnect 8.4A/8.4AN Climate
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 331
Navigation (8.4A/8.4AN)
The Uconnect® navigation feature helps you save time
and become more productive when you know exactly
how to get to where you want to go. (Navigation is
optional on the Uconnect® 8.4A system. See your dealer
to activate navigation at any time.)
1. To enter a destination, push the VR button
the beep, say:
4
. After
• For the 8.4A Uconnect® System, say: “Enter state.”
• For the 8.4AN Uconnect® System, say: “Navigate to
800 Chrysler Drive Auburn Hills, Michigan.”
2. Then follow the system prompts.
TIP: To start a POI search, push the VR button
After the beep, say: “ Find nearest coffee shop.”
.
Uconnect® 8.4A/8.4AN Navigation
332 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Uconnect® Access* (8.4A/8.4AN)
Remote Door Lock/Unlock
An included trial and/or subscription is required to take
advantage of the Uconnect® Access services in the next
section of this guide. To register with Uconnect® Access,
press the Apps button on the 8.4-inch touchscreen to get
started. Detailed registration instructions can be found
on the next page.
Stolen Vehicle Assistance
Remote Vehicle Start**
Remote Horn and Lights
Yelp® Search
Voice Texting
*Uconnect® Access is available only on equipped veRoadside Assistance Call
hicles purchased within the continental United States and
Alaska. Services can only be used where coverage is
Wi-Fi Hotspot***
available; see coverage map for details.
**If vehicle is equipped.
9-1-1 Call
***Extra charges apply.
Theft Alarm Notification
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 333
Register (8.4A/8.4AN)
1. Press the Apps button on the bottom of the 8.4-inch
touchscreen.
2. If a pop-up message appears, press Register or go to
the Favorite Apps menu and press Uconnect® Registration.
4
3. Read through the registration instructions. Enter and
confirm your personal email address. Then press Send.
4. Check your personal inbox for an email from
Uconnect® Access.
5. Click on the link inside the email within 72 hours and
complete the easy online registration process to create
a personal Mopar® Owner Connect account linked to
your vehicle.
Uconnect® Registration 8.4A/8.4AN
334 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Download the Uconnect® Access App to a compatible
Securely link your mobile device to your vehicle with the Apple® or Android® mobile devices. All you need to do is:
Uconnect® Access App. Once you have downloaded the 1. After registering with Uconnect® Access, log on
App, you may start your vehicle or lock it from virtually
to your Mopar® Owner Connect account at
any distance. (Vehicle must be properly equipped with
moparownerconnect.com.
factory-installed Remote Start.)
2. On the Dashboard page, enter your mobile phone
number to receive a link to download the App on your
mobile device. Or go to iTunes®, or Google Play, and
search for the Uconnect® Access App.
Mobile App (8.4A/8.4AN)
3. To activate the App, enter your Mopar Owner Connect
user name and password and log in. Your vehicle is
then connected to your mobile device.
Mobile App
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 335
Voice Texting (8.4A/8.4AN)
You must be registered with Uconnect® Access and have
a compatible MAP – enabled smartphone to use your
voice to send a personalized text message.
1. To send a message, push the Phone button
. After
the beep, say the following command: “Send mesTIP:
sage to John Smith.”
2. Listen to the prompt. After the beep, dictate the • Not compatible with iPhone®.
message you would like to send. Wait for Uconnect®
• Messages are limited to 140 characters.
to process your message.
• The Messaging button on the touchscreen must be
3. The Uconnect® system will repeat your message and
illuminated to use the feature.
provide a variety of options to add to, delete, send or
hear the message again. After the beep, tell Uconnect®
what you’d like to do. For instance, if you’re happy
with your message, after the beep, say: “Send.”
4
336 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
TIP: Once you perform a search, you can reorganize the
results by selecting either the Best Match, Rating or
Once registered with Uconnect® Access, you can use
Distance tab on the top of the touchscreen display.
your voice to search for the most popular places or things
around you.
Yelp® (8.4A/8.4AN)
1. Press the “Apps” button on the touchscreen.
2. Press the “All Apps” button on the touchscreen.
3. Press the “Yelp” button on the touchscreen.
4. Once the YELP® home screen appears on the touch, then say: “YELP
screen, push the VR button
search.”
5. Listen to the system prompts and after the beep, tell
Uconnect® the place or business that you’d like
Uconnect® to find.
Yelp®
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 337
SiriusXM Travel Link™ (8.4A/8.4AN)
Need to find a gas station, view local movie listings,
check a sports score or the 5 - day weather forecast?
SiriusXM Travel Link™ is a suite of services that brings a
wealth of information right to your Uconnect® 8.4AN
system. (Not available for 8.4A system.)
4
. After the beep, say one of the
Push the VR button
following commands:
• Show fuel prices
• Show 5 - day weather forecast
• Show extended weather
TIP: Traffic alerts are not accessible with Voice Command.
SiriusXM Travel Link™
338 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• The term IC before the certification/registration number only signifies that Industry Canada technical speciThis device complies with FCC rules Part 15 and Industry
fications were met.
Canada RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following
two conditions:
Additional Information
General Information
© 2014 Chrysler Group LLC. All rights reserved. Mopar and
Uconnect are registered trademarks and Mopar Owner
2. This device must accept any interference that may be Connect is a trademark of Chrysler Group LLC. Android is
received including interference that may cause unde- a trademark of Google Inc. SiriusXM and all related marks
sired operation.
and logos are trademarks of SiriusXM Radio Inc. Yelp, Yelp
logo, Yelp burst and related marks are registered trademarks
NOTE:
of Yelp.
• The transmitter has been tested and it complies with FCC
and IC rules. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could
void the user’s authority to operate the device.
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 339
Uconnect® System Support:
• U.S. residents call 1-877-855-8400 or visit
DriveUconnect.com
• Canadian residents call 1-800-465-2001 (English) or
1-800-387-9983 (French) or visit DriveUconnect.ca
Mon. – Fri., 7:00 am – 12:00 am, ET
Sat., 8:00 am – 10:00 pm, ET
Sun., 9:00 am – 5:00 pm, ET
Uconnect® Access Services Support 1-855-792-4241.
Please have your Uconnect® Security PIN ready when
you call.
4
STARTING AND OPERATING
CONTENTS
䡵 STARTING PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346 䡵 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . .351
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
▫ Key Ignition Park Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
▫ Keyless Enter-N-Go™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
▫ Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System . . .353
▫ Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
▫ Eight-Speed Automatic Transmission . . . . . . .354
▫ Extreme Cold Weather
䡵 AUTOSTICK — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . .
(Below –20°F Or −29°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
䡵 ALL-WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) — IF EQUIPPED
▫ If Engine Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
䡵 DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES . . . . . . .
▫ After Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
▫ Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED . . .351
▫ Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. .361
. .364
. .365
. .365
. .365
5
342 STARTING AND OPERATING
䡵 DRIVING THROUGH WATER . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
▫ Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
▫ Flowing/Rising Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
▫ Ready Alert Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
▫ Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
▫ Rain Brake Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
䡵 ELECTRIC POWER STEERING . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
▫ ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light
And ESC OFF Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . .383
䡵 FUEL SAVER TECHNOLOGY 5.7L ENGINE
ONLY — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
▫ Synchronizing ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .384
䡵 PARKING BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369 䡵 TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .384
䡵 BRAKE SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
▫ Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .384
䡵 ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM . . . .373
▫ Tire Identification Number (TIN). . . . . . . . . . .388
▫ Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . .373
▫ Tire Terminology And Definitions . . . . . . . . . .389
▫ Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . .375
▫ Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . .391
▫ Brake Assist System (BAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376 䡵 TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . .396
▫ Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . .377
▫ Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .396
STARTING AND OPERATING 343
▫ Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398 䡵 TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS) . .412
▫ Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation . . . .399
▫ Base System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414
▫ Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
▫ Premium System — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .417
▫ Tire Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .422
▫ Run Flat Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .402 䡵 FUEL REQUIREMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
▫ Spare Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
▫ 3.6L Engine — If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
▫ Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
▫ 5.7L Engine — If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
▫ Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
▫ Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
▫ Life Of Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
▫ Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
▫ Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .407
▫ E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles . . . . . . .425
䡵 TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES) . . . . . . .409
▫ MMT In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
䡵 TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS . . . . .411
▫ Materials Added To Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
▫ Fuel System Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
5
344 STARTING AND OPERATING
▫ Carbon Monoxide Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . .427 䡵 VEHICLE LOADING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
䡵 FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
▫ E-85 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
▫ Ethanol Fuel (E-85) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
▫ Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
▫ Vehicle Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
▫ Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) . . . . . . .435
▫ Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) . . . . . . . . .435
▫ Overloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .436
▫ Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel
䡵 TRAILER TOWING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicles (E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles . . . . . . .430
▫ Common Towing Definitions . . . . . . . . .
▫ Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .430
▫ Trailer Hitch Classification . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Cruising Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .430
▫ Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer
▫ Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
Weight Ratings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
▫ Trailer And Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 ADDING FUEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
▫ Emergency Fuel Filler Door Release. . . . . . . . .434
. . . .436
. . . .437
. . . .437
. . . .440
. . . .441
. . . .442
STARTING AND OPERATING 345
▫ Towing Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .443 䡵 RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
MOTORHOME, ETC.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
▫ Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .448
▫ Two-Wheel Drive And All-Wheel Drive . . . . . .450
5
346 STARTING AND OPERATING
STARTING PROCEDURES
WARNING! (Continued)
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust the
inside and outside mirrors, fasten your seat belt, and if
present, instruct all other occupants to buckle their seat
belts.
WARNING!
• When leaving the vehicle, always make sure the
ignition is in the OFF position, remove the Key Fob
from the vehicle, and lock the vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Leaving children in
a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a number of
reasons. A child or others could be seriously or
fatally injured. Children should be warned not to
touch the parking brake, brake pedal or the transmission gear selector.
(Continued)
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle (or
in a location accessible to children), and do not
leave the ignition (of a vehicle equipped with
Keyless Enter-N-Go™) in the ACC or ON/RUN
mode. A child could operate power windows, other
controls, or move the vehicle.
Automatic Transmission
The shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL or PARK
position before you can start the engine. Apply the brakes
before shifting into any driving gear.
STARTING AND OPERATING 347
CAUTION!
Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
• Do not shift from REVERSE, PARK, or NEUTRAL
into any forward gear when the engine is above
idle speed.
• Shift into PARK only after the vehicle has come to
a complete stop.
• Shift into or out of REVERSE only after the vehicle
has come to a complete stop and the engine is at
idle speed.
• Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot
is firmly on the brake pedal.
Keyless Enter-N-Go™
This feature allows the driver to operate the ignition switch with the push
of a button, as long as the Remote
Start/Keyless Enter-N-Go™ Key Fob
is in the passenger compartment.
5
Normal Starting
Using The ENGINE START/STOP Button
1. The transmission must be in PARK or NEUTRAL.
2. Press and hold the brake pedal while pushing the
ENGINE START/STOP button once.
3. The system takes over and attempts to start the
vehicle. If the vehicle fails to start, the starter will
disengage automatically after 10 seconds.
348 STARTING AND OPERATING
4. If you wish to stop the cranking of the engine prior to
the engine starting, push the button again.
NOTE: Normal starting of either a cold or a warm engine
is obtained without pumping or pressing the accelerator
pedal.
To Turn Off The Engine Using ENGINE
START/STOP Button
1. Place the shift lever/gear selector in PARK, then press
and release the ENGINE START/STOP button.
vehicle speed above 5 mph (8 km/h) before the engine
will shut off. The ignition switch position will remain
in the ACC position until the shift lever/gear selector
is in PARK and the button is pressed twice to the OFF
position. If the shift lever/gear selector is not in PARK
and the ENGINE START/STOP button is pressed
once, the DID will display a “Vehicle Not In Park”
message and the engine will remain running. Never
leave a vehicle out of the PARK position, or it could
roll.
NOTE: If the ignition switch is left in the ACC or RUN
(engine not running) position and the transmission is in
3. If the shift lever/gear selector is not in PARK, the PARK, the system will automatically time out after 30
ENGINE START/STOP button must be held for two minutes of inactivity and the ignition will switch to the
seconds or three short presses in a row with the OFF position.
2. The ignition switch will return to the OFF position.
STARTING AND OPERATING 349
ENGINE START/STOP Button Functions — With
Driver’s Foot OFF The Brake Pedal (In PARK Or
NEUTRAL Position)
Extreme Cold Weather (Below –20°F Or −29°C)
To ensure reliable starting at these temperatures, use of
an externally powered electric engine block heater (availThe ENGINE START/STOP button operates similar to an able from your authorized dealer) is recommended.
ignition switch. It has three positions, OFF, ACC, RUN.
If Engine Fails To Start
To change the ignition switch positions without starting
the vehicle and use the accessories follow these steps:
WARNING!
1. Starting with the ignition in the OFF position:
2. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button once to
change the ignition to the ACC position.
3. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button a second time
to change the ignition to the RUN position.
4. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button a third time
to return the ignition to the OFF position.
5
• Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into the
throttle body air inlet opening in an attempt to start
the vehicle. This could result in flash fire causing
serious personal injury.
(Continued)
350 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it
started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel
could enter the catalytic converter and once the
engine has started, ignite and damage the converter
and vehicle.
• If the vehicle has a discharged battery, booster
cables may be used to obtain a start from a booster
battery or the battery in another vehicle. This type
of start can be dangerous if done improperly. Refer
to “Jump Starting” in “What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
Clearing A Flooded Engine (Using ENGINE
START/STOP Button)
If the engine fails to start after you have followed the
“Normal Starting” or “Extreme Cold Weather⬙ procedures, it may be flooded. To clear any excess fuel:
1. Press and hold the brake pedal.
2. Press the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and
hold it.
3. Push and release the ENGINE START/STOP button
once.
The starter motor will engage automatically, run for 10
seconds, and then disengage. Once this occurs, release
the accelerator pedal and the brake pedal, wait 10 to 15
seconds, then repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
STARTING AND OPERATING 351
After Starting
The idle speed is controlled automatically and it will
decrease as the engine warms up.
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED
WARNING!
Remember to disconnect the engine block heater
cord before driving. Damage to the 110-115 Volt
electrical cord could cause electrocution.
The engine block heater warms the engine, and permits
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
quicker starts in cold weather. Connect the cord to a
standard 110-115 Volt AC electrical outlet with a
WARNING!
grounded, three-wire extension cord.
The engine block heater must be plugged in at least one • It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
hour to have an adequate warming effect on the engine.
your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the
The engine block heater cord is routed under the hood on
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in rethe driver side of the vehicle. It has a removable cap that
verse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit
is located near the air box.
someone or something. Only shift into gear when
the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing the brake pedal.
(Continued)
5
352 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the Key Fob.
When the ignition is in the OFF position, the
transmission is locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always make sure the
ignition is in the OFF position, remove the key fob
from the vehicle, and lock the vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle (or
in a location accessible to children), and do not
leave the ignition in the ACC or ON/RUN position.
A child could operate power windows, other controls, or move the vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 353
CAUTION!
Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
• Shift into or out of PARK or REVERSE only after
the vehicle has come to a complete stop.
• Do not shift between PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, or
DRIVE when the engine is above idle speed.
• Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot
is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
Key Ignition Park Interlock
This vehicle is equipped with a Key Ignition Park Interlock which requires the transmission to be in PARK
before the engine can be turned off. This helps the driver
avoid inadvertently leaving the vehicle without placing
the transmission in PARK.
This system also locks the transmission in PARK whenever the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System
NOTE: You must press and hold the brake pedal while This vehicle is equipped with a Brake Transmission Shift
Interlock System (BTSI) that holds the transmission gear
shifting out of PARK.
selector in PARK unless the brakes are applied. To shift
the transmission out of PARK, the engine must be
running and the brake pedal must be pressed.
The brake pedal must also be pressed to shift from
NEUTRAL into DRIVE or REVERSE when the vehicle is
stopped or moving at low speeds.
5
354 STARTING AND OPERATING
Eight-Speed Automatic Transmission
The transmission is controlled using a rotary electronic
gear selector located on the center console. The transmission gear range (PRNDL/S) is displayed both above the
gear selector and in the Driver Information Display
(DID). To select a gear range, simply rotate the gear
selector. To access the L or S position, push down on the
gear selector and then rotate it. You must also press the
brake pedal to shift the transmission out of PARK, or to
shift from NEUTRAL into DRIVE or REVERSE when the
vehicle is stopped or moving at low speeds (refer to
“Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System” in this section). To shift past multiple gear ranges at once (such as
PARK to DRIVE), simply rotate the gear selector to the
appropriate detent. Select the DRIVE range for normal
driving.
The electronically-controlled transmission provides a
precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are
self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new
vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal
condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few
hundred miles (kilometers).
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the
accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped.
Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when
shifting between these gears.
STARTING AND OPERATING 355
Standard Shifter
Premium Shifter with AutoStick
The standard transmission gear selector has PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, DRIVE, and LOW shift positions.
Using the LOW position manually downshifts the transmission to a lower gear based on vehicle speed.
The premium transmission gear selector provides PARK,
REVERSE, NEUTRAL, DRIVE, and SPORT shift positions.
Manual shifts can be made using the AutoStick shift control
(shift paddles mounted on the steering wheel). Pressing the
shift paddles (-/+) while in the DRIVE or SPORT position
will manually select the transmission gear, and will display
the current gear in the instrument cluster as 1, 2, 3, etc.
Refer to “AutoStick” in this section for further information.
Gear Ranges
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or
NEUTRAL into another gear range.
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to
allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating.
This is especially important when the engine is cold.
Gear Selector
5
356 STARTING AND OPERATING
PARK (P)
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the
transmission. The engine can be started in this range.
Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in
motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the
vehicle in this range.
When parking on a level surface, you may shift the
transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking
brake.
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before
shifting the transmission to PARK. As an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill
grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
WARNING!
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• Your vehicle could move and injure you and others
if it is not in PARK. Make sure the transmission is
in PARK before leaving the vehicle.
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear when
the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing the brake pedal.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 357
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the key fob. When
the ignition is in the OFF position, the transmission is locked in PARK, securing the vehicle
against unwanted movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always make sure the
ignition is in the OFF position, remove the key fob
from the vehicle, and lock the vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle (or
in a location accessible to children), and do not
leave the ignition in the ACC or ON/RUN position.
A child could operate power windows, other controls, or move the vehicle.
(Continued)
5
358 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE:
REVERSE (R)
• Before moving the transmission gear selector out of This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into
PARK, you must start the engine and also press the REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete
brake pedal. Otherwise, damage to the gear selector stop.
could result.
NEUTRAL (N)
• DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged
NEUTRAL into another gear range, as this can damage
periods with the engine running. Apply the parking
the drivetrain.
brake and shift the transmission into PARK if you must
The following indicator should be used to ensure that leave the vehicle.
you have engaged the transmission into the PARK position:
WARNING!
• With brake pedal released, look at the transmission
gear position display and verify that it indicates the
PARK position (P).
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
STARTING AND OPERATING 359
CAUTION!
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any other
reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL can cause
severe transmission damage. Refer to “Recreational
Towing” in “Starting And Operating” and “Towing A
Disabled Vehicle” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
DRIVE (D)
This range should be used for most city and highway
driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission
automatically upshifts through all forward gears. The
DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteristics under all normal operating conditions.
When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as
when operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or
while towing heavy trailers), use the AutoStick® shift
control (if equipped; refer to AutoStick in this section for
further information) or the LOW range (if equipped) to
select a lower gear. Under these conditions, using a lower
gear will improve performance and extend transmission
life by reducing excessive shifting and heat buildup.
During extremely cold temperatures (-22°F [-30°C] or
below), transmission operation may be modified depending on engine and transmission temperature as well as
vehicle speed. Normal operation will resume once the
transmission temperature has risen to a suitable level.
5
360 STARTING AND OPERATING
SPORT (S) — If Equipped
are all set to their SPORT settings. Sport Mode will
provide improved throttle response and modified shifting for an enhanced driving experience, as well the
greatest amount of steering feel. This mode may be
activated and deactivated by pushing the Sport button on
the instrument panel switch bank.
This mode alters the transmission’s automatic shift
schedule for sportier driving. Upshift speeds are increased to make full use of available engine power. To
access SPORT mode, push down on the gear selector and
rotate it fully clockwise, or press the SPORT button in the
Transmission Limp Home Mode
center stack.
LOW (L) — If Equipped
Use this range for engine braking when descending very
steep grades. In this range, the transmission will downshift for increased engine braking. To access the LOW
position, push down on the gear selector and rotate it
fully clockwise.
Sport Mode — If Equipped
Your vehicle is equipped with a Sport Mode feature. This
mode is a configuration set up for typical enthusiast
driving. The engine, transmission and steering systems
Transmission function is monitored electronically for abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could
result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home
Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission may
operate only in certain gears, or may not shift at all. Vehicle
performance may be severely degraded and the engine
may stall. In some situations, the transmission may not
re-engage if the engine is turned off and restarted. The
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. A
message in the instrument cluster will inform the driver of
the more serious conditions, and indicate what actions may
be necessary.
STARTING AND OPERATING 361
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recomcan be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the mend that you visit your authorized dealer at your
following steps:
earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has
NOTE: In cases where the instrument cluster message diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could
indicates the transmission may not re-engage after en- recur.
gine shutdown, perform this procedure only in a desired If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer
location (preferably, at your authorized dealer).
service is required.
1. Stop the vehicle.
AUTOSTICK — IF EQUIPPED
2. Shift the transmission into PARK, if possible. If not,
AutoStick is a driver-interactive transmission feature
shift the transmission to NEUTRAL.
providing manual shift control, giving you more control
3. Press and hold the ignition switch until the engine of the vehicle. AutoStick allows you to maximize engine
turns OFF.
braking, eliminate undesirable upshifts and downshifts,
and improve overall vehicle performance. This system
4. Wait approximately 30 seconds.
can also provide you with more control during passing,
5. Restart the engine.
city driving, cold slippery conditions, mountain driving,
6. Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no trailer towing, and many other situations.
longer detected, the transmission will return to normal
operation.
5
362 STARTING AND OPERATING
In AutoStick mode, the transmission will shift up or down
when (+/-) is manually selected by the driver, unless an
When the transmission is in DRIVE or SPORT mode, it
engine lugging or overspeed condition would result. It will
will operate automatically, shifting between the eight
remain in the selected gear until another upshift or downavailable gears. To engage AutoStick, simply tap one of
shift is chosen, except as described below.
the steering wheel-mounted shift paddles (+/-) while in
DRIVE or SPORT mode. In DRIVE mode, this will • If AutoStick is engaged while in DRIVE mode, the
transmission will automatically shift up when maxiactivate a temporary AutoStick mode. The transmission
mum engine speed is reached. If the accelerator is fully
will revert back to normal operation after a period of
depressed, the transmission will downshift when postime, depending on accelerator pedal activity. When the
sible (based on current vehicle speed and gear). Lack
transmission gear selector is in the SPORT position,
of accelerator pedal activity will cause the transmistapping either shift paddle will activate ⬙permanent⬙
sion to revert to automatic operation.
AutoStick mode. The transmission will remain in
AutoStick mode until the driver deliberately disables • If AutoStick is engaged while the transmission gear
AutoStick (as described below). Tapping (-) to enter
selector is in the SPORT position, manual gear selecAutoStick will downshift the transmission to the next
tion will be maintained until the gear selector is
lower gear, while using (+) to enter AutoStick will retain
returned to DRIVE, or as described below. The transthe current gear. When AutoStick is active, the current
mission will not upshift automatically at redline in this
transmission gear is displayed in the instrument cluster.
mode, nor will downshifts be obtained if the accelerator pedal is pressed to the floor.
Operation
STARTING AND OPERATING 363
• In either DRIVE or SPORT mode, the transmission will • Transmission shifting will be more noticeable when
automatically downshift as the vehicle slows (to preAutoStick is engaged.
vent engine lugging) and will display the current gear.
• The system may revert to automatic shift mode if a
• The transmission will automatically downshift to first
fault or overheat condition is detected.
gear when coming to a stop. After a stop, the driver
should manually upshift (+) the transmission as the To disengage AutoStick mode, press and hold the (+)
shift paddle until ⬙D⬙ or ⬙S⬙ is once again indicated in the
vehicle is accelerated.
instrument cluster. Shifting out of SPORT mode will also
• You can start out, from a stop, in first or second gear. disable AutoStick. You can shift in or out of AutoStick
Tapping (+) at a stop will allow starting in second gear. mode at any time without taking your foot off the
Starting out in second gear can be helpful in snowy or accelerator pedal.
icy conditions.
• If a requested downshift would cause the engine to
over-speed, that shift will not occur.
• The system will ignore attempts to upshift at too low
of a vehicle speed.
• Holding the (-) paddle depressed will downshift the
transmission to the lowest gear possible at the current
speed.
WARNING!
Do not downshift for additional engine braking on a
slippery surface. The drive wheels could lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid, causing a collision or
personal injury.
5
364 STARTING AND OPERATING
Sport Mode or activating the windshield wipers for an
extended period of time. Drive mode, RWD or AWD, can
This vehicle is equipped with an active on-demand
be found in the Driver Information Display (DID). Refer
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) system which makes available
to “Driver Information Display (DID)” in “Understandoptimum traction for a wide variety of road surface and
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
driving conditions. The system minimizes wheel slip by
automatically redirecting torque to the front and rear NOTE: If the “SERVICE AWD SYSTEM” warning meswheels as necessary.
sage appears after engine start up, or during driving, it
means that the AWD system is not functioning properly
To maximize fuel economy, your AWD vehicle automatiand that service is required. Refer to “Driver Information
cally defaults to rear-wheel drive (RWD) when road and
Display (DID)” in “Understanding Your Instrument
environmental conditions are such that wheel slip is
Panel” for further information.
unlikely to occur. When specific road and environmental
conditions require increased levels of road traction, the
CAUTION!
vehicle automatically shifts into AWD mode. Automatic
AWD operation could be activated by outside tempera- All wheels must have the same size and type tires.
ture, wheel slip, or other predetermined conditions (there Unequal tire sizes must not be used. Unequal tire
may be a slight delay for AWD engagement after a wheel size may cause failure of the front differential and/or
slip condition occurs). AWD can also be manually se- the transfer case.
lected by activating AutoStick mode (+/-), engaging
ALL-WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) — IF EQUIPPED
STARTING AND OPERATING 365
DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES
Traction
Acceleration
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a
wedge of water to build up between the tire and road
surface. This is known as hydroplaning and may cause
partial or complete loss of vehicle control and stopping
ability. To reduce this possibility, the following precautions should be observed:
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slippery surfaces may cause the driving wheels to pull
erratically to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs
when there is a difference in the surface traction under
the rear (driving) wheels.
WARNING!
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is dangerous.
Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of the rear
wheels. You could lose control of the vehicle and
possibly have a collision. Accelerate slowly and
carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction
(ice, snow, wet mud, loose sand, etc.).
• Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are
slushy.
• Slow down if the road has standing water or puddles.
• Replace tires when tread wear indicators first become
visible.
• Keep tires properly inflated.
• Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a
sudden stop.
5
366 STARTING AND OPERATING
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Limited Slip
Differential (LSD) that reduces, but does not eliminate,
the amount of wheel slip across a given axle for improved handling.
WARNING! (Continued)
your vehicle away swiftly. Failure to follow this
warning may result in injuries that are serious or
fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
DRIVING THROUGH WATER
Shallow Standing Water
Driving through water more than a few inches/
centimeters deep will require extra caution to ensure Although your vehicle is capable of driving through
shallow standing water, consider the following Cautions
safety and prevent damage to your vehicle.
and Warnings before doing so.
Flowing/Rising Water
WARNING!
WARNING!
Do not drive on or across a road or path where water
is flowing and/or rising (as in storm run-off). Flowing water can wear away the road or path’s surface
and cause your vehicle to sink into deeper water.
Furthermore, flowing and/or rising water can carry
(Continued)
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s traction capabilities. Do not exceed 5 mph
(8 km/h) when driving through standing water.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 367
WARNING! (Continued)
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s braking capabilities, which increases stopping
distances. Therefore, after driving through standing water, drive slowly and lightly press on the
brake pedal several times to dry the brakes.
• Failure to follow these warnings may result in
injuries that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
• Determine the condition of the road or the path
that is under water and if there are any obstacles in
the way before driving through the standing water.
• Do not exceed 5 mph (8 km/h) when driving
through standing water. This will minimize wave
effects.
• Driving through standing water may cause damage
to your vehicle’s drivetrain components. Always
inspect your vehicle’s fluids (i.e., engine oil, transmission, axle, etc.) for signs of contamination (i.e.,
fluid that is milky or foamy in appearance) after
driving through standing water. Do not continue to
operate the vehicle if any fluid appears contaminated, as this may result in further damage. Such
damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
CAUTION!
• Always check the depth of the standing water
before driving through it. Never drive through
standing water that is deeper than the bottom of
the tire rims mounted on the vehicle.
(Continued)
(Continued)
5
368 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Getting water inside your vehicle’s engine can
cause it to lock up and stall out, and cause serious
internal damage to the engine. Such damage is not
covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
ELECTRIC POWER STEERING
Equipped” within “Uconnect Settings” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” chapter for further information.
WARNING!
Continued operation with reduced assist could pose
a safety risk to yourself and others. Service should be
obtained as soon as possible.
The electric power steering system will give you good
vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability
in tight spaces. The system will vary its assist to provide
If the Steering icon is displayed and the “SERlight efforts while parking and good feel while driving. If
VICE POWER STEERING” or the “POWER
the electric steering system experiences a fault that
STEERING ASSIST OFF – SERVICE SYSTEM”
prevents it from providing assist, you will still have the
message is displayed within the Driver Inforability to steer the vehicle manually.
mation Display (DID), this indicates the vehicle needs to
Alternate electric power steering efforts can be selected be taken to the dealer for service. Refer to “Driver
through the Uconnect® System. Refer to ”Customer Information Display (DID)” in “Understanding Your
Programmable Features” or “Performance Control — If Instrument Panel” for further information.
STARTING AND OPERATING 369
NOTE:
PARKING BRAKE
• Even if the power steering assistance is no longer
operational, it is still possible to steer the vehicle.
Under these conditions there will be a substantial
increase in steering effort, especially at low speeds and
during parking maneuvers.
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking
brake is fully applied and place the shift lever/gear
selector in the PARK position.
The foot operated parking brake is located below the
lower left corner of the instrument panel. To apply the
• If the condition persists, see your authorized dealer for park brake, firmly push the park brake pedal fully. To
release the parking brake, press the park brake pedal a
service.
second time and let your foot up as you feel the brake
FUEL SAVER TECHNOLOGY 5.7L ENGINE
disengage.
ONLY — IF EQUIPPED
This feature offers improved fuel economy by shutting
off four of the engine’s eight cylinders during light load
and cruise conditions. The system is automatic with no
driver inputs or additional driving skills required.
NOTE: This system may take some time to return to full
functionality after a battery disconnect.
5
370 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE:
• When the parking brake is applied and the transmission is placed in gear, the “Brake Warning Light” will
flash. If vehicle speed is detected, a chime will sound
to alert the driver. Fully release the parking brake
before attempting to move the vehicle.
• This light only shows that the parking brake is applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
When parking on a hill, it is important to turn the front
wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away
from the curb on an uphill grade. Apply the parking
Parking Brake
brake before placing the shift lever/gear selector in
When the parking brake is applied with the ignition
PARK, otherwise the load on the transmission locking
switch in the ON position, the “Brake Warning Light” in
mechanism may make it difficult to move the shift
the instrument cluster will illuminate.
lever/gear selector out of PARK. The parking brake
should always be applied whenever the driver is not in
the vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 371
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the Key
Fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the shift lever/gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle (or
in a location accessible to children), and do not
leave the ignition of a vehicle equipped with
Keyless Enter-N-Go™ in the ACC or ON/RUN
mode. A child could operate power windows, other
controls, or move the vehicle.
• Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged
before driving; failure to do so can lead to brake
failure and a collision.
• Always fully apply the parking brake when leaving your vehicle, or it may roll and cause damage or
injury. Also be certain to leave the transmission in
PARK. Failure to do so may allow the vehicle to roll
and cause damage or injury.
(Continued)
5
372 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
If the “Brake Warning Light” remains on with the
parking brake released, a brake system malfunction
is indicated. Have the brake system serviced by an
authorized dealer immediately.
BRAKE SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with dual hydraulic
brake systems. If either of the two hydraulic
systems loses normal capability, the remaining
system will still function. There will be some
loss of overall braking effectiveness. This may be evident
by increased pedal travel during application, greater
pedal force required to slow or stop, and potential
activation of the “Brake Warning Light.”
In the event power assist is lost for any reason (for
example, repeated brake applications with the engine
OFF) the brakes will still function. The effort required to
brake the vehicle will be much greater than that required
with the power system operating.
NOTE: Your vehicle is equipped with a high performance braking system. The brake pads are a semimetallic compound, which offer superior fade resistance
for consistent operation. A compromise to using this type
of brake pad is that the brakes may produce more brake
dust and may squeal slightly under certain weather and
operating conditions (.i.e., during light brake applications) this is considered normal conditions.
STARTING AND OPERATING 373
The Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) prevents
the rear wheels from over-braking and provides greater
Your vehicle is equipped with an advanced electronic
control of available braking forces applied to the rear
brake control system that include Anti-Lock Brake Sysaxle.
tem (ABS), Traction Control System (TCS), Brake Assist
System (BAS), and the Electronic Stability Control (ESC). When the vehicle is driven over 7 mph (11 km/h), you
All four of these systems work together to enhance may also hear a slight clicking sound as well as some
vehicle stability and control in various driving condi- related motor noises. These noises are the system performing its self check cycle to ensure that the ABS is
tions.
working properly. This self check occurs each time the
Also, your vehicle may be equipped with Hill Start Assist
vehicle is started and accelerated past 7 mph (11 km/h).
(HSA), Ready Alert Braking, and Rain Brake Support.
ABS is activated during braking under certain road or
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
stopping conditions. ABS-inducing conditions can inThe Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) provides increased clude ice, snow, gravel, bumps, railroad tracks, loose
vehicle stability and brake performance under most debris, or panic stops.
braking conditions. The system automatically “pumps”
the brakes during severe braking conditions to prevent
wheel lock-up.
ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
5
374 STARTING AND OPERATING
You also may experience the following when the brake
system goes into Anti-Lock:
• The ABS motor running (it may continue to run for a
short time after the stop).
• The clicking sound of solenoid valves.
• Brake pedal pulsations.
• A slight drop or fall away of the brake pedal at the end
of the stop.
These are all normal characteristics of ABS.
WARNING!
• The ABS contains sophisticated electronic equipment that may be susceptible to interference
caused by improperly installed or high output
radio transmitting equipment. This interference
can cause possible loss of anti-lock braking capability. Installation of such equipment should be
performed by qualified professionals.
• Pumping of the Anti-Lock Brakes will diminish
their effectiveness and may lead to a collision.
Pumping makes the stopping distance longer. Just
press firmly on your brake pedal when you need to
slow down or stop.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 375
WARNING! (Continued)
• The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase
braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded
by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or
the traction afforded.
• The ABS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, following
another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning.
• The capabilities of an ABS equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner that could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
Traction Control System (TCS)
This system monitors the amount of wheel spin of each
driven wheel. If wheel spin is detected, brake pressure is
applied to the slipping wheel(s) and engine power is
reduced to provide enhanced acceleration and stability.
A feature of the TCS system, Brake Limited Differential
(BLD), controls the wheel spin across a driven axle. If one
wheel on a driven axle is spinning faster than the other,
the system will apply the brake of the spinning wheel.
This will allow more engine torque to be applied to the
wheel that is not spinning. This feature remains active
even if TCS and ESC are in the “Sport Mode (Partial Off)”
or ⬙Track Mode (Full Off)⬙ mode. Refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” in this section for more informaAll vehicle wheels and tires must be the same size and tion.
type and tires must be properly inflated to produce
accurate signals for the computer.
5
376 STARTING AND OPERATING
Brake Assist System (BAS)
This system complements the ABS by optimizing the
vehicle braking capability during emergency brake maneuvers. This system detects an emergency braking situation by sensing the rate and amount of brake application
and then applies optimum pressure to the brakes. This
can help reduce braking distances.
Applying the brakes very quickly results in the best BAS
assistance. To receive the benefits of this system, you
must apply continuous brake pedal pressure during the
stopping sequence. Do not reduce brake pedal pressure
unless braking is no longer desired. Once the brake pedal
is released, the BAS is deactivated.
WARNING!
The BAS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase the
traction afforded by prevailing road conditions. The
BAS cannot prevent collisions, including those resulting from excessive speed in turns, driving on
very slippery surfaces, or hydroplaning. The capabilities of a BAS-equipped vehicle must never be
exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner that
could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of
others.
STARTING AND OPERATING 377
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
This system enhances directional control and stability of
the vehicle under various driving conditions. The ESC
corrects for oversteering and understeering the vehicle
by applying the brake of the appropriate wheel. Engine
power may also be reduced to assist in counteracting the
condition of oversteer or understeer and help the vehicle
maintain the desired path.
The ESC uses sensors in the vehicle to determine the path
that the driver intends to steer the vehicle and compares
it to the actual path of the vehicle. When the actual path
does not match the intended path, the ESC applies the
brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting
the condition of oversteer or understeer.
• Oversteer - when the vehicle is turning more than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
• Understeer - when the vehicle is turning less than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
WARNING!
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle, nor can it increase the traction afforded by
prevailing road conditions. ESC cannot prevent all
accidents, including those resulting from excessive
speed in turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or
hydroplaning. ESC also cannot prevent collisions
resulting from loss of vehicle control due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Only a safe,
attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents.
The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner
which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety
of others.
5
378 STARTING AND OPERATING
The “ESC Off” switch is located on the switch bank in the
The ESC system has two or three available operating center of the instrument panel. To enter the “Partial Off”
mode, momentarily press the “ESC Off” switch and the
modes:
⬙ESC off indicator light⬙ will illuminate. To turn the ESC
ESC On
on again, momentarily press the “ESC Off” switch and
the ⬙ESC off indicator light⬙ will turn off.
This is the normal operating mode for the ESC. Whenever the vehicle is started, the ESC system will be in this
WARNING!
mode. This mode should be used for most driving
conditions. The ESC should only be turned OFF for • When in “Partial Off” mode, the TCS functionality
specific reasons as noted in the following paragraphs.
of ESC, (except for the limited slip feature deESC Operating Modes
Partial Off
The “Partial Off” mode is intended for times when a
more spirited driving experience is desired. It is also
intended for driving in deep snow, sand, or gravel. This
mode disables the TCS portion of the ESC and raises the
threshold for ESC activation, which allows for more
wheel spin than what ESC normally allows.
scribed in the TCS section), has been disabled and
the “ESC Off Indicator Light” will be illuminated.
When in “Partial Off” mode, the engine power
reduction feature of TCS is disabled, and the
enhanced vehicle stability offered by the ESC system is reduced.
• Trailer Sway control (TSC) is disabled when the
ESC system is in the “Partial Off” mode.
STARTING AND OPERATING 379
NOTE:
• To improve the vehicle’s traction when driving with
snow chains, or when starting off in deep snow, sand,
or gravel, it may be desirable to switch to the “Partial
Off” mode by momentarily pressing the “ESC Off”
switch. Once the situation requiring “Partial Off”
mode is overcome, turn the ESC on again by momentarily pressing the “ESC Off” switch. This may be done
while the vehicle is in motion.
Full Off — If Equipped
This mode is intended for off-highway or off-road use
only and should not be used on any public roadways. In
this mode, all TCS and ESC stability features are turned
OFF. To enter the “Full Off” mode, press and hold the
“ESC Off” switch for five seconds while the vehicle is
stopped with the engine running. After five seconds, a
chime will sound, the ⬙ESC Off Indicator Lamp⬙ will
illuminate, and the “ESC off” message may appear in the
Driver Information Display (DID). Refer to “Driver In• When in “Partial Off” mode, the TCS functionality of
formation Display (DID)” in “Understanding Your InESC, (except for the limited slip feature described in
strument Panel” for further information. To turn ESC ON
the TCS section), has been disabled and the “ESC Off
again, momentarily press the “ESC Off” switch.
Indicator Light” will be illuminated. All other stability
features of ESC function normally. When in “Partial
Off” mode, the engine power reduction feature of TCS
is disabled, and the enhanced vehicle stability offered
by the ESC system is reduced.
5
380 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
In the ESC “Full Off” mode, the engine torque
reduction and stability features are disabled. Therefore, the enhanced vehicle stability offered by ESC is
unavailable. In an emergency evasive maneuver, the
ESC system will not engage to assist in maintaining
stability. ⴖESC Offⴖ mode is intended for off-highway
or off-road use only.
Hill Start Assist (HSA)
The HSA system is designed to assist the driver when
starting a vehicle from a stop on a hill. HSA will maintain
the level of brake pressure the driver applied for a short
period of time after the driver takes their foot off of the
brake pedal. If the driver does not apply the throttle
during this short period of time, the system will release
brake pressure and the vehicle will roll down the hill.
The system will release brake pressure in proportion to
the amount of throttle applied as the vehicle starts to
move in the intended direction of travel.
HSA Activation Criteria
The following criteria must be met in order for HSA to
activate:
• Vehicle must be stopped.
• Vehicle must be on a 6% (approximate) grade or
greater hill.
• Gear selection matches vehicle uphill direction (i.e.,
vehicle facing uphill is in forward gear; vehicle backing uphill is in REVERSE gear).
HSA will work in REVERSE and all forward gears when
the activation criteria have been met. The system will not
activate if the vehicle is placed in NEUTRAL or PARK.
STARTING AND OPERATING 381
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
There may be situations on minor hills with a loaded
vehicle, or while pulling a trailer, when the system
will not activate and slight rolling may occur. This
could cause a collision with another vehicle or object.
Always remember the driver is responsible for braking the vehicle.
released, there may not be enough brake pressure to
hold the vehicle and trailer on a hill and this could
cause a collision with another vehicle or object
behind you. In order to avoid rolling down the hill
while resuming acceleration, manually activate the
trailer brake prior to releasing the brake pedal.
Always remember the driver is responsible for braking the vehicle.
• HSA is not a parking brake. If you stop the vehicle
on a hill without putting the transmission in PARK
and using the parking brake, it will roll down the
hill and could cause a collision with another vehicle or object. Always remember to use the parking brake while parking on a hill, and that the
driver is responsible for braking the vehicle.
Towing With HSA
HSA will provide assistance when starting on a grade
when pulling a trailer.
WARNING!
• If you use a trailer brake controller with your trailer,
your trailer brakes may be activated and deactivated
with the brake switch. If so, when the brake pedal is
(Continued)
5
382 STARTING AND OPERATING
HSA Off
If you wish to turn off the HSA system, it can be done in
the Uconnect® settings. Refer to ⬙Uconnect® Settings⬙ in
⬙Understanding Your Instrument Panel⬙ for further information.
Rain Brake Support
Rain Brake Support may improve braking performance
in wet conditions. It will periodically apply a small
amount of brake pressure to remove any water buildup
on the front brake rotors. It only functions when the
windshield wipers are in the LO or HI mode, it does not
Ready Alert Braking
function in the intermittent mode. When Rain Brake
Ready Alert Braking may reduce the time required to Support is active, there is no notification to the driver and
reach full braking during emergency braking situations. no driver interaction is required.
It anticipates when an emergency braking situation may
occur by monitoring how fast the throttle is released by
the driver. When the throttle is released very quickly,
Ready Alert Braking applies a small amount of brake
pressure. This brake pressure will not be noticed by the
driver. The brake system uses this brake pressure to allow
a fast brake response if the driver applies the brakes.
STARTING AND OPERATING 383
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” also
flashes when TCS is active. If the “ESC Activation/
Malfunction Indicator Light” begins to flash during acceleration, ease up on the accelerator and apply as little
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light” in the instrument cluster will come on throttle as possible. Be sure to adapt your speed and
driving to the prevailing road conditions.
when the ignition switch is cycled to the ON
position. It should go out with the engine NOTE:
running. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
• Each time the ignition is cycled ON, the ESC system
Light” comes on continuously with the engine running, a
will be ON even if it was cycled off previously.
malfunction has been detected in the ESC system. If this
light remains on after several ignition cycles, and the • The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds
vehicle has been driven several miles (kilometers) at
when it is active. This is normal; the sounds will stop
speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see your authowhen ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver
rized dealer as soon as possible to have the problem
that caused the ESC activation.
diagnosed and corrected.
ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
ESC OFF Indicator Light
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” (located in the instrument cluster) starts to flash as soon as
the tires lose traction and the ESC system becomes active.
The “ESC OFF Indicator Light” indicates the
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is partially
off or full off.
5
384 STARTING AND OPERATING
Synchronizing ESC
TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION
Tire Markings
If the power supply is interrupted (battery
disconnected or discharged), the “ESC
Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” may
illuminate with the engine running. If this
should occur, turn the steering wheel completely to the
left and then to the right. The “ESC Activation/
Malfunction Indicator Light” should go out. However, if
the light remains on, have the ESC and BAS checked at
your authorized dealer as soon as possible.
1 — U.S. DOT Safety Standards
Code (TIN)
2 — Size Designation
3 — Service Description
4 — Maximum Load
5 — Maximum Pressure
6 — Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades
STARTING AND OPERATING 385
• LT (Light Truck) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric
• P (Passenger) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the
design standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P”
letters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall precedmolded into the sidewall preceding the size designaing the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.
tion. Example: P215/65R15 95H.
• Temporary spare tires are designed for temporary
• European — Metric tire sizing is based on European
emergency use only. Temporary high pressure comdesign standards. Tires designed to this standard have
pact spare tires have the letter “T” or “S” molded into
the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with
the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example:
the section width. The letter ⬙P⬙ is absent from this tire
T145/80D18 103M.
size designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H.
• High flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design
standards and it begins with the tire diameter molded
into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.
NOTE:
5
386 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Sizing Chart
EXAMPLE:
Example Size Designation: P215/65R15XL 95H, 215/65R15 96H, LT235/85R16C, T145/80D18 103M, 31x10.5 R15 LT
P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards, or
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Passenger car tire based on European design standards, or
LT = Light truck tire based on U.S. design standards, or
T or S = Temporary spare tire or
31 = Overall diameter in inches (in)
215, 235, 145 = Section width in millimeters (mm)
65, 85, 80 = Aspect ratio in percent (%)
– Ratio of section height to section width of tire, or
10.5 = Section width in inches (in)
R = Construction code
– ⬙R⬙ means radial construction, or
– ⬙D⬙ means diagonal or bias construction
15, 16, 18 = Rim diameter in inches (in)
STARTING AND OPERATING 387
EXAMPLE:
Service Description:
95 = Load Index
– A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry
H = Speed Symbol
– A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to
its load index under certain operating conditions
– The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under
specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions, and
posted speed limits)
Load Identification:
Absence of the following load identification symbols on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL)
tire:
• XL = Extra load (or reinforced) tire, or
• LL = Light load tire or
• C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure
Maximum Load – Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry
Maximum Pressure – Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this tire
5
388 STARTING AND OPERATING
Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire, tires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on
however, the date code may only be on one side. Tires the outboard side, then you will find it on the inboard
side of the tire.
with white sidewalls will have the full TIN, including the
date code, located on the white sidewall side of the tire.
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
DOT = Department of Transportation
– This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire
safety standards and is approved for highway use
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits)
L9 = Code representing the tire size (two digits)
ABCD = Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits)
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 03 means the 3rd week
STARTING AND OPERATING 389
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 01 means the year 2001
– Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the year
in which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991
5
Tire Terminology And Definitions
Term
B-Pillar
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Definition
The vehicle B-Pillar is the structural member of the body located
behind the front door.
Cold tire inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after the
vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours, or driven less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three hours.
Inflation pressure is measured in units of PSI (pounds per square
inch) or kPa (kilopascals).
390 STARTING AND OPERATING
Term
Maximum Inflation Pressure
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation
Pressure
Tire Placard
Definition
The maximum inflation pressure is the maximum permissible
cold tire inflation pressure for this tire. The maximum inflation
pressure is molded into the sidewall.
Vehicle manufacturer’s recommended cold tire inflation pressure
as shown on the tire placard.
A label permanently attached to the vehicle describing the vehicle’s loading capacity, the original equipment tire sizes and the
recommended cold tire inflation pressures.
STARTING AND OPERATING 391
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure
Tire And Loading Information Placard Location
NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on
the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the driver’s
side door.
5
Example Tire Placard Location (B-Pillar)
Example Tire Placard Location (Door)
392 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire And Loading Information Placard
This placard tells you important information about the:
1. Number of people that can be carried in the vehicle.
2. Total weight your vehicle can carry.
3. Tire size designed for your vehicle.
4. Cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear, and
spare tires.
Loading
Tire And Loading Information Placard
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed
the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You
will not exceed the tire’s load carrying capacity if you
adhere to the loading conditions, tire size, and cold tire
inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading
Information placard and in the “Vehicle Loading” section
of this manual.
STARTING AND OPERATING 393
NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition, Steps For Determining Correct Load Limit
gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occuaxles must not be exceeded. For further information on
pants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
GAWRs, vehicle loading, and trailer towing, refer to
XXX kg” on your vehicle’s placard.
“Vehicle Loading” in this section.
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your
passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
vehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight of
occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or 3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.
XXX kg” on the Tire and Loading Information placard.
The combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage and
trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed
the weight referenced here.
5
394 STARTING AND OPERATING
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of NOTE:
cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
• If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your
“XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs (635 kg) and there will
trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. The followbe five 150 lb (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle, the
ing table shows examples on how to calculate total
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity
load, cargo/luggage, and towing capacities of your
is 650 lbs (295 kg) (since 5 x 150 lbs (68 kg) = 750 lbs
vehicle with varying seating configurations and num(340 kg), and 1400 lbs (635 kg) – 750 lbs (340 kg) =
ber and size of occupants. This table is for illustration
650 lbs [295 kg]).
purposes only and may not be accurate for the seating
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo
and load carry capacity of your vehicle.
being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not
• For the following example, the combined weight of
safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load
occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs
capacity calculated in step 4.
(392 kg).
STARTING AND OPERATING 395
5
396 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading can
cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and increase
your stopping distance. Use tires of the recommended
load capacity for your vehicle. Never overload them.
TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and
satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Four primary areas
are affected by improper tire pressure:
• Safety and Vehicle Stability
• Economy
• Tread Wear
• Ride Comfort
Safety
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can
cause collisions.
• Under-inflation increases tire flexing and can result in overheating and tire failure.
• Over-inflation reduces a tire’s ability to cushion
shock. Objects on the road and chuckholes can
cause damage that result in tire failure.
• Overinflated or under-inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in
loss of vehicle control.
• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems. You could lose control of your vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 397
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle
to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the
right or left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure.
Fuel Economy
Underinflated tires will increase tire rolling resistance
resulting in higher fuel consumption.
Tread Wear
Improper cold tire inflation pressures can cause abnormal wear patterns and reduced tread life, resulting in the
Both under-inflation and over-inflation affect the stability need for earlier tire replacement.
of the vehicle and can produce a feeling of sluggish Ride Comfort And Vehicle Stability
response or over responsiveness in the steering.
Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.
NOTE:
Over-inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable
• Unequal tire pressures from side to side may cause ride.
erratic and unpredictable steering response.
• Unequal tire pressure from side to side may cause the
vehicle to drift left or right.
5
398 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Inflation Pressures
The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the
driver’s side B-Pillar or rear edge of the driver’s side
door.
At least once a month:
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always
“cold tire inflation pressure.” Cold tire inflation pressure
is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not
been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than
1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three hours.
The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the
maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidewall.
• Check and adjust tire pressure with a good quality
pocket-type pressure gauge. Do not make a visual judgement when determining proper inflation. Tires may look Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range
properly inflated even when they are under-inflated.
of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with
• Inspect tires for signs of tire wear or visible damage. temperature changes.
CAUTION!
After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will prevent
moisture and dirt from entering the valve stem,
which could damage the valve stem.
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per
12°F (7°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind
when checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially in
the winter.
STARTING AND OPERATING 399
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F (20°C) and the
outside temperature = 32°F (0°C) then the cold tire
inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),
which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (7°C) for this
outside temperature condition.
important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle
loading may be required for high-speed vehicle operation. Refer to your authorized tire dealer or original
equipment vehicle dealer for recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold tire inflation pressures.
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)
during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure
build up or your tire pressure will be too low.
WARNING!
Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds and
within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or conditions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high
speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very
High speed driving with your vehicle under maximum load is dangerous. The added strain on your
tires could cause them to fail. You could have a
serious collision. Do not drive a vehicle loaded to the
maximum capacity at continuous speeds above
75 mph (120 km/h).
5
400 STARTING AND OPERATING
Consult an authorized tire dealer for tire repairs and
additional information.
Radial Ply Tires
WARNING!
Combining radial ply tires with other types of tires
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle
poorly. The instability could cause a collision. Always use radial ply tires in sets of four. Never
combine them with other types of tires.
Tire Repair
Damaged Run Flat tires, or Run Flat tires that have
experienced a loss of pressure should be replaced immediately with another Run Flat tire of identical size and
service description (Load Index and Speed Symbol).
Tire Types
All Season Tires — If Equipped
All Season tires provide traction for all seasons (spring,
If your tire becomes damaged, it may be repaired if it summer, fall and winter). Traction levels may vary bemeets the following criteria:
tween different all season tires. All season tires can be
identified by the M+S, M&S, M/S or MS designation on
• The tire has not been driven on when flat.
the tire sidewall. Use all season tires only in sets of four;
• The damage is only on the tread section of your tire failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and
(sidewall damage is not repairable).
handling of your vehicle.
• The puncture is no greater than a ¼ of an inch (6 mm).
STARTING AND OPERATING 401
Summer Or Three Season Tires — If Equipped
WARNING!
Summer tires provide traction in both wet and dry
conditions, and are not intended to be driven in snow or Do not use summer tires in snow/ice conditions. You
on ice. If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be could lose vehicle control, resulting in severe injury
aware these tires are not designed for winter or cold or death. Driving too fast for conditions also creates
driving conditions. Install winter tires on your vehicle the possibility of loss of vehicle control.
when ambient temperatures are less than 40°F (5°C) or if
Snow Tires
roads are covered with ice or snow. For more informaSome areas of the country require the use of snow tires
tion, contact an authorized dealer.
during the winter. Snow tires can be identified by a
Summer tires do not contain the all season designation or “mountain/snowflake” symbol on the tire sidewall.
mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall. Use
If you need snow tires, select tires
summer tires only in sets of four; failure to do so may
equivalent in size and type to the origiadversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
nal equipment tires. Use snow tires
only in sets of four; failure to do so
may adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
5
402 STARTING AND OPERATING
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what
was originally equipped with your vehicle and should
not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph
(120 km/h). For speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to
original equipment or an authorized tire dealer for
recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold
tire inflation pressures.
Run Flat Tires — If Equipped
Run Flat tires allow you the capability to drive 50 miles
(80 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) after a rapid loss of inflation
pressure. This rapid loss of inflation is referred to as the
Run Flat mode. A Run Flat mode occurs when the tire
inflation pressure is of/or below 14 psi (96 kPa). Once a
Run Flat tire reaches the run flat mode it has limited
While studded tires improve performance on ice, skid driving capabilities and needs to be replaced immediand traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may be ately. A Run Flat tire is not repairable.
poorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states pro- It is not recommended driving a vehicle loaded at full
hibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should be capacity or to tow a trailer while a tire is in the run flat
checked before using these tire types.
mode.
See the tire pressure monitoring section for more information.
STARTING AND OPERATING 403
rotation for your vehicle. If your vehicle has this option,
refer to an authorized tire dealer for the recommended
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Tire Service Kit
tire rotation pattern.
instead of a spare tire, please refer to “Tire Service Kit” in
Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped
“What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
Spare Tires — If Equipped
CAUTION!
Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not take
your vehicle through an automatic car wash with a
compact or limited-use temporary spare installed.
Damage to the vehicle may result.
Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire And
Wheel — If Equipped
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use only.
You can identify if your vehicle is equipped with a
compact spare by looking at the spare tire description on
the Tire and Loading Information Placard located on the
driver’s side door opening or on the sidewall of the tire.
Compact spare tire descriptions begin with the letter “T”
or “S” preceding the size designation. Example: T145/
80D18 103M.
T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and
Since this tire has limited tread life, the original equipwheel equivalent in look and function to the original
ment tire should be repaired (or replaced) and reinstalled
equipment tire and wheel found on the front or rear axle
on your vehicle at the first opportunity.
of your vehicle. This spare tire may be used in the tire
5
404 STARTING AND OPERATING
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a
conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the
wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare tire.
Do not install more than one compact spare tire and
wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
WARNING!
Compact spares are for temporary emergency use
only. With these spares, do not drive more than
50 mph (80 km/h). Temporary use spares have limited
tread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wear
indicators, the temporary use spare tire needs to be
replaced. Be sure to follow the warnings, which
apply to your spare. Failure to do so could result in
spare tire failure and loss of vehicle control.
Full Size Spare — If Equipped
The full size spare is for temporary emergency use only.
This tire may look like the originally equipped tire on the
front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. This spare
tire may have limited tread life. When the tread is worn
to the tread wear indicators, the temporary use full size
spare tire needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the
first opportunity.
Limited-Use Spare — If Equipped
The limited-use spare tire is for temporary emergency
use only. This tire is identified by a label located on the
limited-use spare wheel. This label contains the driving
limitations for this spare. This tire may look like the
original equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your
vehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited-use spare
tire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as
STARTING AND OPERATING 405
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the Tire Spinning
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not
first opportunity.
spin your vehicle’s wheels above 30 mph (48 km/h) or
for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopWARNING!
ping.
Limited-use spares are for emergency use only. Installation of this limited-use spare tire affects vehicle
handling. With this tire, do not drive more than the
speed listed on the limit-use spare wheel. Keep
inflated to the cold tire inflation pressures listed on
your Tire and Loading Information Placard located
on the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the
driver’s side door. Replace (or repair) the original
equipment tire at the first opportunity and reinstall it
on your vehicle. Failure to do so could result in loss
of vehicle control.
Refer to “Freeing A Stuck Vehicle” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire damage or failure. A tire could explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than
30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 30 seconds continuously when you are stuck, and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
5
406 STARTING AND OPERATING
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread
Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires grooves. They will appear as bands when the tread depth
to help you in determining when your tires should be becomes a 1/16 of an inch (2 mm). When the tread is
worn to the tread wear indicators, the tire should be
replaced.
replaced. Refer to “Replacement Tires” in this section for
further information.
Tread Wear Indicators
Life Of Tire
The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying
factors including, but not limited to:
• Driving style.
• Tire pressure - Improper cold tire inflation pressures can
cause uneven wear patterns to develop across the tire
tread. These abnormal wear patterns will reduce tread
life, resulting in the need for earlier tire replacement.
1 — Worn Tire
2 — New Tire
• Distance driven.
STARTING AND OPERATING 407
• Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of V or
higher, and summer tires typically have a reduced
tread life. Rotation of these tires per the vehicle maintenance schedule is highly recommended.
Replacement Tires
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many
characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for
wear and correct cold tire inflation pressures. The manufacturer strongly recommends that you use tires equivaWARNING!
lent to the originals in size, quality and performance
when replacement is needed. Refer to the paragraph on
Tires and the spare tire should be replaced after six
years, regardless of the remaining tread. Failure to “Tread Wear Indicator.” Refer to the Tire and Loading
follow this warning can result in sudden tire failure. Information placard or the Vehicle Certification Label for
You could lose control and have a collision resulting the size designation of your tire. The Load Index and
Speed Symbol for your tire will be found on the original
in serious injury or death.
equipment tire sidewall. See the Tire Sizing Chart exKeep dismounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little ample found in the Tire Safety Information section of this
exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact manual for more information relating to the Load Index
with oil, grease, and gasoline.
and Speed Symbol of a tire.
5
408 STARTING AND OPERATING
It is recommended to replace the two front tires or two
rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously
affect your vehicle’s handling. If you ever replace a
wheel, make sure that the wheel’s specifications match
those of the original wheels.
It is recommended you contact your authorized tire
dealer or original equipment dealer with any questions
you may have on tire specifications or capability. Failure
to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect
the safety, handling, and ride of your vehicle.
WARNING!
• Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than
that specified for your vehicle. Some combinations
of unapproved tires and wheels may change suspension dimensions and performance characteristics, resulting in changes to steering, handling, and
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
braking of your vehicle. This can cause unpredictable handling and stress to steering and suspension components. You could lose control and have
a collision resulting in serious injury or death. Use
only the tire and wheel sizes with load ratings
approved for your vehicle.
• Never use a tire with a smaller load index or
capacity, other than what was originally equipped
on your vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load
index could result in tire overloading and failure.
You could lose control and have a collision.
• Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having
adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire
failure and loss of vehicle control.
STARTING AND OPERATING 409
CAUTION!
Replacing original tires with tires of a different size may
result in false speedometer and odometer readings.
TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES)
Use of traction devices require sufficient tire-to-body
clearance. Follow these recommendations to guard
against damage.
• Traction device must be of proper size for the tire, as
recommended by the traction device manufacturer.
• Install on Rear Tires Only.
• Due to limited clearance for a Rear Wheel Drive
(RWD) vehicle, on P215/65R17, P225/60R18 and
P235/55R18 tires with a Security Chain Company
(SCC) Super Z6 low profile traction device or equivalent is recommended.
• Due to limited clearance for an All Wheel Drive
(AWD) vehicle, P245/45R20 tire with the use of a
traction device that meets the SAE type “Class S”
specification is recommended.
• No other tire sizes are recommended for use with a tire
chain or traction device.
WARNING!
Using tires of different size and type (M+S, Snow)
between front and rear axles can cause unpredictable
handling. You could lose control and have a collision.
5
410 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
To avoid damage to your vehicle or tires, observe the
following precautions:
• Because of restricted traction device clearance between tires and other suspension components, it is
important that only traction devices in good condition are used. Broken devices can cause serious
damage. Stop the vehicle immediately if noise
occurs that could indicate device breakage. Remove
the damaged parts of the device before further use.
• Install device as tightly as possible and then retighten after driving about ½ mile (0.8 km).
• Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h).
• Drive cautiously and avoid severe turns and large
bumps, especially with a loaded vehicle.
• Do not drive for a prolonged period on dry pavement.
• Observe the traction device manufacturer’s instructions on the method of installation, operating speed,
and conditions for use. Always use the suggested
operating speed of the device manufacturer’s if it is
less than 30 mph (48 km/h).
• Do not use traction devices on a compact spare tire.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 411
The suggested rotation method is the “forward cross”
shown in the following diagram. This rotation pattern
Tires on the front and rear axles of vehicles operate at
does not apply to some directional tires that must not be
different loads and perform different steering, driving,
reversed.
and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear at
unequal rates.
TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS
These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of tires.
The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with
aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type
tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to maintain
mud, snow and wet traction levels, and contribute to a
smooth, quiet ride.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals. The reasons for any rapid or
unusual wear should be corrected prior to rotation being
performed.
5
Tire Rotation
412 STARTING AND OPERATING
The TPMS will warn the driver of a low tire pressure if
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) will warn the the tire pressure falls below the low-pressure warning
driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle recom- limit for any reason, including low temperature effects
and natural pressure loss through the tire.
mended cold placard pressure.
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS)
The tire pressure will vary with temperature by about 1 psi
(7 kPa) for every 12°F (6.5°C). This means that when the
outside temperature decreases, the tire pressure will decrease. Tire pressure should always be set based on cold
inflation tire pressure. This is defined as the tire pressure
after the vehicle has not been driven for at least three
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a three hour
period. The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the
maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidewall.
Refer to “Tires – General Information” in “Starting and
Operating” for information on how to properly inflate the
vehicle’s tires. The tire pressure will also increase as the
vehicle is driven - this is normal and there should be no
adjustment for this increased pressure.
The TPMS will continue to warn the driver of low tire
pressure as long as the condition exists, and will not turn
off until the tire pressure is at or above the recommended
cold placard pressure. Once the low tire pressure warning (Tire Pressure Monitoring [TPM] Telltale Light) illuminates, you must increase the tire pressure to the
recommended cold placard pressure in order for the TPM
Telltale Light to turn off. The system will automatically
update and the TPM Telltale Light will turn off once the
system receives the updated tire pressures. The vehicle
may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
STARTING AND OPERATING 413
For example, your vehicle may have a recommended cold
(parked for more than three hours) placard pressure of 30 psi
(207 kPa). If the ambient temperature is 68°F (20°C) and the
measured tire pressure is 27 psi (186 kPa), a temperature
drop to 20°F (-7°C) will decrease the tire pressure to approximately 23 psi (158 kPa). This tire pressure is sufficiently low
enough to turn ON the TPM Telltale Light. Driving the
vehicle may cause the tire pressure to rise to approximately
27 psi (186 kPa), but the TPM Telltale Light will still be ON.
In this situation, the TPM Telltale Light will turn OFF only
after the tires are inflated to the vehicle’s recommended cold
placard pressure value.
CAUTION!
• The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warning have been established for the tire size
(Continued)
CAUTION! (Continued)
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using
replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
sensor damage. Using aftermarket tire sealants may
cause the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
sensor to become inoperable. After using an aftermarket tire sealant it is recommended that you take
your vehicle to your local dealer to have your
sensor function checked.
• After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure,
always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will
prevent moisture and dirt from entering the valve
stem, which could damage the TPM sensor.
5
414 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire pressure,
and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire pressure in the
• The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care
tire.
and maintenance or to provide warning of a tire failure
Base System
or condition.
NOTE:
• The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless
technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to
while adjusting your tire pressure.
monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors mounted to each
• Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the
tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation wheel as part of the valve stem transmit tire pressure
also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may readings to the receiver module.
affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the
• The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire mainte- tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly
nance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain and to maintain the proper pressure.
correct tire pressure using an accurate tire pressure
gauge, even if under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the TPM Telltale Light.
STARTING AND OPERATING 415
The TPMS consists of the following components:
Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
• Receiver module
• Four TPM sensors
• TPM Telltale Light
The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly (if
equipped) has a TPM sensor. The matching full size spare
can be used in place of any of the four road tires. The
TPMS will only monitor the pressure in the full size spare
when it is used in place of a road tire. Otherwise, a spare
with a pressure below the low-pressure limit will not
cause the TPM Telltale Light to illuminate or the chime to
sound.
The TPM Telltale Light will illuminate in the
instrument cluster, a ⬙LOW TIRE⬙ message will be
displayed and a chime will sound when tire pressure is
low in one or more of the four active road tires. An
⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message will also be displayed. Should
this occur, you should stop as soon as possible, check the
inflation pressure of each tire on your vehicle, and inflate
each tire to the vehicle’s recommended cold placard
pressure value as shown in the ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message.
Once the system receives the updated tire pressures, the
system will automatically update and the TPM Telltale
Light and ⬙LOW TIRE⬙ message will turn off. The vehicle
may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this
information.
5
416 STARTING AND OPERATING
Service TPMS Warning
Vehicles With Full Size Spare
If a system fault is detected, the TPM Telltale Light will 1. The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly
flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid.
has a TPM sensor that can be monitored by the TPMS.
The system fault will also sound a chime. If the ignition
switch is cycled, this sequence will repeat, providing the 2. If you install the full size spare in place of a road tire
that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning
system fault still exists. The TPM Telltale Light will turn
limit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, a chime will
off when the fault condition no longer exists. A system
sound and the TPM Telltale Light and ⬙LOW TIRE⬙
fault can occur due to any of the following:
message will turn ON. The ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message
1. Signal interference due to electronic devices or driving
will also be displayed.
next to facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as
3. Driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
the TPM sensors.
(24 km/h) will turn off the TPM Telltale Light and
2. Installing aftermarket window tinting that contains
⬙LOW TIRE⬙ message as long as no tire pressure is
materials that may block radio wave signals.
below the low-pressure warning limit in any of the
four active road tires.
3. Accumulation of snow or ice around the wheels or
wheel housings.
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
STARTING AND OPERATING 417
Vehicles With Compact Spare
1. The compact spare tire does not have a TPM sensor.
Therefore, the TPMS will not monitor the pressure in
the compact spare tire.
5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire, and
reinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare,
the TPMS will update automatically and the TPM
Telltale Light will turn OFF, as long as no tire pressure
is below the low-pressure warning limit in any of the
four active road tires. The vehicle may need to be
driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h)
in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
2. If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road
tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning limit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, a chime
will sound and the TPM Telltale Light and ⬙LOW
Premium System — If Equipped
TIRE⬙ message will turn ON. The ⬙Inflate to XX⬙
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless
message will also be displayed.
technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to
3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors mounted to each
15 mph (24 km/h), the ⬙LOW TIRE⬙ message will turn wheel as part of the valve stem transmit tire pressure
off and the TPM Telltale Light will flash on and off for readings to the receiver module.
75 seconds and then remain on solid.
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the
4. For each subsequent ignition switch cycle, a chime will tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly
sound and the TPM Telltale Light will flash on and off and to maintain the proper pressure.
for 75 seconds and then remain on solid.
5
418 STARTING AND OPERATING
The TPMS consists of the following components:
Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
• Receiver module
The TPM Telltale Light will illuminate in the
instrument cluster and a chime will sound when
• Various TPMS messages, which display in the Driver tire pressure is low in one or more of the four active road
tires. In addition, the DID will display a ⬙LOW TIRE⬙
Information Display (DID)
message and a graphic showing the pressure values of
• TPM Telltale Light
each tire with the low tire pressure values flashing or
The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly (if changing color. An ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message will also be
equipped) has a TPM sensor. The full size spare can be displayed.
used in place of any of the four road tires. The TPMS will
only monitor the pressure in the full size spare tire when
it is used in place of a road tire. Otherwise, a spare with
a pressure below the low-pressure limit will not cause the
TPM Telltale Light to illuminate or the chime to sound.
• Four TPM sensors
STARTING AND OPERATING 419
automatically update, the graphic display in the DID will
stop flashing or change color back to the original color, and
the TPM Telltale Light will turn off. The vehicle may need
to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h)
in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
5
Tire Pressure Monitor Display
Should this occur, you should stop as soon as possible and
inflate the tires with a low pressure condition (those
flashing or in a different color in the DID graphic) to the
vehicle’s recommended cold placard pressure inflation
value as shown in the ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message. Once the
system receives the updated tire pressures, the system will
Low Tire Pressure Monitor Display
420 STARTING AND OPERATING
Service TPMS Warning
2. Installing aftermarket window tinting that contains
materials that may block radio wave signals.
If a system fault is detected, the TPM Telltale Light will
flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid. 3. Accumulation of snow or ice around the wheels or
The system fault will also sound a chime. In addition, the
wheel housings.
DID will display a ⬙SERVICE TPM SYSTEM⬙ message for
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
a minimum of five seconds and then display dashes (- -)
in place of the pressure value to indicate which sensor is 5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
not being received.
The DID will also display a ⬙SERVICE TPM SYSTEM⬙
If the ignition switch is cycled, this sequence will repeat, message for a minimum of five seconds when a system
providing the system fault still exists. If the system fault fault related to an incorrect sensor location fault is
no longer exists, the TPM Telltale Light will no longer detected. In this case, the ⬙SERVICE TPM SYSTEM⬙
flash, and the ⬙SERVICE TPM SYSTEM⬙ message will no message is then followed with a graphic display with
longer display, and a pressure value will display in place pressure values still shown. This indicates that the presof the dashes. A system fault can occur due to any of the sure values are still being received from the TPM sensors
following:
but they may not be located in the correct vehicle
position. The system still needs to be serviced as long as
1. Signal interference due to electronic devices or driving
the ⬙SERVICE TPM SYSTEM⬙ message is displayed.
next to facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as
the TPM sensors.
STARTING AND OPERATING 421
Vehicles With Full Size Spare
Vehicles With Compact Spare
1. The matching full size spare wheel and tire assembly 1. The compact spare tire does not have a TPM sensor.
Therefore, the TPMS will not monitor the pressure in
has a TPM sensor that can be monitored by the TPMS.
the compact spare tire.
2. If you install the full size spare in place of a road tire
that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning 2. If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road
tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warnlimit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, a chime will
ing limit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, the TPM
sound and the TPM Telltale Light will turn ON. In
addition, the DID will display a low pressure message
Telltale Light will remain ON and a chime will sound.
In addition, the graphic in the DID will still display a
and a graphic showing the low tire pressure value
flashing pressure value or a pressure value in a
flashing or in a different color. An ⬙Inflate to XX⬙
message will also be displayed.
different color. An ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message will also be
displayed.
3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above
15 mph (24 km/h) the TPM Telltale Light will turn 3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above
15 mph (24 km/h), the TPM Telltale Light will flash on
OFF, and the pressure value displayed will be updated
and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid. In
and stop flashing or return to its original color as long
addition, the DID will display a ⬙SERVICE TPM
as no tire pressure is below the low-pressure warning
SYSTEM⬙ message for a minimum of five seconds and
limit in any of the four active road tires.
then display dashes (- -) in place of the pressure value.
5
422 STARTING AND OPERATING
4. For each subsequent ignition switch cycle, a chime will
sound, the TPM Telltale Light will flash on and off for
75 seconds and then remain on solid, and the DID will
display a ⬙SERVICE TPM SYSTEM⬙ message for a
minimum of five seconds and then display dashes (- -)
in place of the pressure value.
General Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire and • This device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired opreinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare,
eration.
the TPMS will update automatically. In addition, the
TPM Telltale Light will turn OFF and the graphic in The TPM sensors are regulated under one of the followthe DID will display a new pressure value instead of ing licenses:
dashes (- -), as long as no tire pressure is below the
MRXMERCTX1
low-pressure warning limit in any of the four active United States
road tires. The vehicle may need to be driven for up to Canada
2546A-MERCTX1
20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the
TPMS to receive this information.
STARTING AND OPERATING 423
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
3.6L Engine — If Equipped
This engine is designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide excellent fuel
economy and performance when using
high-quality unleaded “regular” gasoline
having an octane rating of 87. The use of
premium gasoline is not recommended, as it will not
provide any benefit over regular gasoline in these engines.
5.7L Engine — If Equipped
This engine is designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide satisfactory
fuel economy and performance when using
high-quality unleaded gasoline having an
octane range of 87 to 89. The manufacturer
recommends the use of 89 octane for optimum performance. The use of premium gasoline is not recommended,
as it will not provide any benefit over regular gasoline in
these engines.
Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to
your engine. However, continued heavy spark knock at
high speeds can cause damage and immediate service is
required. Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such
as hard starting, stalling, and hesitations. If you experience these symptoms, try another brand of gasoline
before considering service for the vehicle.
Over 40 auto manufacturers worldwide have issued and
endorsed consistent gasoline specifications (the Worldwide Fuel Charter, WWFC) which define fuel properties
necessary to deliver enhanced emissions, performance,
and durability for your vehicle. The manufacturer recommends the use of gasolines that meet the WWFC specifications if they are available.
5
424 STARTING AND OPERATING
Reformulated Gasoline
Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner
burning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline.”
Reformulated gasoline contain oxygenates and are specifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and improve air quality.
The manufacturer supports the use of reformulated gasoline. Properly blended reformulated gasoline will provide excellent performance and durability of engine and
fuel system components.
CAUTION!
DO NOT use gasoline containing Methanol or gasoline containing more than 10% Ethanol. Use of these
blends may result in starting and drivability problems, damage critical fuel system components, cause
emissions to exceed the applicable standard, and/or
cause the “Malfunction Indicator Light” to illuminate. Pump labels should clearly communicate if a
fuel contains greater than 10% Ethanol.
Problems that result from using gasoline containing
Methanol or gasoline containing more than 10% Ethanol
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxy- are not the responsibility of the manufacturer and may
genates such as Ethanol.
not be covered under New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends
STARTING AND OPERATING 425
To fix a Non-FFV vehicle inadvertently fueled once with
Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles (FFV) are compatible with gaso- E-85 perform the following:
line containing 10% ethanol (E10). Gasoline with higher • Drain the fuel tank (see your authorized dealer).
ethanol content may void the New Vehicle Limited
• Change the engine oil and oil filter.
Warranty.
E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles
If a Non-FFV vehicle is inadvertently fueled with E-85 • Disconnect and reconnect the battery to reset the
engine controller memory.
fuel, the engine will have some or all of these symptoms:
More extensive repairs will be required for prolonged
• Operate in a lean mode.
exposure to E-85 fuel.
• OBD II “Malfunction Indicator Light” on.
MMT In Gasoline
• Poor engine performance.
Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl (MMT)
is a manganese-containing metallic additive that is
• Poor cold start and cold drivability.
blended into some gasoline to increase octane. Gasoline
• Increased risk for fuel system component corrosion.
blended with MMT provides no performance advantage
beyond gasoline of the same octane number without
MMT. Gasoline blended with MMT reduces spark plug
5
426 STARTING AND OPERATING
life and reduces emissions system performance in some Fuel System Cautions
vehicles. The manufacturer recommends that gasoline
without MMT be used in your vehicle. The MMT content
CAUTION!
of gasoline may not be indicated on the gasoline pump,
therefore, you should ask your gasoline retailer whether Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle’s
the gasoline contains MMT. MMT is prohibited in Federal performance:
• The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law.
and California reformulated gasoline.
Using leaded gasoline can impair engine perforMaterials Added To Fuel
mance and damage the emissions control system.
•
An out-of-tune engine or certain fuel or ignition
All gasoline sold in the United States is required to
malfunctions can cause the catalytic converter to
contain effective detergent additives. Use of additional
overheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor or
detergents or other additives is not needed under normal
some light smoke, your engine may be out of tune
conditions and they would result in additional cost.
or malfunctioning and may require immediate serTherefore, you should not have to add anything to the
vice. Contact your authorized dealer for service
fuel.
assistance.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 427
CAUTION! (Continued)
• The use of fuel additives, which are now being
sold as octane enhancers, is not recommended.
Most of these products contain high concentrations
of methanol. Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such
fuels or additives is not the responsibility of the
manufacturer.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with the emissions control
system can result in civil penalties being assessed against
you.
Carbon Monoxide Warnings
WARNING!
Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is deadly.
Follow the precautions below to prevent carbon
monoxide poisoning:
• Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain carbon
monoxide, a colorless and odorless gas, which can
kill. Never run the engine in a closed area, such as
a garage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running for an extended period. If the
vehicle is stopped in an open area with the engine
running for more than a short period, adjust the
ventilation system to force fresh, outside air into
the vehicle.
(Continued)
5
428 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Guard against carbon monoxide with proper maintenance. Have the exhaust system inspected every
time the vehicle is raised. Have any abnormal
conditions repaired promptly. Until repaired, drive
with all side windows fully open.
FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) — IF
EQUIPPED
E-85 General Information
The information in this section is for Flexible Fuel vehicles only. These vehicles can be identified by a unique
fuel filler door label that states Ethanol (E-85) or Unleaded Gasoline Only. This section only covers those
subjects that are unique to these vehicles. Please refer to
the other sections of this manual for information on
features that are common between Flexible Fuel and
gasoline-only powered vehicles.
CAUTION!
Only vehicles with the E-85 fuel filler door label can
operate on E-85.
Ethanol Fuel (E-85)
E-85 is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and
15% unleaded gasoline.
WARNING!
Ethanol vapors are extremely flammable and could
cause serious personal injury. Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the vehicle when removing the fuel filler tube cap (gas cap) or filling the
tank. Do not use E-85 as a cleaning agent and never
use it near an open flame.
STARTING AND OPERATING 429
Fuel Requirements
NOTE:
If your vehicle is E-85 compatible, it will operate on • Use seasonally adjusted E-85 fuel (ASTM D5798). With
unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 87, or E-85
non-seasonally adjusted E-85 fuel, you may experience
fuel, or any mixture of these two fuels.
hard starting and rough idle following start up even if
the above recommendations are followed, especially
For best results, a refueling pattern that avoids alternatwhen the ambient temperature is below 32°F (0°C).
ing between E-85 and unleaded gasoline is recom• Some additives used in regular gasoline are not fully
compatible with E-85 and may form deposits in your
When you do switch fuel types it is recommended that:
engine. To eliminate driveability issues that may be
• You do not add less than 5 gallons (19 Liters) when
caused by these deposits, a supplemental gasoline
refueling.
additive, such as MOPAR® Injector Cleanup or
Techron may be used.
• You drive the vehicle immediately after refueling for at
least 5 miles (8 km).
mended.
Observing these precautions will avoid possible hard
starting and/or significant deterioration in driveability
during warm up.
5
430 STARTING AND OPERATING
Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel Vehicles
(E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles
FFV vehicles operated on E-85 require specially formulated engine oils. These special requirements are included
in MOPAR® engine oils, and in equivalent oils meeting
Chrysler Specification MS-6395. The manufacturer only
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
the requirements of Material Standard MS-6395. MS-6395
contains additional requirements, developed during extensive fleet testing, to provide additional protection to
Chrysler Group LLC engines. Use MOPAR® or an
equivalent oil meeting the specification MS-6395.
Starting
The characteristics of E-85 fuel make it unsuitable for use
when ambient temperatures fall below 0°F (-18°C). In the
range of 0°F (-18°C) to 32°F (0°C), you may experience an
increase in the time it takes for your engine to start, and
a deterioration in driveability (sags and/or hesitations)
until the engine is fully warmed up.
NOTE: Use of the engine block heater (if equipped) is
beneficial for E-85 startability when the ambient temperature is less than 32°F (0°C).
Cruising Range
Because E-85 fuel contains less energy per gallon/liter
than gasoline, you will experience an increase in fuel
consumption. You can expect your miles per gallon
(mpg)/Kilometers per liter and your driving range to
decrease by about 30%, compared to gasoline operation.
STARTING AND OPERATING 431
Replacement Parts
ADDING FUEL
Many components in your Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV) are 1. Press the fuel filler door release switch (located in the
designed to be compatible with ethanol. Always be sure
driver’s door map pocket).
that your vehicle is serviced with correct ethanol compatible parts.
CAUTION!
5
Replacing fuel system components with non-ethanol
compatible components can damage your vehicle.
Maintenance
CAUTION!
Do not use ethanol mixture greater than 85% in your
vehicle. It will cause difficulty in cold starting and
may affect drivability.
Fuel Filler Door Release Switch
432 STARTING AND OPERATING
2. Open the fuel filler door.
3. There is no fuel filler cap. A flapper door inside the
pipe seals the system.
4. Insert the fuel nozzle fully into the filler pipe – the
nozzle opens and holds the flapper door while refueling.
NOTE: Only the correct size nozzle opens the latches
allowing the flapper door to open.
5. Fill the vehicle with fuel – when the fuel nozzle
“clicks” or shuts off the fuel tank is full.
6. Maintain nozzle in filler for 5 seconds to allow nozzle
to drain.
Fuel Filler Door
7. Remove the fuel nozzle and close the fuel door.
NOTE: In certain cold conditions, ice may prevent the
fuel door from opening. If this occurs, lightly push on the NOTE: A funnel is provided (located in the trunk in the
fuel door to break the ice buildup and re-release the fuel spare tire area) to open the flapper door to allow for
door using the inside release button. Do not pry on the emergency refueling with a gas can.
door.
STARTING AND OPERATING 433
WARNING!
Fuel Funnel
CAUTION!
To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not “top
off” the fuel tank after filling.
• Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the
vehicle when the fuel door is open or the tank is
being filled.
• Never add fuel when the engine is running. This is
in violation of most state and federal fire regulations and may cause the “Malfunction Indicator
Light” to turn on.
• A fire may result if fuel is pumped into a portable
container that is inside of a vehicle. You could be
burned. Always place fuel containers on the
ground while filling.
5
434 STARTING AND OPERATING
Emergency Fuel Filler Door Release
3. Pull the release cable.
If you are unable to open the fuel filler door, use the fuel
filler door emergency release.
1. Open the trunk.
2. Remove the access cover (located on the left side inner
trim panel).
Release Cable
Access Cover
STARTING AND OPERATING 435
VEHICLE LOADING
• Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) rear
The load carrying capacity of your vehicle is shown on • Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
the “Vehicle Certification Label”. This information • Type of Vehicle
should be used for passenger and luggage loading as
• Month Day and Hour of Manufacture (MDH)
indicated.
Do not exceed the specified Gross Vehicle Weight Rating The bar code allows a computer scanner to read the VIN.
(GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).
Vehicle Certification Label
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle.
Your vehicle has a Vehicle Certification Label affixed to This includes driver, passengers, and cargo. The total
the drivers side B-Pillar or the rear of the driver’s door. load must be limited so that you do not exceed the
GVWR.
The label contains the following information:
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
• Name of manufacturer
The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear
• Month and year of manufacture
axles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axles
• Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front or
rear GAWR.
• Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) front
5
436 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Because the front wheels steer the vehicle, it is
important that you do not exceed the maximum front
or rear GAWR. A dangerous driving condition can
result if either rating is exceeded. You could lose
control of the vehicle and have a collision.
Overloading
The load carrying components (axle, springs, tires,
wheels, etc.) of your vehicle will provide satisfactory
service as long as you do not exceed the GVWR and the
front and rear GAWR.
Figure out the weight on the front and rear of the vehicle
separately. It is important that you distribute the load
evenly over the front and rear axles.
Overloading can cause potential safety hazards and
shorten useful service life. Heavier axles or suspension
components do not necessarily increase the vehicle’s
GVWR.
Loading
To load your vehicle properly, first figure out its empty
weight, axle-by-axle and side-by-side. Store heavier items
down low and be sure you distribute their weight as
evenly as possible. Stow all loose items securely before
The best way to figure out the total weight of your driving. If weighing the loaded vehicle shows that you
vehicle is to weigh it when it is fully loaded and ready for have exceeded either GAWR, but the total load is within
operation. Weigh it on a commercial scale to ensure that the specified GVWR, you must redistribute the weight.
Improper weight distribution can have an adverse effect
it is not over the GVWR.
on the way your vehicle steers and handles and the way
the brakes operate.
STARTING AND OPERATING 437
NOTE:
Common Towing Definitions
• Refer to the “Vehicle Certification Label” affixed to the The following trailer towing related definitions will assist
rear of the driver’s door for your vehicle’s GVWR and you in understanding the following information:
GAWRs.
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
• Refer to the “Tire Placard” for your vehicle’s proper The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle.
tire pressure.
This includes driver, passengers, cargo and tongue weight.
The total load must be limited so that you do not exceed
the GVWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle Certification
In this section you will find safety tips and information Label” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
on limits to the type of towing you can reasonably do
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW)
with your vehicle. Before towing a trailer, carefully
review this information to tow your load as efficiently The GTW is the weight of the trailer plus the weight of all
cargo, consumables and equipment (permanent or temand safely as possible.
porary) loaded in or on the trailer in its ⬙loaded and
To maintain the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage,
ready for operation⬙ condition. The recommended way to
follow the requirements and recommendations in this
measure GTW is to put your fully loaded trailer on a
manual concerning vehicles used for trailer towing.
vehicle scale. The entire weight of the trailer must be
supported by the scale.
TRAILER TOWING
5
438 STARTING AND OPERATING
Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR)
Tongue Weight (TW)
The GCWR is the total permissible weight of your vehicle The tongue weight is the downward force exerted on the
and trailer when weighed in combination.
hitch ball by the trailer. The recommended tongue weight
is 10% to 15% for a conventional hitch. You must consider
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
this as part of the load on your vehicle.
The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear
Frontal Area
axles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axles
evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front or The frontal area is the maximum height multiplied by the
rear GAWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle Certifica- maximum width of the front of a trailer.
tion Label” in “Starting and Operating” for further
Trailer Sway Control
information.
The trailer sway control is a telescoping link that can be
installed between the hitch receiver and the trailer tongue
WARNING!
that typically provides adjustable friction associated with
It is important that you do not exceed the maximum the telescoping motion to dampen any unwanted trailer
front or rear GAWR. A dangerous driving condition swaying motions while traveling.
can result if either rating is exceeded. You could lose
control of the vehicle and have a collision.
STARTING AND OPERATING 439
Trailer sway control and a weight distributing (load
equalizing) hitch are recommended for heavier Tongue
A weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongue
Weights (TW) and may be required depending on vehicle
weight, just as if it were luggage located at a hitch ball or
and trailer configuration/loading to comply with Gross
some other connecting point of the vehicle. These kinds
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) requirements.
of hitches are the most popular on the market today and
they are commonly used to tow small and medium sized
WARNING!
trailers.
Weight-Carrying Hitch
Weight-Distributing Hitch
A weight-distributing system works by applying leverage through spring (load) bars. They are typically used
for heavier loads to distribute trailer tongue weight to the
tow vehicle’s front axle and the trailer axle(s). When used
in accordance with the manufacturer’s directions, it provides for a more level ride, offering more consistent
steering and brake control thereby enhancing towing
safety. The addition of a friction/hydraulic sway control
also dampens sway caused by traffic and crosswinds and
contributes positively to tow vehicle and trailer stability.
• An improperly adjusted Weight Distributing Hitch
system may reduce handling, stability, braking
performance, and could result in a collision.
• Weight Distributing Systems may not be compatible
with Surge Brake Couplers. Consult with your hitch
and trailer manufacturer or a reputable Recreational
Vehicle dealer for additional information.
5
440 STARTING AND OPERATING
Trailer Hitch Classification
The following chart provides the industry standard for
the maximum trailer weight a given trailer hitch class can
tow and should be used to assist you in selecting the
correct trailer hitch for your intended towing condition.
Trailer Hitch Classification Definitions
Class
Max. Trailer Hitch Industry Standards
Class I - Light Duty
2,000 lbs (907 kg)
Class II - Medium Duty
3,500 lbs (1 587 kg)
Class III - Heavy Duty
5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)
Class IV - Extra Heavy Duty
10,000 lbs (4 540 kg)
Refer to the “Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)” chart for the Maximum Gross Trailer
Weight (GTW) towable for your given drivetrain.
All trailer hitches should be professionally installed on your vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 441
Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight
Ratings)
The following chart provides the maximum trailer
weight ratings towable for your given drivetrain.
Engine/Transmission
3.6L Automatic
5.7L Automatic
Max. GTW (Gross
Trailer Weight)
22 sq ft (2.04 sq m)
1,000 lbs (454 kg)
32 sq ft (2.97 sq m)
1,000 lbs (454 kg)
Refer to local laws for maximum trailer towing speeds.
Frontal Area
NOTE: The trailer tongue weight must be considered as
part of the combined weight of occupants and cargo, and
it should never exceed the weight referenced on the “Tire
and Loading Information” placard. Refer to “Tire Safety
Information” in “Starting and Operating” for further
information.
Max. Tongue Weight
(See Note)
100 lbs (45 kg)
100 lbs (45 kg)
5
442 STARTING AND OPERATING
Trailer And Tongue Weight
Always load a trailer with 60% to 65% of the weight in
the front of the trailer. This places 10% to 15% of the
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) on the tow hitch of your
vehicle. Loads balanced over the wheels or heavier in the
rear can cause the trailer to sway severely side to side
which will cause loss of control of the vehicle and trailer.
Failure to load trailers heavier in front is the cause of
many trailer collisions.
Never exceed the maximum tongue weight stamped on
your bumper or trailer hitch.
STARTING AND OPERATING 443
Consider the following items when computing the Towing Requirements
weight on the rear axle of the vehicle:
To promote proper break-in of your new vehicle drive• The tongue weight of the trailer.
train components the following guidelines are recom• The weight of any other type of cargo or equipment mended:
put in or on your vehicle.
• The weight of the driver and all passengers.
NOTE: Remember that everything put into or on the
trailer adds to the load on your vehicle. Also, additional
factory-installed options or dealer-installed options must
be considered as part of the total load on your vehicle.
Refer to the “Tire and Loading Information” placard for
the maximum combined weight of occupants and cargo
for your vehicle.
WARNING!
Improper towing can lead to an injury collision.
Follow these guidelines to make your trailer towing
as safe as possible:
• Make certain that the load is secured in the trailer
and it will not shift during travel. When trailering
cargo that is not fully secured, dynamic load shifts
can occur that may be difficult for the driver to
control. You could lose control of your vehicle and
have a collision.
(Continued)
5
444 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• When hauling cargo or towing a trailer, do not
overload your vehicle or trailer. Overloading can
cause a loss of control, poor performance, or damage to brakes, axle, engine, transmission, steering,
suspension, chassis structure, or tires.
• Safety chains must always be used between your
vehicle and trailer. Always connect the chains to
the frame or hook retainers of the vehicle hitch.
Cross the chains under the trailer tongue and allow
enough slack for turning corners.
• Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a
grade. When parking, apply the parking brake on
the tow vehicle. Put the tow vehicle automatic
transmission in PARK. Always, block or ⴖchockⴖ
the trailer wheels.
• GCWR must not be exceeded.
• Total weight must be distributed between the tow
vehicle and the trailer such that the following four
ratings are not exceeded:
(Continued)
1. Max loading as defined on the “Tire and Loading
Information” placard.
2. GTW
3. GAWR
4. Tongue weight rating for the trailer hitch utilized. (This requirement may limit the ability to
always achieve the 10% to 15% range of tongue
weight as a percentage of total trailer weight.)
STARTING AND OPERATING 445
CAUTION!
• Do not tow a trailer at all during the first 500 miles
(805 km) the new vehicle is driven. The engine, axle
or other parts could be damaged.
• Then, during the first 500 miles (805 km) that a
trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h)
and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps
the engine and other parts of the vehicle wear in at
the heavier loads.
• Check the trailer tires for proper tire inflation pressures before trailer usage.
• Check for signs of tire wear or visible tire damage
before towing a trailer. Refer to “Tires – General
Information” in “Starting and Operating” for information on tread wear indicators and for the proper
inspection procedure.
• When replacing tires, refer to “Tires – General Information” in “Starting and Operating” for information
on replacement tires and for the proper tire replaceTowing Requirements — Tires
ment procedures. Replacing tires with a higher load
carrying capacity will not increase the vehicle’s GVWR
• Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compact
and GAWR limits.
spare tire.
• Proper tire inflation pressures are essential to the safe
and satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Refer to
“Tires – General Information” in “Starting and Operating” for information on tire pressures and for proper tire
inflation procedures.
5
446 STARTING AND OPERATING
Towing Requirements — Trailer Brakes
• Do not interconnect the hydraulic brake system or
vacuum system of your vehicle with that of the trailer.
This could cause inadequate braking and possible
personal injury.
• An electronically actuated trailer brake controller is
required when towing a trailer with electronically
actuated brakes. When towing a trailer equipped with
a hydraulic surge actuated brake system, an electronic
brake controller is not required.
• Trailer brakes are recommended for trailers over
1,000 lbs (454 kg) and required for trailers in excess of
2,000 lbs (907 kg).
WARNING!
• Do not connect trailer brakes to your vehicle’s hydraulic brake lines. It can overload your brake system and
cause it to fail. You might not have brakes when you
need them and could have a collision.
• Towing any trailer will increase your stopping
distance. When towing you should allow for additional space between your vehicle and the vehicle
in front of you. Failure to do so could result in a
collision.
CAUTION!
If the trailer weighs more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg)
loaded, it should have its own brakes and they
should be of adequate capacity. Failure to do this
could lead to accelerated brake lining wear, higher
brake pedal effort, and longer stopping distances.
STARTING AND OPERATING 447
Towing Requirements — Trailer Lights And Wiring
Whenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer size,
stoplights and turn signals on the trailer are required for
motoring safety.
The Trailer Tow Package may include a four- and sevenpin wiring harness. Use a factory approved trailer harness and connector.
5
NOTE: Do not cut or splice wiring into the vehicles
wiring harness.
The electrical connections are all complete to the vehicle
but you must mate the harness to a trailer connector.
Refer to the following illustrations.
1 — Female Pins
2 — Male Pin
3 — Ground
Four-Pin Connector
4 — Park
5 — Left Stop/Turn
6 — Right Stop/Turn
448 STARTING AND OPERATING
Towing Tips
Before setting out on a trip, practice turning, stopping,
and backing up the trailer in an area located away from
heavy traffic.
Automatic Transmission
The DRIVE range can be selected when towing. The
transmission controls include a drive strategy to avoid
frequent shifting when towing. However, if frequent
shifting does occur while in DRIVE, you can use the
AutoStick shift control to select a lower gear.
Seven-Pin Connector
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Battery
Backup Lamps
Right Stop/Turn
Electric Brakes
5 — Ground
6 — Left Stop/Turn
7 — Running Lamps
NOTE: Using a lower gear while operating the vehicle
under heavy loading conditions will improve performance and extend transmission life by reducing excessive shifting and heat buildup. This action will also
provide better engine braking.
STARTING AND OPERATING 449
• To prevent excess heat generation, avoid continuous
driving at high RPM. Reduce vehicle speed as neces• Do not use in hilly terrain or with heavy loads.
sary to avoid extended driving at high RPM. Return to
a higher gear or vehicle speed when grade and road
• When using the speed control, if you experience speed
conditions allow.
drops greater than 10 mph (16 km/h), disengage until
you can get back to cruising speed.
Cooling System
• Use speed control in flat terrain and with light loads to To reduce potential for engine and transmission overmaximize fuel efficiency.
heating, take the following actions:
Electronic Speed Control — If Equipped
AutoStick — If Equipped
City Driving
• When using the AutoStick shift control, select the
When stopped for short periods of time, shift the transhighest gear that allows for adequate performance and
mission into NEUTRAL and increase engine idle speed.
avoids frequent downshifts. For example, choose “5” if
the desired speed can be maintained. Choose “4” or Highway Driving
“3” if needed to maintain the desired speed.
Reduce speed.
Air Conditioning
Turn off temporarily.
5
450 STARTING AND OPERATING
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Two-Wheel Drive And All-Wheel Drive
Recreational towing (with all four wheels on the ground,
or using a tow dolly) is NOT ALLOWED. The only
acceptable method for towing this vehicle (behind another vehicle) is on a vehicle trailer with all four wheels
OFF the ground.
CAUTION!
Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission and/or transfer
case damage. Damage from improper towing is not
covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CONTENTS
䡵 HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS . . . . . . . . . . .452 䡵 JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . .464
䡵 IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS . . . . . . . . . . . .452
▫ Preparations For Jump-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
䡵 WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
▫ Jump-Starting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .466
▫ Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
䡵 JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING . . . . . . . . . .455
▫ Jack Location/Spare Tire Stowage . . . . . . . . .456
▫ Preparations For Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .458
▫ Jacking And Changing A Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . .459
▫ Road Tire Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
䡵 FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
䡵 MANUAL PARK RELEASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .470
䡵 TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . .473
▫ All Wheel Drive (AWD) Models . . . . . . . . . . .475
▫ Rear-Wheel Drive (RWD) Models . . . . . . . . . .475
▫ Without The Key Fob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .476
6
452 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS
NOTE: With extended use the Hazard Warning flashers
may wear down your battery.
The Hazard Warning flasher switch is located in the
center of the instrument panel between the center air IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS
outlets.
In any of the following situations, you can reduce the
Press the switch to turn on the Hazard Warning potential for overheating by taking the appropriate acflashers. When the switch is activated, all direc- tion.
tional turn signals will flash on and off to warn oncoming
• On the highways — slow down.
traffic of an emergency. Press the switch a second time to
• In city traffic — while stopped, place the transmission
turn off the Hazard Warning flashers.
in NEUTRAL, but do not increase the engine idle
This is an emergency warning system and it should not
speed.
be used when the vehicle is in motion. Use it when your
vehicle is disabled and it is creating a safety hazard for NOTE: There are steps that you can take to slow down
an impending overheat condition:
other motorists.
When you must leave the vehicle to seek assistance, the • If your air conditioner (A/C) is on, turn it off. The A/C
system adds heat to the engine cooling system and
Hazard Warning flashers will continue to operate even
turning the A/C off can help remove this heat.
though the ignition is placed in the OFF position.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 453
• You can also turn the temperature control to maximum
heat, the mode control to floor and the blower control
to high. This allows the heater core to act as a
supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat
from the engine cooling system.
CAUTION!
Driving with a hot cooling system could damage
your vehicle. If the temperature gauge reads “H,”
pull over and stop the vehicle. Idle the vehicle with
the air conditioner turned off until the pointer drops
back into the normal range. If the pointer remains on
the “H,” turn the engine off immediately and call for
service.
WARNING!
You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had time
to cool. Never try to open a cooling system pressure
cap when the radiator or coolant bottle is hot.
WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Proper lug nut/bolt torque is very important to ensure
that the wheel is properly mounted to the vehicle. Any
time a wheel has been removed and reinstalled on the
vehicle the lug nuts/bolts should be torqued using a
properly calibrated torque wrench.
6
454 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Torque Specifications
Lug Nut/Bolt Torque
**Lug Nut/
Bolt Size
130 Ft-Lbs (176 N·m)
M14 x 1.50
Lug Nut/
Bolt Socket
Size
22 mm
**Use only Chrysler recommended lug nuts/bolts and
clean or remove any dirt or oil before tightening.
Inspect the wheel mounting surface prior to mounting
the tire and remove any corrosion or loose particles.
Wheel Mounting Surface
Tighten the lug nuts/bolts in a star pattern until each
nut/bolt has been tightened twice.
After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut/bolt torque to be
sure that all the lug nuts/bolts are properly seated
against the wheel.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 455
JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING
WARNING!
Torque Patterns
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle has
been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
• Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
• Being under a jacked-up vehicle is dangerous. The
vehicle could slip off the jack and fall on you. You
could be crushed. Never put any part of your body
under a vehicle that is on a jack. If you need to get
under a raised vehicle, take it to a service center
where it can be raised on a lift.
• Never start or run the engine while the vehicle is
on a jack.
(Continued)
6
456 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING! (Continued)
• The jack is designed to be used as a tool for
changing tires only. The jack should not be used to
lift the vehicle for service purposes. The vehicle
should be jacked on a firm level surface only.
Avoid ice or slippery areas.
Jack Location/Spare Tire Stowage
The jack and spare tire are both stowed under an access
cover in the trunk. Follow these steps to access the jack
and spare tire.
Opening The Access Panel
NOTE: The spare tire must be removed in order to
3. Remove the fastener securing the spare tire.
access the jack.
1. Open the trunk.
2. Lift the access cover using the pull strap.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 457
6
Spare Tire Fastener
4. Remove the spare tire.
5. Remove the fastener securing the jack.
Jack Fastener
6. Remove the jack and lug wrench assembly from under
the spare tire. Turn the jack screw to the left to loosen
the lug wrench, and remove the wrench from the jack
assembly.
458 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision or
hard stop could endanger the occupants of the vehicle. Always stow the jack parts and the spare tire in
the places provided. Have the deflated (flat) tire
repaired or replaced immediately.
2. Turn on the Hazard Warning flasher.
3. Set the parking brake.
4. Place the shift lever/gear selector into PARK.
5. Turn OFF the ignition.
6. Block both the front and rear of the wheel diagonally
opposite of the jacking position. For
Preparations For Jacking
example, if changing the right front
tire, block the left rear wheel.
1. Park the vehicle on a firm, level surface as far from the
edge of the roadway as possible. Avoid icy or slippery
areas.
WARNING!
Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic, pull far enough off
the road to avoid being hit when operating the jack
or changing the wheel.
NOTE: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle
when the vehicle is being jacked.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 459
Jacking And Changing A Tire
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
Carefully follow these tire changing warnings to
help prevent personal injury or damage to your
vehicle:
• Always park on a firm, level surface as far from the
edge of the roadway as possible before raising the
vehicle.
• Turn on the Hazard Warning flasher.
• Block the wheel diagonally opposite the wheel to
be raised.
• Set the parking brake firmly and set an automatic
transmission in PARK; a manual transmission in
REVERSE.
• Never start or run the engine with the vehicle on a
jack.
• Do not let anyone sit in the vehicle when it is on a
jack.
• Do not get under the vehicle when it is on a jack. If
you need to get under a raised vehicle, take it to a
service center where it can be raised on a lift.
• Only use the jack in the positions indicated and for
lifting this vehicle during a tire change.
• If working on or near a roadway, be extremely
careful of motor traffic.
Jack Warning Label
(Continued)
6
460 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
Do not attempt to raise the vehicle by jacking on
locations other than those indicated in the Jacking
Instructions for this vehicle.
1. Remove the spare tire, jack, and lug wrench.
2. If equipped with aluminum wheels where the center
cap covers the lug nuts, use the lug wrench to pry the
center cap off carefully before raising the vehicle.
3. Before raising the vehicle, use the lug wrench to
Jacking Locations
loosen, but not remove, the lug nuts on the wheel with
the flat tire. Turn the lug nuts counterclockwise one 4. Place the jack underneath the lift area that is closest to
turn while the wheel is still on the ground.
the flat tire. Turn the jack screw clockwise to firmly
engage the jack saddle with the lift area of the sill
flange.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 461
NOTE: If the vehicle is too low for jack placement, slide
the jack on its side and rotate it up into position.
6
Rear Jacking Location
Front Jacking Location
5. Raise the vehicle just enough to remove the flat tire
and install the spare tire.
462 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
Raising the vehicle higher than necessary can make
the vehicle less stable. It could slip off the jack and
hurt someone near it. Raise the vehicle only enough
to remove the tire.
6. Remove the lug nuts and tire.
7. Mount the spare tire.
CAUTION!
Be sure to mount the spare tire with the valve stem
facing outward. The vehicle could be damaged if the
spare tire is mounted incorrectly.
Mounting Spare Tire
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 463
9. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
handle counterclockwise.
• For vehicles so equipped, do not attempt to install a
center cap or wheel cover on the compact spare.
10. Finish tightening the lug nuts. Push down on the
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
• Refer to “Compact Spare Tire” and to “Limited-Use
leverage. Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until
Spare” under “Tires—General Information” in
each nut has been tightened twice. For the correct lug
“Starting and Operating” for additional warnings,
nut torque refer to Torque Specifications in this
cautions, and information about the spare tire, its
section. If in doubt about the correct tightness, have
use, and operation.
them checked with a torque wrench by your autho8. Install the lug nuts with the cone shaped end of the lug
rized dealer or at a service station.
nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the lug nuts.
11. Stow the jack, tools and flat tire. Make sure the base
of the jack faces the front of the vehicle before
WARNING!
tightening down the fastener.
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle has
been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
NOTE:
6
464 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision or hard
stop could endanger the occupants of the vehicle. Always stow the jack parts and the spare tire in the places
provided. Have the deflated (flat) tire repaired or replaced immediately.
Road Tire Installation
3. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
handle counterclockwise.
4. Refer to Torque Table for proper lug nut torque.
5. After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut torque with a
torque wrench to ensure that all lug nuts are properly
seated against the wheel.
JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURES
1. Mount the road tire on the axle.
If your vehicle has a discharged battery it can be jump2. Install the remaining lug nuts with the cone shaped end started using a set of jumper cables and a battery in
of the nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the lug nuts. another vehicle or by using a portable battery booster
pack. Jump-starting can be dangerous if done improperly
so please follow the procedures in this section carefully.
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack, do
not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle has been
lowered. Failure to follow this warning may result in
personal injury.
NOTE: When using a portable battery booster pack
follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions and
precautions.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 465
CAUTION!
Do not use a portable battery booster pack or any
other booster source with a system voltage greater
than 12 Volts or damage to the battery, starter motor,
alternator or electrical system may occur.
WARNING!
Do not attempt jump-starting if the battery is frozen.
It could rupture or explode and cause personal injury.
Preparations For Jump-Start
6
Remote Battery Post Locations
The battery is stored under an access cover in the trunk. 1 — Remote Positive (+) Post
Remote battery posts are located on the right side of the 2 — Remote Negative (-) Post
engine compartment for jump-starting.
466 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
• Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the hood is raised. It can start anytime the
ignition switch is ON. You can be injured by
moving fan blades.
• Remove any metal jewelry such as rings, watch
bands and bracelets that could make an inadvertent
electrical contact. You could be seriously injured.
• Batteries contain sulfuric acid that can burn your
skin or eyes and generate hydrogen gas which is
flammable and explosive. Keep open flames or
sparks away from the battery.
1. Set the parking brake, shift the automatic transmission
into PARK and turn the ignition to LOCK.
2. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical accessories.
3. If using another vehicle to jump-start the battery, park
the vehicle within the jumper cables reach, set the
parking brake and make sure the ignition is OFF.
WARNING!
Do not allow vehicles to touch each other as this
could establish a ground connection and personal
injury could result.
Jump-Starting Procedure
WARNING!
Failure to follow this jump-starting procedure could
result in personal injury or property damage due to
battery explosion.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 467
CAUTION!
WARNING!
Failure to follow these procedures could result in
damage to the charging system of the booster vehicle
or the discharged vehicle.
Do not connect the jumper cable to the negative (-)
post of the discharged battery. The resulting electrical spark could cause the battery to explode and
could result in personal injury. Only use the specific
ground point, do not use any other exposed metal
parts.
Connecting The Jumper Cables
1. Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable to the
remote positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
2. Connect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable to the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
3. Connect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable to the
negative (-) post of the booster battery.
4. Connect the opposite end of the negative (-) jumper
cable to the remote negative (-) post of the vehicle with
the discharged battery.
5. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster
battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and then
start the engine in the vehicle with the discharged
battery.
6
468 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
6. Once the engine is started, remove the jumper cables
in the reverse sequence:
Disconnecting The Jumper Cables
1. Disconnect the negative (-) jumper cable from the
remote negative (-) post of the vehicle with the discharged battery.
2. Disconnect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable
from the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
CAUTION!
Accessories plugged into the vehicle power outlets
draw power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not
in use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough without engine operation,
the vehicle’s battery will discharge sufficiently to
degrade battery life and/or prevent the engine from
starting.
3. Disconnect the positive (+) jumper cable from the FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE
positive (+) post of the booster battery.
If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand, or snow, it
4. Disconnect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable can often be moved using a rocking motion. Turn the
from the remote positive (+) post of the discharged steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the
vehicle.
front wheels. Then shift back and forth between DRIVE
If frequent jump-starting is required to start your vehicle and REVERSE while gently pressing the accelerator. Use
you should have the battery and charging system in- the least amount of accelerator pedal pressure that will
maintain the rocking motion, without spinning the
spected at your authorized dealer.
wheels or racing the engine.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 469
NOTE: Shifts between DRIVE and REVERSE can only be
achieved at wheel speeds of 5 mph (8 km/h) or less.
Whenever the transmission remains in NEUTRAL for
more than 2 seconds, you must press the brake pedal to
engage DRIVE or REVERSE.
NOTE: Press the ⬙ESC Off⬙ switch, to place the Electronic
Stability Control (ESC) system in ⬙Partial Off⬙ mode,
before rocking the vehicle. Refer to “Electronic Brake
Control” in “Starting And Operating” for further information. Once the vehicle has been freed, press the ⬙ESC
Off⬙ switch again to restore ⬙ESC On⬙ mode.
CAUTION!
Racing the engine or spinning the wheels may lead to
transmission overheating and failure. Allow the engine to idle with the transmission in NEUTRAL for at
least one minute after every five rocking-motion
cycles. This will minimize overheating and reduce
the risk of transmission failure during prolonged
efforts to free a stuck vehicle.
CAUTION!
• When “rocking” a stuck vehicle by shifting between DRIVE and REVERSE, do not spin the
wheels faster than 15 mph (24 km/h), or drivetrain
damage may result.
• Revving the engine or spinning the wheels too fast
may lead to transmission overheating and failure.
It can also damage the tires. Do not spin the wheels
above 30 mph (48 km/h) while in gear (no transmission shifting occurring).
6
470 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause damage, or
even failure, of the axle and tires. A tire could
explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or for
longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping when you are stuck and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
MANUAL PARK RELEASE
WARNING!
Always secure your vehicle by fully applying the
parking brake, before activating the Manual Park
Release. Activating the Manual Park Release will
allow your vehicle to roll away if it is not secured by
the parking brake or by proper connection to a tow
vehicle. Activating the Manual Park Release on an
unsecured vehicle could lead to serious injury or
death for those in or around the vehicle.
In order to push or tow the vehicle in cases where the
transmission will not shift out of PARK (such as a dead
battery), a Manual Park Release is available.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 471
Follow these steps to use the Manual Park Release:
1. Firmly apply the parking brake.
3. Using a small screwdriver or similar tool, fish the
tether strap up through the opening in the console
base.
2. Remove the console storage bin to access the Manual
4. Insert the screwdriver into the slot in the center of the
Park Release lever.
lever, and disengage the lever locking tab by pushing
it to the right.
6
Manual Park Release Lever Location
Locking Tab Location
472 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
5. While holding the locking tab in the disengaged To Reset The Manual Park Release:
position, pull the tether strap to rotate the lever up and
1. Push the latch (at the base of the lever, on the rear side)
rearward, until it locks in place in the vertical position.
rearward (away from the lever) to unlatch the lever.
The vehicle is now out of PARK and can be towed.
Release the parking brake only when the vehicle is 2. Rotate the Manual Park Release lever forward and
securely connected to a tow vehicle.
down, to its original position, until the locking tab
snaps into place to secure the lever.
3. Pull up gently on the tether strap to confirm that the
lever is locked in its stowed position.
4. Tuck the tether strap into the base of the console.
Reinstall the console storage bin.
Tether Strap Location
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 473
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
This section describes procedures for towing a disabled
vehicle using a commercial towing service.
Towing
Condition
Flat Tow
Wheel Lift or
Dolly Tow
Flatbed
Wheels OFF
The Ground
NONE
RWD MODELS
AWD MODELS
NOT ALLOWED
Rear
If transmission is operable:
• Transmission in NEUTRAL
• 30 mph (48 km/h) max speed
• 30 miles (48 km) max distance
NOT RECOMMENDED (but, if
used, same limitations as above)
NOT RECOMMENDED
ALL
BEST METHOD
Front
6
NOT ALLOWED
NOT RECOMMENDED, but, if used:
• Ignition in ON/RUN position
• Transmission in NEUTRAL
(NOT in Park)
BEST METHOD
474 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Proper towing or lifting equipment is required to prevent
damage to your vehicle. Use only tow bars and other
equipment designed for this purpose, following equipment manufacturer’s instructions. Use of safety chains is
mandatory. Attach a tow bar or other towing device to
main structural members of the vehicle, not to bumpers
or associated brackets. State and local laws regarding
vehicles under tow must be observed.
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.)
while being towed, the ignition must be in the ON/RUN
position, not the ACC position.
If the key fob is unavailable, or the vehicle’s battery is
discharged, refer to ⬙Manual Park Release⬙ in this section
for instructions on shifting the transmission out of PARK
for towing.
CAUTION!
• DO NOT use sling-type equipment when towing.
Vehicle damage may occur.
• When securing the vehicle to a flatbed truck, do not
attach to front or rear suspension components.
Damage to your vehicle may result from improper
towing.
• The manufacturer does not recommend towing this
vehicle using a tow dolly. Vehicle damage may occur.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 475
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Models
Rear-Wheel Drive (RWD) Models
The manufacturer recommends towing your vehicle with The manufacturer recommends towing your vehicle with
all four wheels OFF the ground using a flatbed.
all four wheels OFF the ground using a flatbed.
If the transmission and drivetrain are operable, AWD models can also be towed with the ignition in the ON/RUN
position, the transmission in NEUTRAL (not in PARK!), and
the rear wheels OFF the ground with no limitation on speed
or distance. Since the ignition MUST be in the ON/RUN
position to tow in this manner, AWD vehicles must be towed
with ALL FOUR wheels OFF the ground (e.g. on a flatbed
truck) if the Key Fob is unavailable.
CAUTION!
• Towing this vehicle using any other method can cause
severe transmission and/or transfer case damage.
• Damage from improper towing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
If flatbed equipment is not available, and the transmission is operable, this vehicle may be towed (with rear
wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:
• The transmission must be in NEUTRAL.
• The towing speed must not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h).
• The towing distance must not exceed 30 miles (48 km).
If the transmission is not operable, or the vehicle must be
towed faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or farther than
30 miles (48 km), then the only acceptable method of
towing is with a flatbed truck.
6
476 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage. Damage from improper towing is not covered under the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Without The Key Fob
Special care must be taken when the vehicle is towed
with the ignition in the LOCK/OFF position. The only
approved method of towing without the Key Fob is with
a flatbed truck. Proper towing equipment is necessary to
prevent damage to the vehicle.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L . . . . . . . . . .479
▫ Engine Air Cleaner Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 5.7L . . . . . . . . . .480
▫ Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
䡵 ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II . .481
▫ Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
䡵 EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE PROGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . .482
▫ A/C Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .493
䡵 REPLACEMENT PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
䡵 DEALER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
䡵 MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . .484
▫ Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
▫ Engine Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
▫ Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .495
▫ Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .495
▫ Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .496
▫ Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .496
▫ Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .499
▫ Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .505
7
478 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .508
▫ Front Turn Signal Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .534
▫ All Wheel Drive (AWD) — If Equipped . . . . .509
▫ Front Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .535
▫ Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .510
▫ Front/Rear Side Marker Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . .535
▫ Appearance Care And Protection From
Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .511
▫ Rear Backup Lamp And Turn Signal Lamps . . .535
䡵 FUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .517
▫ Front Power Distribution Center (Fuses) . . . . .518
▫ Rear Power Distribution Center (Fuses) . . . . .523
▫ License Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .535
▫ Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL). . .535
䡵 FLUID CAPACITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .536
䡵 VEHICLE STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
䡵 FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE
PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .537
䡵 REPLACEMENT BULBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
▫ Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .537
䡵 BULB REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .533
▫ Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .539
▫ Low Beam And High Beam Headlamp . . . . . .533
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 479
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L
7
1 — Remote Jump Start (Positive Battery Post)
2 — Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
3 — Remote Jump Start (Negative Battery Post)
4 — Engine Oil Dipstick
5 — Brake Fluid Reservoir Access Cover
6 — Engine Coolant Reservoir
7 — Air Cleaner Filter
8 — Engine Oil Fill
9 — Washer Fluid Reservoir
480 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 5.7L
1 — Remote Jump Start (Positive Battery Post)
2 — Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
3 — Remote Jump Start (Negative Battery Post)
4 — Brake Fluid Reservoir Access Cover
5 — Engine Coolant Reservoir
6 — Air Cleaner Filter
7 — Engine Oil Fill
8 — Engine Oil Dipstick
9 — Washer Fluid Reservoir
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 481
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II
Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard
diagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitors
the performance of the emissions, engine, and automatic
transmission control systems. When these systems are
operating properly, your vehicle will provide excellent
performance and fuel economy, as well as engine emissions well within current government regulations.
If any of these systems require service, the OBD II system
will turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL).” It
will also store diagnostic codes and other information to
assist your service technician in making repairs. Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not
need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as
soon as possible.
CAUTION!
• Prolonged driving with the MIL on could cause
further damage to the emissions control system. It
could also affect fuel economy and driveability.
The vehicle must be serviced before any emissions
tests can be performed.
• If the MIL is flashing while the engine is running,
severe catalytic converter damage and power loss
will soon occur. Immediate service is required.
7
482 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Your vehicle has a simple ignition actuated test, which you
can use prior to going to the test station. To check if your
In some localities, it may be a legal requirement to pass vehicle’s OBD II system is ready, you must do the following:
an inspection of your vehicle’s emissions control system. 1. Cycle the ignition switch to the ON position, but do
Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration.
not crank or start the engine.
EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
PROGRAMS
For states that require an Inspection and Mainte- NOTE: If you crank or start the engine, you will have to
nance (I/M), this check verifies the “Malfunction start this test over.
Indicator Light (MIL)” is functioning and is not
2. As soon as you cycle the ignition switch to the ON
on when the engine is running, and that the OBD II
position, you will see the Malfunction Indicator Light
system is ready for testing.
(MIL) symbol come on as part of a normal bulb check.
Normally, the OBD II system will be ready. The OBD II
3. Approximately 15 seconds later, one of two things will
system may not be ready if your vehicle was recently
happen:
serviced, recently had a dead battery or a battery replacement. If the OBD II system should be determined not • The MIL will flash for about 10 seconds and then
ready for the I/M test, your vehicle may fail the test.
return to being fully illuminated until you turn OFF
the ignition or start the engine. This means that your
vehicle’s OBD II system is not ready and you should
not proceed to the I/M station.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 483
• The MIL will not flash at all and will remain fully
illuminated until you place the ignition in the off
position or start the engine. This means that your
vehicle’s OBD II system is ready and you can proceed
to the I/M station.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
Use of genuine MOPAR® parts for normal/scheduled
maintenance and repairs is highly recommended to ensure the designed performance. Damage or failures
caused by the use of non-MOPAR® parts for mainteIf your OBD II system is not ready, you should see your nance and repairs will not be covered by the New Vehicle
authorized dealer or repair facility. If your vehicle was Limited Warranty.
recently serviced or had a battery failure or replacement,
you may need to do nothing more than drive your DEALER SERVICE
vehicle as you normally would in order for your OBD II Your authorized dealer has the qualified service personsystem to update. A recheck with the above test routine nel, special tools, and equipment to perform all service
may then indicate that the system is now ready.
operations in an expert manner. Service Manuals are
available which include detailed service information for
Regardless of whether your vehicle’s OBD II system is
your vehicle. Refer to these Service Manuals before
ready or not, if the MIL is illuminated during normal
attempting any procedure yourself.
vehicle operation you should have your vehicle serviced
before going to the I/M station. The I/M station can fail
your vehicle because the MIL is on with the engine
running.
7
484 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control
systems may void your warranty and could result in civil
penalties being assessed against you.
WARNING!
You can be badly injured working on or around a motor
vehicle. Only do service work for which you have the
knowledge and the proper equipment. If you have any
doubt about your ability to perform a service job, take
your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
The pages that follow contain the required maintenance
services determined by the engineers who designed your
vehicle.
Besides those maintenance items specified in the fixed
“Maintenance Schedule”, there are other components
which may require servicing or replacement in the future.
CAUTION!
• Failure to properly maintain your vehicle or perform repairs and service when necessary could
result in more costly repairs, damage to other
components or negatively impact vehicle performance. Immediately have potential malfunctions
examined by an authorized dealer or qualified
repair center.
• Your vehicle has been built with improved fluids
that protect the performance and durability of your
vehicle and also allow extended maintenance intervals. Do not use chemical flushes in these components as the chemicals can damage your engine,
transmission, power steering or air conditioning.
Such damage is not covered by the New Vehicle
Limited Warranty. If a flush is needed because of
component malfunction, use only the specified
fluid for the flushing procedure.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 485
Checking Oil Level — 5.7L Engine
Engine Oil
To assure proper engine lubrication, the engine oil must
be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at
To assure proper engine lubrication, the engine oil must
regular intervals, such as every fuel stop. The best time to
be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at
check the engine oil level is about five minutes after a
regular intervals, such as every fuel stop. The best time to
fully warmed engine is shut off.
check the engine oil level is about five minutes after a
fully warmed engine is shut off.
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will
improve the accuracy of the oil level readings. Maintain
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will
the oil level in the “SAFE” range. Adding 1.0 qt (1.0 L) of
improve the accuracy of the oil level readings. Maintain
oil when the reading is at the bottom of the “SAFE” range
the oil level between the MIN and MAX markings on the
will result in an oil level at the top of the “SAFE” range
dipstick. Adding 1.0 qt (1.0 L) of oil when the reading is
on these engines.
at the MIN mark will result in a MAX reading on these
engines.
Checking Oil Level — 3.6L Engine
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
Overfilling or underfilling will cause oil aeration or
loss of oil pressure. This could damage your engine.
Overfilling or underfilling will cause oil aeration or
loss of oil pressure. This could damage your engine.
7
486 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Change Engine Oil
American Petroleum Institute (API) Engine Oil
The oil change indicator system will remind you that it is Identification Symbol
time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance.
This symbol means that the oil has
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for further informabeen certified by the American
tion.
Petroleum Institute (API). The
NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change inmanufacturer only recommends
tervals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve
API Certified engine oils.
months, whichever occurs first.
Engine Oil Selection
For best performance and maximum protection under all
types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your engine oil as the
chemicals can damage your engine. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 487
Engine Oil Viscosity — 3.6L Engine
Engine Oil Viscosity — 5.7L Engine
MOPAR® SAE 5W-20 engine oil approved to Chrysler
Material Standard MS-6395 such as Pennzoil®, Shell
Helix® or equivalent is recommended for all operating
temperatures. This engine oil improves low temperature
starting and vehicle fuel economy.
MOPAR® SAE 5W-20 engine oil or equivalent such as
Pennzoil® or Shell Helix® is recommended for all operating temperatures. This engine oil improves low temperature starting and vehicle fuel economy.
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended engine
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended oil viscosity for your engine. For information on engine oil
engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on filler cap location, refer to “Engine Compartment” in “Mainengine oil filler cap location, refer to the “Engine Com- taining Your Vehicle” for further information.
partment” illustration in this section.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with a 5.7L engine must use
NOTE: MOPAR® SAE 5W-30 engine oil approved to SAE 5W-20 oil. Failure to do so may result in improper
Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 such as Pennzoil®, operation of the Fuel Saver Technology. Refer to “Fuel
Shell Helix® or equivalent may be used when SAE 5W-20 Saver Technology – If Equipped” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
engine oil meeting MS-6395 is not available.
Lubricants that do not have both, the engine oil certification mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade number
should not be used.
7
488 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
environment. Contact your authorized dealer, service
station or governmental agency for advice on how and
You may use synthetic engine oils provided the recomwhere used oil and oil filters can be safely discarded in
mended oil quality requirements are met, and the recomyour area.
mended maintenance intervals for oil and filter changes
are followed.
Engine Oil Filter
Synthetic Engine Oils
The engine oil filter should be replaced with a new filter
The manufacturer strongly recommends against the ad- at every engine oil change.
dition of any additives (other than leak detection dyes) to Engine Oil Filter Selection
the engine oil. Engine oil is an engineered product and its
This manufacturer’s engines have a full-flow type oil
performance may be impaired by supplemental addifilter. Use a filter of this type for replacement. The quality
tives.
of replacement filters varies considerably. Only high
Disposing Of Used Engine Oil And Oil Filters
quality filters should be used to assure most efficient
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil and service. MOPAR® engine oil filters are a high quality oil
oil filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil filters, filter and are recommended.
Materials Added To Engine Oil
indiscriminately discarded, can present a problem to the
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 489
Engine Air Cleaner Filter
Engine Air Cleaner Filter Selection
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper The quality of replacement engine air cleaner filters
maintenance intervals.
varies considerably. Only high quality filters should be
used to assure most efficient service. MOPAR® engine air
cleaner filters are a high quality filter and are recomWARNING!
mended.
The air induction system (air cleaner, hoses, etc.) can
provide a measure of protection in the case of engine Maintenance-Free Battery
backfire. Do not remove the air induction system (air Your vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free battery.
cleaner, hoses, etc.) unless such removal is necessary You will never have to add water, nor is periodic mainfor repair or maintenance. Make sure that no one is tenance required.
near the engine compartment before starting the
vehicle with the air induction system (air cleaner,
hoses, etc.) removed. Failure to do so can result in
serious personal injury.
7
490 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The battery is stored under an access cover in
the trunk. Remote battery terminals are located in the
engine compartment for jump starting. Refer to “JumpStarting Procedures” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
Battery Location
WARNING!
• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can
burn or even blind you. Do not allow battery fluid
to contact your eyes, skin, or clothing. Do not lean
over a battery when attaching clamps. If acid
splashes in eyes or on skin, flush the area immediately with large amounts of water.
• Battery gas is flammable and explosive. Keep
flame or sparks away from the battery. Do not use
a booster battery or any other booster source with
an output greater than 12 Volts. Do not allow cable
clamps to touch each other.
• Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands
after handling.
• The battery in this vehicle has a vent hose that
should not be disconnected and should only be
replaced with a battery of the same type (vented).
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 491
CAUTION!
• It is essential when replacing the cables on the
battery that the positive cable is attached to the
positive post and the negative cable is attached to the
negative post. Battery posts are marked positive (+)
and negative (-) and are identified on the battery
case. Cable clamps should be tight on the terminal
posts and free of corrosion.
• If a “fast charger” is used while the battery is in the
vehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables before connecting the charger to the battery. Do not
use a “fast charger” to provide starting voltage.
Air Conditioner Maintenance
For best possible performance, your air conditioner should
be checked and serviced by an authorized dealer at the start
of each warm season. This service should include cleaning of
the condenser fins and a performance test. Drive belt tension
should also be checked at this time.
WARNING!
• Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricants
approved by the manufacturer for your air conditioning system. Some unapproved refrigerants are
flammable and can explode, injuring you. Other
unapproved refrigerants or lubricants can cause the
system to fail, requiring costly repairs. Refer to
Warranty Information Book, located on the DVD,
for further warranty information.
• The air conditioning system contains refrigerant
under high pressure. To avoid risk of personal
injury or damage to the system, adding refrigerant
or any repair requiring lines to be disconnected
should be done by an experienced technician.
7
492 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your air conditioning
system as the chemicals can damage your air conditioning components. Such damage is not covered by
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling R134a — If
Equipped
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling HFO 1234yf
— If Equipped
HFO 1234yf Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product
with a low GWP (Global Warming Potential). However,
the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning service be performed by authorized dealer or other service
facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
R-134a Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system
Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product. How- PAG compressor oil and refrigerants.
ever, the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning
service be performed by authorized dealer or other
service facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system
PAG compressor oil and refrigerants.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 493
A/C Air Filter
The filter is located in the fresh air inlet under the hood,
behind a removable panel in the cowl on the passenger
side of the vehicle, next to the windshield wipers. When
installing a new filter, ensure its proper orientation.
1. Remove the access door in the cowl screen by pressing
the retaining clips.
7
Access Door
2. Unsnap both ends and lift the filter access cover.
494 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Filter Access Cover
3. Remove the used filter.
A/C Air Filter
5. Close the filter access cover.
4. Install the new filter with arrows pointing in the Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
direction of airflow, which is toward the rear of the maintenance intervals.
vehicle (text and arrows on the filter will indicate this).
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 495
Body Lubrication
Windshield Wiper Blades
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as
seat tracks, door hinge pivot points and rollers, liftgate,
tailgate, decklid, sliding doors and hood hinges, should
be lubricated periodically with a lithium based grease,
such as MOPAR® Spray White Lube to assure quiet, easy
operation and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to
the application of any lubricant, the parts concerned
should be wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after
lubricating excess oil and grease should be removed.
Particular attention should also be given to hood latching
components to ensure proper function. When performing
other underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.
Clean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the
windshield periodically with a sponge or soft cloth and a
mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will remove accumulations of salt or road film.
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods
may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use
washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt
from a dry windshield.
Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from
the windshield. Keep the blade rubber out of contact with
petroleum products such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.
NOTE: Life expectancy of wiper blades varies depending
on
geographical area and frequency of use. Poor perforThe external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a
mance
of blades may be present with chattering, marks,
year, preferably in the Fall and Spring. Apply a small
water
lines
or wet spots. If any of these conditions are
amount of a high quality lubricant, such as MOPAR®
present,
clean
the wiper blades or replace as necessary.
Lock Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.
7
496 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Adding Washer Fluid
The windshield washer fluid reservoir is located in the
front of the engine compartment. Be sure to check the
fluid level at regular intervals. Fill the reservoir with
windshield washer solvent (not radiator antifreeze) and
operate the system for a few seconds to flush out the
residual water.
WARNING!
Commercially available windshield washer solvents
are flammable. They could ignite and burn you. Care
must be exercised when filling or working around
the washer solution.
Exhaust System
When refilling the washer fluid reservoir, apply some
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
washer fluid to a cloth or towel and wipe the wiper
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
blades clean. This will help blade performance.
system.
To prevent freeze-up of your windshield washer system in
If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system;
cold weather, select a solution or mixture that meets or
or if the exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle;
exceeds the temperature range of your climate. This rating
or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged;
information can be found on most washer fluid containers.
have an authorized technician inspect the complete exThe fluid reservoir will hold nearly 1 gal (4 L) of washer haust system and adjacent body areas for broken, damfluid when the message “Low Washer Fluid” appears in aged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams
the Driver Information Display (DID).
or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 497
into the passenger compartment. In addition, have the
exhaust system inspected each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
WARNING!
• Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain
carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and
odorless. Breathing it can make you unconscious
and can eventually poison you. To avoid breathing
CO, refer to “Safety Tips/Exhaust Gas” in “Things
To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further
information.
• A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park
over materials that can burn. Such materials might
be grass or leaves coming into contact with your
exhaust system. Do not park or operate your vehicle in areas where your exhaust system can contact anything that can burn.
CAUTION!
• The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel only. Leaded gasoline will destroy the
effectiveness of the catalyst as an emissions control
device and may seriously reduce engine performance and cause serious damage to the engine.
• Damage to the catalytic converter can result if your
vehicle is not kept in proper operating condition.
In the event of engine malfunction, particularly
involving engine misfire or other apparent loss of
performance, have your vehicle serviced promptly.
Continued operation of your vehicle with a severe
malfunction could cause the converter to overheat,
resulting in possible damage to the converter and
vehicle.
7
498 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic con- To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter damverter will not require maintenance. However, it is im- age:
portant to keep the engine properly tuned to assure • Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition,
proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst
when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in
damage.
motion.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control • Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the
systems can result in civil penalties being assessed
vehicle.
against you.
• Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires
In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning
disconnected or removed, such as when diagnostic
engine operation, a scorching odor may suggest severe
testing, or for prolonged periods during very rough
and abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, stop
idle or malfunctioning operating conditions.
the vehicle, turn off the engine and allow it to cool.
Service, including a tune-up to manufacturer’s specifications, should be obtained immediately.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 499
Coolant Checks
Cooling System
WARNING!
• When working near the radiator cooling fan, disconnect the fan motor lead or cycle the ignition
switch to the LOCK position. The fan is temperature controlled and can start at any time the ignition switch is in the ON position.
• You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had
time to cool. Never try to open a cooling system
pressure cap when the radiator is hot.
Check engine coolant (antifreeze) protection every 12
months (before the onset of freezing weather, where
applicable). If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty, the
system should be drained, flushed, and refilled with
fresh OAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032) only according to Chrysler Service Manual procedure or by an
authorized dealer. Check the front of the radiator for any
accumulation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean by gently
spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the
face of the condenser.
Check the coolant recovery bottle tubing for brittle rubber, cracking, tears, cuts, and tightness of the connection
at the bottle and radiator. Inspect the entire system for
leaks.
7
500 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
With the engine at normal operating temperature (but
not running), check the cooling system pressure cap for
proper vacuum sealing by draining a small amount of
engine coolant (antifreeze) from the radiator drain cock.
If the cap is sealing properly, the engine coolant (antifreeze) will begin to drain from the coolant recovery
bottle. DO NOT REMOVE THE COOLANT PRESSURE
CAP WHEN THE COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT.
Cooling System — Drain, Flush And Refill
NOTE: Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant
properly. Failure to fill these systems properly could lead
to severe internal engine damage. If any coolant is
needed to be added to the system please contact your
local authorized dealer.
If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or contains
visible sediment, have an authorized dealer clean and
flush with OAT coolant (antifreeze) (conforming to
MS.90032).
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
Selection Of Coolant
Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
CAUTION!
• Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze), may result in engine
damage and may decrease corrosion protection.
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant is different and should not be mixed with
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology (HOAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) or any “globally compatible” coolant (antifreeze). If a non-OAT engine
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 501
CAUTION! (Continued)
coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the cooling
system in an emergency, the cooling system will
need to be drained, flushed, and refilled with fresh
OAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032), by an authorized dealer as soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine
coolant (antifreeze) products. Do not use additional
rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not
be compatible with the radiator engine coolant and
may plug the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze).
Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
Adding Coolant
Your vehicle has been built with an improved engine
coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS.90032) that allows extended maintenance intervals. This engine coolant (antifreeze) can be used up to ten years or
150,000 miles (240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent reducing this extended maintenance period, it is
important that you use the same engine coolant (OAT
coolant conforming to MS.90032) throughout the life of
your vehicle.
Please review these recommendations for using Organic
Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze)
that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS.90032. When adding engine coolant (antifreeze):
• We recommend using MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant
10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive
Technology) that meets the requirements of Chrysler
Material Standard MS.90032.
7
502 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT engine coolant NOTE:
that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Stan• Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant
dard MS.90032 and distilled water. Use higher concenproperly. Failure to fill these systems properly could
trations (not to exceed 70%) if temperatures below
lead to severe internal engine damage. If any coolant is
−34° F (−37° C) are anticipated.
needed to be added to the system please contact your
local authorized dealer.
• Use only high purity water such as distilled or deionized water when mixing the water/engine coolant
• Mixing engine coolant (antifreeze) types is not recom(antifreeze) solution. The use of lower quality water
mended and can result in cooling system damage. If
will reduce the amount of corrosion protection in the
HOAT and OAT coolant are mixed in an emergency,
engine cooling system.
have a authorized dealer drain, flush, and refill with
Please note that it is the owner’s responsibility to mainOAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032) as soon as
possible.
tain the proper level of protection against freezing according to the temperatures occurring in the area where
the vehicle is operated.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 503
Cooling System Pressure Cap
WARNING! (Continued)
The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of engine
coolant (antifreeze), and to ensure that engine coolant
(antifreeze) will return to the radiator from the coolant
recovery tank.
• Do not use a pressure cap other than the one
specified for your vehicle. Personal injury or engine damage may result.
The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any Disposal Of Used Engine Coolant
accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces. Used ethylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is
a regulated substance requiring proper disposal. Check
with your local authorities to determine the disposal
WARNING!
rules for your community. To prevent ingestion by ani• Do not open hot engine cooling system. Never add mals or children, do not store ethylene glycol-based
engine coolant (antifreeze) when the engine is engine coolant in open containers or allow it to remain in
overheated. Do not loosen or remove the cap to cool puddles on the ground. If ingested by a child or pet, seek
an overheated engine. Heat causes pressure to emergency assistance immediately. Clean up any ground
build up in the cooling system. To prevent scalding spills immediately.
or injury, do not remove the pressure cap while the
system is hot or under pressure.
(Continued)
7
504 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Coolant Level
The coolant bottle provides a quick visual method for
determining that the coolant level is adequate. With the
engine OFF and cold, the level of the engine coolant
(antifreeze) in the bottle should be between the ranges
indicated on the bottle.
Points To Remember
NOTE: When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles/
kilometers of operation, you may observe vapor coming
from the front of the engine compartment. This is normally a result of moisture from rain, snow, or high
humidity accumulating on the radiator and being vaporized when the thermostat opens, allowing hot engine
The radiator normally remains completely full, so there is
no need to remove the radiator/coolant pressure cap coolant (antifreeze) to enter the radiator.
unless checking for engine coolant (antifreeze) freeze If an examination of your engine compartment shows no
point or replacing coolant. Advise your service attendant evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the vehicle may be
of this. As long as the engine operating temperature is safely driven. The vapor will soon dissipate.
satisfactory, the coolant bottle need only be checked once • Do not overfill the coolant expansion bottle.
a month.
• Check the coolant freeze point in the radiator and in the
When additional engine coolant (antifreeze) is needed to
coolant expansion bottle. If engine coolant (antifreeze)
maintain the proper level, only OAT coolant that meets
needs to be added, the contents of the coolant expansion
the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS.90032
bottle must also be protected against freezing.
should be added to the coolant bottle. Do not overfill.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 505
• If frequent engine coolant (antifreeze) additions are Brake System
required, the cooling system should be pressure tested In order to assure brake system performance, all brake
for leaks.
system components should be inspected periodically.
• Maintain engine coolant (antifreeze) concentration at a Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
minimum of 50% OAT coolant (conforming to maintenance intervals.
MS.90032) and distilled water for proper corrosion
protection of your engine which contains aluminum
WARNING!
components.
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and
• Make sure that the coolant expansion bottle overflow possibly a collision. Driving with your foot resting or
hoses are not kinked or obstructed.
riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally
• Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle is high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and
equipped with air conditioning, keep the front of the possible brake damage. You would not have your full
braking capacity in an emergency.
condenser clean.
• Do not change the thermostat for Summer or Winter
operation. If replacement is ever necessary, install ONLY
the correct type thermostat. Other designs may result in
unsatisfactory engine coolant (antifreeze) performance,
poor gas mileage, and increased emissions.
7
506 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in “MainCheck the fluid level in the master cylinder immediately if
taining Your Vehicle” for further information.
the brake system warning light indicates system failure.
Master Cylinder — Brake Fluid Level Check
Check the fluid level in the master cylinder when performing underhood services.
Clean the top of the master cylinder area before removing
the cap. Add fluid to bring the level up to the top of the
“FULL” mark on the side of the master cylinder reservoir.
Overfilling of fluid is not recommended because it may
cause leaking in the system.
Add enough fluid to bring the level up to the requirements described on the brake fluid reservoir. With disc
brakes, fluid level can be expected to fall as the brake
pads wear. However, low fluid level may be caused by a
leak and a checkup may be needed.
WARNING!
• Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine
Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further
information. Using the wrong type of brake fluid
can severely damage your brake system and/or
impair its performance. The proper type of brake
fluid for your vehicle is also identified on the
original factory installed hydraulic master cylinder
reservoir.
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 507
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• To avoid contamination from foreign matter or
moisture, use only new brake fluid or fluid that has
been in a tightly closed container. Keep the master
cylinder reservoir cap secured at all times. Brake
fluid in a open container absorbs moisture from the
air resulting in a lower boiling point. This may
cause it to boil unexpectedly during hard or prolonged braking, resulting in sudden brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
• Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in
spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts, causing
the brake fluid to catch fire. Brake fluid can also
damage painted and vinyl surfaces, care should be
taken to avoid its contact with these surfaces.
• Do not allow petroleum based fluid to contaminate
the brake fluid. Brake seal components could be
damaged, causing partial or complete brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
(Continued)
Use only brake fluid that has been in a tightly closed
container to avoid contamination from foreign matter or
moisture.
7
508 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Automatic Transmission
Special Additives
Selection Of Lubricant
The manufacturer strongly recommends against using
any special additives in the transmission.
It is important to use the proper transmission fluid to
ensure optimum transmission performance and life. Use
only the manufacturer’s specified transmission fluid. Refer
to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in this section
for fluid specifications. It is important to maintain the
transmission fluid at the correct level using the recommended fluid. No chemical flushes should be used in any
transmission; only the approved lubricant should be used.
Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is an engineered
product and its performance may be impaired by supplemental additives. Therefore, do not add any fluid additives to the transmission. The only exception to this
policy is the use of special dyes for diagnosing fluid
leaks. Avoid using transmission sealers as they may
adversely affect seals.
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
Using a transmission fluid other than the manufacturer’s recommended fluid may cause deterioration
in transmission shift quality and/or torque converter
shudder. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine
Parts” in this section for fluid specifications.
Do not use chemical flushes in your transmission as
the chemicals can damage your transmission components. Such damage is not covered by the New
Vehicle Limited Warranty.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 509
Fluid Level Check
Fluid And Filter Changes
The fluid level is preset at the factory and does not require
adjustment under normal operating conditions. Routine
fluid level checks are not required, therefore the transmission has no dipstick. Your authorized dealer can check your
transmission fluid level using special service tools.
Under normal operating conditions, the fluid installed at
the factory will provide satisfactory lubrication for the
life of the vehicle.
Routine fluid and filter changes are not required. However, change the fluid and filter if the fluid becomes
If you notice fluid leakage or transmission malfunction, contaminated (with water, etc.), or if the transmission is
visit your authorized dealer immediately to have the disassembled for any reason.
transmission fluid level checked. Operating the vehicle All Wheel Drive (AWD) — If Equipped
with an improper fluid level can cause severe transmisThe all wheel drive system consists of a transfer case and
sion damage.
front differential. The exterior surface of these components should be inspected for evidence of fluid leaks.
CAUTION!
Confirmed leaks should be repaired as soon as possible.
If a transmission fluid leak occurs, visit your autho- The transfer case fluid fill/inspection plug is located in the
rized dealer immediately. Severe transmission dam- middle of the rear housing. To inspect the transfer case
age may occur. Your authorized dealer has the proper fluid level, remove the fill/inspection plug. The fluid level
tools to adjust the fluid level accurately.
should be even with the bottom of the hole. Use this plug
to add fluid as required.
7
510 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
The front differential fill plug is located on the outer cover
near the halfshaft attachment. To inspect the differential
fluid level, remove the fill plug. The fluid level should be
even with or slightly below the bottom of the hole.
Fluid Changes
Fluid Level Check
Check the fluid level by removing the fill plug on the
axle. The fluid level should be at the bottom of the fill
hole. Add fluid, if necessary, to maintain the proper level.
Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
Change Axle Fluid
Rear Axle
For normal service, periodic fluid level checks are not
required. When the vehicle is serviced for other reasons the
exterior surfaces of the axle assembly should be inspected.
If gear oil leakage is suspected inspect the fluid level. Refer
to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in “Maintaining
Your Vehicle” for further information.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 511
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion
What Causes Corrosion?
Protection Of Body And Paint From Corrosion
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of
paint and protective coatings from your vehicle.
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geographic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads
passable in snow and ice, and chemicals that are sprayed
on trees and road surfaces during other seasons, are
highly corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside
parking, which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants, road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated,
extreme hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and
underbody protection.
The most common causes are:
• Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.
• Stone and gravel impact.
• Insects, tree sap and tar.
• Salt in the air near seacoast localities.
• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.
Washing
The following maintenance recommendations will enable • Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your veyou to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion
hicle in the shade using MOPAR® Car Wash, or a mild
resistance built into your vehicle.
car wash soap, and rinse the panels completely with
clear water.
7
512 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have accumu- Special Care
lated on your vehicle, use MOPAR® Super Kleen Bug • If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive
and Tar Remover to remove.
near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once
a month.
• Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as MOPAR®
Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to protect • It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges
your paint finish. Take care never to scratch the paint.
of the doors, rocker panels, and trunk be kept clear and
open.
• Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing that
may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint finish.
• If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint,
touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is
CAUTION!
considered the responsibility of the owner.
• Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials
such as steel wool or scouring powder that will
scratch metal and painted surfaces.
• Use of power washers exceeding 1,200 psi
(8 274 kPa) can result in damage or removal of paint
and decals.
• If your vehicle is damaged due to a collision or similar
cause that destroys the paint and protective coating,
have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible. The
cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of
the owner.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 513
• If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers, NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with Dark Vapor or
de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well Black Satin Chrome wheels DO NOT USE wheel cleaners,
abrasives or polishing compounds. They will permapackaged and sealed.
nently damage this finish and such damage is not cov• If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider
ered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. USE ONLY
mud or stone shields behind each wheel.
MILD SOAP AND WATER WITH A SOFT CLOTH. Used
• Use MOPAR® Touch Up Paint on scratches as soon as on a regular basis this is all that is required to maintain
possible. Your authorized dealer has touch up paint to this finish.
match the color of your vehicle.
Wheel And Wheel Trim Care
• All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and
chrome plated wheels, should be cleaned regularly
with a mild soap and water to prevent corrosion.
• To remove heavy soil and/or excessive brake dust, use
MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner.
CAUTION!
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristle brush,
or metal polishes. Do not use oven cleaner. These
products may damage the wheel’s protective finish.
Avoid automatic car washes that use acidic solutions
or harsh brushes that may damage the wheel’s protective finish. Only MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner or
equivalent is recommended.
7
514 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Stain Repel Fabric Cleaning Procedure — If
Equipped
Interior Care
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean fabric upholstery and
Stain Repel seats may be cleaned in the following man- carpeting.
ner:
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean vinyl upholstery.
• Remove as much of the stain as possible by blotting
MOPAR® Total Clean is specifically recommended for
with a clean, dry towel.
leather upholstery.
• Blot any remaining stain with a clean, damp towel.
Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular
• For tough stains, apply MOPAR® Total Clean, or a cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt
mild soap solution to a clean, damp cloth and remove can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery
stain. Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue. and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth.
Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth
• For grease stains, apply MOPAR® Multi-Purpose
and MOPAR® Total Clean. Care should be taken to avoid
Cleaner to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use
soaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Please
a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
do not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, deter• Do not use any harsh solvents or any other form of gents, or ammonia-based cleaners to clean your leather
protectants on Stain Repel products.
upholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is not
required to maintain the original condition.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 515
WARNING!
Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.
Many are potentially flammable, and if used in
closed areas they may cause respiratory harm.
CAUTION!
Do not use Alcohol and Alcohol-based and/or Keton
based cleaning products to clean leather seats, as
damage to the seat may result.
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and
reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To
remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution followed by rinsing.
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel
wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.
Glass Surfaces
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis with
MOPAR® Glass Cleaner, or any commercial householdtype glass cleaner. Never use an abrasive type cleaner. Use
caution when cleaning the inside rear window equipped
Cleaning Headlights
with electric defrosters or windows equipped with radio
Your vehicle is equipped with plastic headlights and fog antennas. Do not use scrapers or other sharp instrument
lights that are lighter and less susceptible to stone break- that may scratch the elements.
age than glass headlights.
When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on the
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore towel or rag that you are using. Do not spray cleaner
different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
directly on the mirror.
7
516 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the
The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are buckles do not work properly.
molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care
WARNING!
must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.
1. Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may be A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision and
used, but do not use high alcohol content or abrasive leave you with no protection. Inspect the belt system
periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or loose parts.
cleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damp
Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do
rag.
not disassemble or modify the system. Seat belt
2. Dry with a soft cloth.
assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they
have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor, torn webSeat Belt Maintenance
bing, etc.).
Do not bleach, dye, or clean the belts with chemical
solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric. Cleaning The Center Console Cupholders
Sun damage can also weaken the fabric.
Clean with a damp cloth or towel using a mild detergent
If the belts need cleaning, use MOPAR® Total Clean, a mild with the cupholder in the center console.
soap solution, or lukewarm water. Do not remove the belts
NOTE: The cupholder cannot be removed.
from the vehicle to wash them. Dry with a soft cloth.
Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 517
FUSES
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
• When replacing a blown fuse, always use an appropriate replacement fuse with the same amp rating as
the original fuse. Never replace a fuse with another
fuse of higher amp rating. Never replace a blown
fuse with metal wires or any other material. Failure
to use proper fuses may result in serious personal
injury, fire and/or property damage.
• Before replacing a fuse, make sure that the ignition
is off and that all the other services are switched off
and/or disengaged.
• If the replaced fuse blows again, contact an authorized dealer.
• If a general protection fuse for safety systems (air
bag system, braking system), power unit systems
(engine system, gearbox system) or steering system
blows, contact an authorized dealer.
7
(Continued)
518 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Front Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
The Front Power Distribution Center is located in the
engine compartment. This module contains fuses and
relays.
Front Power Distribution Center
CAUTION!
• When installing the power distribution center
cover, it is important to ensure the cover is properly
positioned and fully latched. Failure to do so may
allow water to get into the power distribution
center and possibly result in an electrical system
failure.
• When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use
only a fuse having the correct amperage rating. The
use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may
result in a dangerous electrical system overload. If
a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates
a problem in the circuit that must be corrected.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 519
Cavity
1
2
3
Cartridge Fuse
–
40 Amp Green
50 Amp Red
Mini-Fuse
–
–
–
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
30 Amp Pink
40 Amp Green
30 Amp Pink
–
20 Amp Blue
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
20 Amp Yellow
10 Amp Red
11
12
13
–
–
–
20 Amp Yellow
10 Amp Red
–
Description
Fuse – Spare
Radiator Fan #1 – If Equipped
Power Steering #1 / Radiator Fan
(6.2L Supercharged) – If Equipped
Starter
Electronic Stability Control
Electronic Stability Control
Fuse – Spare
Police Ignition Run / ACC # 2
All-Wheel Drive Module – If Equipped
Security – If Equipped / Under hood
Lamp – Police
Horns
Air Conditioning Clutch
Fuse – Spare
7
520 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
14
15
16
18
19
Cartridge Fuse
–
–
–
40 Amp Green
50 Amp Red
Mini-Fuse
–
20 Amp Yellow
20 Amp Yellow
–
–
20
21
30 Amp Pink
30 Amp Pink
–
–
22
40 Amp Green / 20 Amp
Blue – Police
–
23
24
28
30 Amp Pink
20 Amp Blue
–
–
–
–
Description
Fuse – Spare
Left HID – If Equipped
Right HID – If Equipped
Radiator Fan #2 – If Equipped
Power Steering #2 / Radiator Fan
(6.2L Supercharged)
Wiper Motor
Headlamp Washers – If Equipped /
Police Feed
Engine Cooling Pump (6.2L Supercharged) / Police Bat Feed # 3 –
If Equipped
Police Bat Feed # 1 – If Equipped
Police Bat Feed # 3 – If Equipped
Fuse – Spare
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 521
Cavity
29
Cartridge Fuse
–
Mini-Fuse
15 Amp Blue
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
25 Amp Clear
–
–
25 Amp Clear
20 Amp Yellow
10 Amp Red
10 Amp Red
38
39
–
–
10 Amp Red
10 Amp Red
Description
Transmission Control Module
(LA/LD Police)
Fuse – Spare
Engine Module
Fuse – Spare
Fuse – Spare
Powertrain #1
Powertrain #2
Anti-Lock Brake Module
Engine Controller/Rad Fan Relays –
If Equipped
Airbag Module
Power Steering Module/AC Clutch
Relay
7
522 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
48
Cartridge Fuse
–
Mini-Fuse
10 Amp Red
49
50
51
52
53
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
20 Amp Yellow
10 Amp Red
–
Description
AWD Module/Front Axle Disconnect
(LX) / Adaptive Cruise (LA) – If
Equipped
Fuse – Spare
Fuse – Spare
Vacuum Pump
Adaptive Cruise (LD/LX) – If Equipped
Fuse – Spare
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 523
Rear Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
There is also a power distribution center located in the
trunk under the spare tire access panel. This center
contains fuses and relays.
7
Rear Power Distribution Center
CAUTION!
Opening The Access Cover
• When installing the power distribution center cover,
it is important to ensure the cover is properly positioned and fully latched. Failure to do so may allow
(Continued)
524 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
water to get into the power distribution center and
possibly result in an electrical system failure.
• When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use
only a fuse having the correct amperage rating. The
use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may
result in a dangerous electrical system overload. If
a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates
a problem in the circuit that must be corrected.
Cavity
2
3
4
5
6
Cartridge Fuse
60 Amp Yellow
—
60 Amp Yellow
30 Amp Pink
40 Amp Green
Mini-Fuse
—
—
—
—
—
Description
Front PDC Feed #1
Fuse – Spare
Front PDC Feed #2
Sunroof / Dome Lamp – Police
Exterior Lighting #1
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 525
Cavity
7
8
9
10
11
12
Cartridge Fuse
40 Amp Green
30 Amp Pink
40 Amp Green
30 Amp Pink
30 Amp Pink
—
Mini-Fuse
—
—
—
—
—
20 Amp Yellow
15
16
17
18
19
20
40 Amp Green
20 Amp Blue
—
30 Amp Pink
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Description
Exterior Lighting #2
Interior Lighting
Power Locks
Driver Door Control Module
Passenger Door Control Module
Dual USB Center Console Rear/Cigar
Lighter IP – If Equipped
HVAC Blower
Left Spot Lamp – Police
Fuse – Spare
Mod Network Interface – Police
Fuse — Spare
Fuse — Spare
7
526 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
21
22
Cartridge Fuse
30 Amp Pink
(6.2L Supercharged)
25 Amp Clear (LD STD)
—
23
24
25
26
—
—
—
—
27
31
32
—
—
—
Mini-Fuse
—
20 Amp Yellow – Police
10 Amp Red – LA
10 Amp Red
15 Amp Blue
10 Amp Red
15 Amp Blue – LD/LX
25 Amp Clear – LA
30 Amp Green – LA 6.2L
Supercharged
25 Amp Clear
25 Amp Breaker
15 Amp Blue
Description
Fuel Pump (6.2L Supercharged)
Fuel Pump (LD STD)
Right Spot Lamp – Police
Integrated Center Stack – LA
Fuel Door/Diagnostic Port
Integrated Center Stack – LD/LX
Tire Pressure Monitor
Transmission / Electronic Shift Module
(LD/LX)
Fuel Pump (LA)
Fuel Pump (LA 6.2L Supercharged)
Amplifier – If Equipped
Power Seats
HVAC Module/Cluster
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 527
Cavity
33
Cartridge Fuse
—
Mini-Fuse
15 Amp Blue
34
—
10 Amp Red
35
36
37
38
—
—
—
—
5 Amp Tan
15 Amp Blue
20 Amp Yellow
15 Amp Blue – LD/LX
20 Amp Yellow – LA
40
41
42
43
—
—
30 Amp Pink
—
—
—
—
20 Amp Yellow
Description
Ignition Switch/RF hub Module/
Steering Column Lock-LX If Equipped
Steering Column Module/Clock/
Spare – Police
Battery Sensor
Electronic Exhaust Valve – If Equipped
Radio
Console Power Outlet/Console Media
Hub (LD/LX)
Power Outlet Inside Arm Rest (LA)
Fuse — Spare
Fuse — Spare
Rear Defrost
Rear Heated Seats/Steering Wheel
Module
7
528 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
44
Cartridge Fuse
—
Mini-Fuse
10 Amp Red
45
—
15 Amp Blue
46
47
—
—
—
10 Amp Red
48
49
50
51
52
—
—
—
—
—
20 Amp Yellow
—
—
20 Amp Yellow
10 Amp Red
Description
Park Assist / Blind Spot / Rear View
Camera
Cluster / Rearview Mirror / Compass
(LDLX)/Humidity Sensor
Fuse — Spare
Adaptive Front Lighting / Auto High
BEAM / Day Time Running Lamps- If
Equipped
Active Suspension – SRT
Fuse — Spare
Fuse — Spare
Front Heated Seats – If Equipped
Heated Cupholders/Rear Heated Seat
Switches – If Equipped
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 529
Cavity
53
Cartridge Fuse
—
Mini-Fuse
10 Amp Red
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
10 Amp Red
—
—
—
10 Amp Red
20 Amp Yellow
5 Amp Tan
20 Amp Yellow
—
—
25 Amp Breaker
10 Amp Red
—
Description
HVAC Module/In Car Temperature
Sensor
Airbag Module (LA)
Fuse — Spare
Fuse — Spare
Fuse — Spare
Airbag Module (LD/LX)
Adjustable Pedals – Police
Heated Washer Nozzles (LD)
Cigar Lighter (LA) – If Equipped
Fuse — Spare
Fuse — Spare
Rear Windows (LD/LX)
Airbag Module
Fuse — Spare
7
530 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
67
68
Cartridge Fuse
—
—
Mini-Fuse
10 Amp Red
10 Amp Red
69
70
—
—
—
—
VEHICLE STORAGE
If you are leaving your vehicle dormant for more than 21
days, you may want to take these steps to protect your
battery.
• Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
Description
Rain and Light Sensor/Sunroof
Dual USB Power Outlet – R/A Sense
(LD/LX) Rear Sunshade (LD/LX)
Fuse — Spare
Fuse — Spare
in the fresh air and high blower setting. This will
ensure adequate system lubrication to minimize the
possibility of compressor damage when the system is
started again.
REPLACEMENT BULBS
• Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of All of the interior bulbs are glass wedge base or glass
service (e.g., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the cartridge types. Aluminum base bulbs are not approved
air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes and should not be used for replacement.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 531
Interior Bulbs
Bulb Number
Rear Courtesy/Reading Lamps
W5W
Rear Compartment (Trunk) Lamp
562
Overhead Console Reading Lamps
578
Visor Vanity Lamps
A6220
Glove Box Lamp – If Equipped
194
Door Courtesy
562
Shift Indicator Lamp
JKLE14140
Optional Door Map Pocket/Cupholder
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
For lighted switches, see your authorized dealer for replacement instructions.
7
532 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Exterior Bulbs
Low Beam/High Beam (Bi-Halogen Headlamp)
Low Beam/High Beam (Bi-Xenon Headlamp)
Front Turn Signal Lamp
Front Park Lamp
Daytime Running Lamp
Front Fog Lamp – If Equipped
Front Sidemarker Lamp
Rear Tail/Stop/Turn Lamp
Rear Sidemarker Lamp
Backup Lamp
Center High Mount Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
License
Rear Fog Lamp – If Equipped
Bulb Number
HIR2LL
D3S (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
PSY24WSV
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 533
BULB REPLACEMENT
NOTE: Lens fogging can occur under certain atmospheric conditions. This will usually clear as atmospheric
conditions change to allow the condensation to change
back into a vapor. Turning the lamps on will usually
accelerate the clearing process.
WARNING!
A transient high voltage occurs at the bulb sockets of
HID headlamps when the headlamp switch is turned
ON. It may cause serious electrical shock or electrocution if not serviced properly. See your authorized
dealer for service.
Low Beam And High Beam Headlamp
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with HID headlamps,
when the headlamps are turned on, there is a blue hue to
the lights. This diminishes and becomes more white after
The headlamps are a type of high voltage discharge tube. approximately 10 seconds, as the system charges.
High voltage can remain in the circuit even with the
headlamp switch off and the ignition turned to the OFF
position. Because of this, you should not attempt to
service a headlamp bulb yourself. If a headlamp bulb
fails, take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for
service.
High Intensity Discharge Headlamps (HID) — If
Equipped
7
534 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Standard Low Beam And High Beam Headlamp
1. Open the hood.
NOTE: Removal of the air cleaner filter housing may be
necessary prior to replacing bulbs in the headlamp
assembly on the driver side of the vehicle.
2. Reach behind the headlamp housing to access the
headlamp (outboard) bulb cap.
7. Install the headlamp bulb cap in the headlamp housing and rotate it clockwise to lock it.
CAUTION!
Do not touch the new bulb with your fingers. Oil
contamination will severely shorten bulb life. If the
bulb comes in contact with an oily surface, clean the
bulb with rubbing alcohol.
3. Firmly grasp the cap and rotate it counterclockwise to
Front Turn Signal Lamps
unlock it.
1. Open the hood.
4. Twist the headlamp bulb assembly counterclockwise,
NOTE: Removal of the air cleaner filter housing may be
and then pull it out of the headlamp assembly.
necessary prior to replacing bulbs in the headlamp
5. Disconnect the bulb from the wiring assembly and
assembly on the driver side of the vehicle.
install the replacement bulb.
2. Reach behind the headlamp housing to access the turn
6. Reinstall the bulb and wiring assembly into the headsignal (inboard) bulb cap.
lamp assembly, and then turn it clockwise.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 535
3. Firmly grasp the cap and rotate it counterclockwise to Front/Rear Side Marker Lamp
unlock it.
The Side Markers use LED lamps that are not serviceable
4. Squeeze the two tabs on the side of the bulb socket and separately. The Side Markers must be replaced as an
assembly, see your authorized dealer.
pull straight out from the lamp assembly.
5. Disconnect the bulb from the wiring connector and Rear Backup Lamp And Turn Signal Lamps
install the replacement bulb.
The Rear Backup and Turn Signal Lamp use LED sources
6. Install the bulb and connector assembly straight into that are not serviceable separately. The Rear Lamps must be
replaced as an assembly, please see your authorized dealer.
the lamp until it locks in place.
7. Install the turn signal bulb cap in the headlamp License Lamp
housing and rotate clockwise to lock in place.
The License Lamp uses an LED source that is not
serviceable separately. The License Lamp must be reFront Fog Lamp
placed as an assembly, see your authorized dealer.
The Front Fog Lamps use LED sources that are not
serviceable separately. The Front Fog Lamp must be Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
replaced as an assembly, see your authorized dealer.
The CHMSL Lamp uses LED sources that are not serviceable separately. The CHMSL Lamp must be replaced as
an assembly, see your authorized dealer
7
536 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FLUID CAPACITIES
U.S.
Fuel (Approximate)
All Engines
18.5 Gallons
Engine Oil With Filter
3.6 Liter Engine (SAE 5W-20, API Certified)
6 Quarts
5.7 Liter Engine (SAE 5W-20, API Certified)
7 Quarts
Cooling System *
3.6 Liter Engine – We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/
10 Quarts
Engine Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula or equivalent.
5.7 Liter Engine without Severe Duty II Cooling System – We rec14.5 Quarts
ommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine Coolant 10 Year/
150,000 Mile Formula.
5.7 Liter Engine with Severe Duty II Cooling System – We recom15 Quarts
mend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine Coolant 10 Year/
150,000 Mile Formula.
* Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to MAX level.
Metric
69.9 Liters
5.6 Liters
6.6 Liters
9.5 Liters
13.9 Liters
14.3 Liters
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 537
FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS
Engine
Component
Engine Coolant
Engine Oil – 3.6L Engine
Engine Oil – 5.7L Engine
Engine Oil Filter
Spark Plugs
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/
150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology).
We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-20 Engine Oil, meeting
the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 such as
MOPAR®, Pennzoil®, and Shell Helix®. Refer to your engine oil filler
cap for correct SAE grade.
We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-20 Engine Oil, meeting
the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 such as
MOPAR®, Pennzoil®, and Shell Helix®. Refer to your engine oil filler
cap for correct SAE grade.
MOPAR® Engine Oil Filter or equivalent.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs.
7
538 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Component
Fuel Selection – 3.6L Engine
Fuel Selection – 5.7L Engine
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
87 Octane.
87 Octane Acceptable – 89 Octane Recommended.
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze), may result in engine
damage and may decrease corrosion protection.
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant is different and should not be mixed with
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology (HOAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) or any “globally compatible” coolant (antifreeze). If a non-OAT engine
coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the cooling
system in an emergency, the cooling system will
need to be drained, flushed, and refilled with fresh
OAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032), by an authorized dealer as soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine
coolant (antifreeze) products. Do not use additional
rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not
be compatible with the radiator engine coolant and
may plug the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze).
Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 539
Chassis
Component
Automatic Transmission – 8-Speed
Transmission
Brake Master Cylinder
Front Axle
Rear Axle
Transfer Case
Fluid, Lubricant, Or Genuine Part
Use only MOPAR® ZF 8&9 Speed ATF™ Automatic Transmission Fluid,
or equivalent. Failure to use the correct fluid may affect the function or
performance of your transmission.
We recommend you use MOPAR® DOT 3 and SAE J1703. If DOT 3 brake
fluid is not available, then DOT 4 is acceptable.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Synthetic Gear Lubricant SAE 75W90
(API GL-5).
We recommend you use MOPAR® OD Synthetic Gear Lubricant
SAE 75W85 (API GL-5).
We recommend you use MOPAR® Transfer Case Lubricant for
BorgWarner 44–40.
7
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
CONTENTS
䡵 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . .542
▫ Maintenance Chart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .544
8
542 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
The “Oil Change Required” message will be displayed in
the DID and a single chime will sound, indicating that an
Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic oil change
oil change is necessary.
indicator system. The oil change indicator system will
remind you that it is time to take your vehicle in for Your authorized dealer will reset the oil change indicator
scheduled maintenance.
message after completing the scheduled oil change. If a
scheduled oil change is performed by someone other
Based on engine operation conditions, the oil change
than your authorized dealer, the message can be reset by
indicator message will illuminate. This means that serreferring to the steps described under “Driver Informavice is required for your vehicle. Operating conditions
tion Dispay (DID)” in “Understanding Your Instrument
such as frequent short-trips, trailer tow, extremely hot or
Panel” for further information.
cold ambient temperatures, and E85 fuel usage will
influence when the “Change Oil” or “Oil Change Re- NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change interquired” message is displayed. Severe Operating Condi- vals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve months,
tions can cause the change oil message to illuminate as whichever comes first.
early as 3,500 miles (5,600 km) since last reset. Have your
Severe Duty All Models
vehicle serviced as soon as possible, within the next
500 miles (805 km).
Change Engine Oil at 4000 miles (6,500 km) if the vehicle
is operated in a dusty and off road environment. This
type of vehicle use is considered Severe Duty
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 543
Once A Month Or Before A Long Trip:
• Check engine oil level
• Check windshield washer fluid level
• Check tire pressure and look for unusual wear or
damage. Rotate tires at the first sign of irregular wear,
even if it occurs before your next scheduled service.
• Check the fluid levels of the coolant reservoir, brake
master cylinder, and power steering (If Equipped) and
fill as needed.
• Check function of all interior and exterior lights
Required Maintenance Intervals.
Refer to the maintenance schedules on the following
page for the required maintenance intervals.
At Every Oil Change Interval As Indicated By Oil
Change Indicator System:
• Change oil and filter
• Rotate the tires. Rotate at the first sign of irregular
wear, even if it occurs before your next scheduled
service
• Inspect battery and clean and tighten terminals as
required
• Inspect brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums, hoses
and park brake
• Inspect engine cooling system protection and
hoses
• Inspect exhaust system
• Inspect engine air cleaner if using in dusty or
off-road conditions
8
544 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
Additional Inspections
Inspect the CV joints.
Inspect front suspension, tie rod ends, boot seals,
and replace if necessary.
Inspect the rear axle fluid. Inspect the front axle
fluid (All Wheel Drive Only).
Inspect the brake linings, replace as necessary.
Adjust park brake on vehicles equipped with four
wheel disc brakes.
Inspect transfer case fluid (All Wheel Drive Only).
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first)
32,000
Maintenance Chart
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Additional Maintenance
Replace engine air filter.
Replace cabin/air conditioning filter.
Replace spark plugs (3.6L engine).**
Replace spark plugs (5.7L engine).**
Flush and replace the engine coolant at 10 years
or 150,000 miles (240,000 km) whichever comes
first.
Inspect the transfer case fluid. Change the transfer
case fluid; if using your vehicle for any of the
following: police, taxi, fleet, off-road, or frequent
trailer towing. (All Wheel Drive Only).
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first)
32,000
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 545
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
8
X
X
X
X
X
X
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first)
32,000
546 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
Change the rear axle fluid and on models
equipped with All Wheel Drive (AWD) change the
front axle fluid if using your vehicle for any of the
following: police, taxi, fleet, off-road, or frequent
trailer towing.
Inspect and replace PCV valve if necessary.
** The spark plug change interval is mileage based only,
yearly intervals do not apply.
X
X
X
X
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 547
WARNING!
• You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Do only service work for which you
have the knowledge and the right equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
• Failure to properly inspect and maintain your vehicle could result in a component malfunction and
effect vehicle handling and performance. This
could cause an accident.
8
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
CONTENTS
䡵 SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .551
▫ Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or
Speech Impaired (TDD/TTY) . . . . . . . . . . . . .553
▫ Prepare For The Appointment. . . . . . . . . . . . .551
▫ Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .553
▫ Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .551 䡵 WARRANTY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .554
▫ Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . .551 䡵 MOPAR® PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .555
䡵 IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . .551 䡵 REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS . . . . . . . . . . . .555
▫ Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center. . . . . . .552
▫ Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center . . . . . .552
▫ In Mexico Contact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .553
▫ In The 50 United States And
Washington, D.C.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .555
▫ In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .555
䡵 PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS . . . . . . . . . . . .556
9
550 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
䡵 DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .557
▫ Treadwear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .557
▫ Traction Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .557
▫ Temperature Grades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .558
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 551
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE
Prepare For The Appointment
Be Reasonable With Requests
If you list a number of items and you must have your
vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with
the service advisor and list the items in order of priority.
At many authorized dealers, you may obtain a rental
vehicle at a minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it
is advisable to make these arrangements when you call
for an appointment.
If you are having warranty work done, be sure to have
the right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All
work to be performed may not be covered by the
warranty. Discuss additional charges with the service
manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle’s
service history. This can often provide a clue to the IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE
current problem.
The manufacturer and its authorized dealer are vitally
Prepare A List
interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be happy
Make a written list of your vehicle’s problems or the with our products and services.
specific work you want done. If you’ve had an accident Warranty service must be done by an authorized dealer.
or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the We strongly recommend that you take the vehicle to an
service advisor know.
authorized dealer. They know your vehicle the best, and
are most concerned that you get prompt and high quality
service. The manufacturer’s authorized dealer have the
9
552 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
facilities, factory-trained technicians, special tools, and • Authorized dealer name
the latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
correctly and in a timely manner.
• Vehicle delivery date and mileage
This is why you should always talk to an authorized
dealer service manager first. Most matters can be re- Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center
solved with this process.
P.O. Box 21–8004
• If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004
general manager or owner of the authorized dealer.
Phone: (800) 247–9753
They want to know if you need assistance.
• If an authorized dealer is unable to resolve the con- Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center
cern, you may contact the manufacturer’s customer P.O. Box 1621
center.
Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6
Any communication to the manufacturer’s customer cenPhone: (800) 465–2001 English / (800) 387–9983 French
ter should include the following information:
• Owner’s name and address
• Owner’s telephone number (home and office)
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 553
Mexico, D. F.
Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that require
assistance can use the special needs relay service offered
by Bell Canada. For TTY teletypewriter users, dial 711
and for Voice callers, dial 1-800-855-0511 to connect with
a Bell Relay Service operator.
In Mexico City: 5081-7568
Service Contract
Outside Mexico City: 1-800-505-1300
You may have purchased a service contract for a vehicle
to help protect you from the high cost of unexpected
repairs after the manufacturer’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty expires. The manufacturer stands behind only
the manufacturer’s service contracts. If you purchased a
manufacturer’s service contract, you will receive Plan
Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in the mail
within three weeks of the vehicle delivery date. If you
have any questions about the service contract, call the
manufacturer’s Service Contract National Customer
Hotline at 1-800-521-9922 (Canadian residents, call
(800) 465–2001 English / (800) 387–9983 French).
In Mexico Contact
Av. Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma, 1240
Sante Fe C.P. 05109
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY)
To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the
manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its customer
center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer, who
has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter
(TTY) in the United States, can communicate with the
manufacturer by dialing 1–800–380–CHRY.
9
554 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service
contract that is not the manufacturer’s service contract. It
is not responsible for any service contract other than the
manufacturer’s service contract. If you purchased a service contract that is not a manufacturer’s service contract,
and you require service after the manufacturer’s New
Vehicle Limited Warranty expires, please refer to the
contract documents, and contact the person listed in
those documents.
We appreciate that you have made a major investment
when you purchased the vehicle. An authorized dealer
has also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and
training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with
the ownership experience. You will be pleased with their
sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related
concerns.
WARNING!
Engine exhaust (internal combustion engines only),
some of its constituents, and certain vehicle components contain, or emit, chemicals known to the State
of California to cause cancer and birth defects, or
other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids
contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain, or emit, chemicals known to the
State of California to cause cancer and birth defects,
or other reproductive harm.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
See the Warranty Information Booklet, located on the
DVD, for the terms and provisions of Chrysler Group
LLC warranties applicable to this vehicle and market.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 555
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety
MOPAR® fluids, lubricants, parts, and accessories are Hotline toll free at 1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424– 9153),
or write to: Administraavailable from an authorized dealer. They are recom- or go to http://www.safercar.gov;
tor, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE., West Buildmended for your vehicle in order to help keep the vehicle
ing, Washington, D.C. 20590.
operating at its best.
You can also obtain other information about motor
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.
In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C.
In Canada
MOPAR® PARTS
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect that could cause
a crash or cause injury or death, you should immediately
inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying the manufacturer.
If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you
should contact the Customer Service Department immediately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety
defect to the Canadian government should contact TransIf NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an port Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations and
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in Recalls at 1-800-333-0510 or go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy roadsafety/
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your authorized
dealer, and the manufacturer.
9
556 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
To order the following manuals, you may use either the
website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mastercard, American Express, and Discover orders are accepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call
for an order form.
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with diagrams,
charts and detailed illustrations. These practical manuals
make it easy for students and technicians to find and fix
problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and
features. They show exactly how to find and correct
problems the first time, using step-by-step troubleshootNOTE: A street address is required when ordering
ing and drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests
manuals (no P.O. Boxes).
and a complete list of all tools and equipment.
Service Manuals
Owner’s Manuals
These comprehensive Service Manuals provide the inforThese Owner’s Manuals have been prepared with the
mation that students and professional technicians need in
assistance of service and engineering specialists to acdiagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving, maintainquaint you with specific Chrysler Group LLC vehicles.
ing, servicing, and repairing Chrysler Group LLC veIncluded are starting, operating, emergency and maintehicles. A complete working knowledge of the vehicle,
system, and/or components is written in straightforward nance procedures as well as specifications, capabilities
and safety tips.
language with illustrations, diagrams, and charts.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 557
Call toll free at:
Treadwear
• 1–800–890–4038 (U.S.)
The Treadwear grade is a comparative rating, based on the
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a
tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half times as well
on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative
performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of
their use, however, and may depart significantly from the
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices,
and differences in road characteristics and climate.
• 1–800–387–1143 (Canada)
Or
Visit us on the Worldwide Web at:
• www.techauthority.com
DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES
The following tire grading categories were established by
the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration. The
specific grade rating assigned by the tire’s manufacturer
in each category is shown on the sidewall of the tires on
your vehicle.
All passenger car tires must conform to Federal safety
requirements in addition to these grades.
Traction Grades
The Traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
and C. These grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on
wet pavement, as measured under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete.
A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.
9
558 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
WARNING!
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or
peak traction characteristics.
Temperature Grades
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat, when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of performance, which all
passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test
wheel, than the minimum required by law.
WARNING!
The temperature grade for this tire is established for
a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.
Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause
heat buildup and possible tire failure.
INDEX
10
560 INDEX
About Your Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
ABS (Anti-Lock Brake System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) (Cruise Control) . . .175
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .501
Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .496
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
Adjustable Pedals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Air bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Air Bag
Advance Front Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Air Bag Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Air bag Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Air Bag Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Driver Knee Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Enhanced Accident Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Event Data Recorder (EDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Front Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
If A Deployment Occurs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Knee Impact Bolsters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Maintaining Your Air Bag System . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Side Air Bags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Air bag Deployment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Air bag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Air bag Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Air Cleaner, Engine (Engine Air Cleaner Filter) . . . .489
Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
Air Conditioning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
Air Conditioning Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Air Conditioning, Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Air Pressure, Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
Alarm
Arm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Alarm Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Alarm, Panic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
INDEX 561
Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Alarm System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
All Wheel Drive (AWD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .500
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .503
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Anti-Lock Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Appearance Care. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .511
Arming System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Assist, Hill Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
Auto Down Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Automatic Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Automatic High Beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .310
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
Fluid and Filter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
Fluid Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .508
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .539
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
Special Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .508
Auto Unlock, Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Auto Up Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Axle Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .539
Axle Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .539
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
Keyless Transmitter Replacement (RKE) . . . . . . . .24
Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .490
Remote Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Transmitter Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Belts, Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .495
B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
10
562 INDEX
Radiator (Coolant Pressure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .503
Carbon Monoxide Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Cargo Area Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Cargo Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Cargo (Vehicle Loading) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Car Washes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .511
Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
Certification Label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .409
Changing A Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .455
Chart, Tire Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
Check Engine Light (Malfunction Indicator Light) . .267
Checking Your Vehicle For Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Checks, Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Camera, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 Child Restraints
Booster Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .536
Center Seat LATCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Caps, Filler
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Brake Control System, Electronic
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake, Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Anti-Lock (ABS) . . . . . . . . . .
Fluid Check . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . .
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake/Transmission Interlock . . .
Brightness, Interior Lights . . . . .
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .
Bulbs, Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.373
.539
.369
.372
.372
.373
.506
.506
.369
.267
.353
.158
.530
.101
INDEX 563
Child Seat Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
How To Stow An Unused ALR Seat Belt . . . . . . . .89
Infants And Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Install A LATCH-compatible Child Restraint . . . . .88
Lower Anchors And Tethers For Children . . . . . . .83
Older Children And Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . .79
Seating Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Child Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Clean Air Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
Cleaning
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .513
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Coin Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Cold Weather Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Compact Disc (CD) Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Connector
UCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI)
Console, Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Coolant Pressure Cap (Radiator Cap) .
Cooling System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . .
Coolant Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Disposal of Used Coolant . . . . . . .
Drain, Flush, and Refill . . . . . . . . .
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Points to Remember . . . . . . . . . . .
Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radiator Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . .
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cruise Control (Speed Control). . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.307
.307
.254
.553
.503
.499
.501
.536
.499
.503
.500
.504
.504
.503
.503
.500
.511
.175
10
564 INDEX
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251 Disposal
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .551
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .503
Customer Programmable Features . . . . . . . . . . . . .284 Door Locks
Child-Protection Door Lock — Rear Doors . . . . . .33
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Data Recorder, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Daytime Brightness, Interior Lights. . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Key Fob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Key Fob Emergency Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Dealer Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
Deck Lid, Emergency Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Deck Lid, Power Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 Door Locks, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Defroster, Rear Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260 Driver Information Display
Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
DID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Instrument Cluster Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Delay (Intermittent) Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Diagnostic System, Onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481 Driver Information Display (DID)
Dimmer Switch, Headlight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Driver Information Display (DID) . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Driving
Dipsticks
Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow Standing
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Disabled Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .473
Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
INDEX 565
E-85 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428 Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . .482
Electrical Power Outlets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .480
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
Electric Rear Window Defrost. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Block Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
Electric Remote Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Electronic Brake Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Checking Oil Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .479
Traction Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
Compartment Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .479
Electronic Power Distribution Center (Fuses) . . . . . .518
Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .499
Electronic Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . .170
Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .499
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Emergency Deck Lid Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Emergency, In Case of
Flooded, Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Freeing Vehicle When Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .455
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
Oil Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Oil Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .486
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .473
Oil Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
Emergency Trunk Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
10
566 INDEX
Engine Oil . . . . . . . .
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Engine Oil Disposal .
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267 Flashers
Hazard Warning . . . .
Engine Oil Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Turn Signal . . . . . . .
Engine Oil Viscosity Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Enhanced Accident Response Feature . . . . . . . . . . . .71 Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . . .
Entry System, Illuminated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 Flexible Fuel Vehicles
Cruising Range . . . . .
Ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
Engine Oil . . . . . . . .
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Fuel Requirements . .
Exhaust Gas Caution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Maintenance . . . . . . .
Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Replacement Parts . . .
Exterior Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Starting . . . . . . . . . .
Exterior Lighting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 Flooded Engine Starting
Floor Console . . . . . . . .
Filler Location Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267 Fluid, Brake . . . . . . . . .
Fluid Capacities . . . . . .
Filters
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489 Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . .
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321 Fluid Level Checks . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.430
.430
.428
.431
.431
.430
.349
.254
.539
.536
.101
.510
INDEX 567
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . .
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts
Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Forward Collision Warning . . . . . . .
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Filler Door (Gas Cap) . . . . . . . . .
Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Materials Added . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Methanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.509
.506
.499
.485
.509
.537
.153
.141
.203
.468
.423
.426
.424
.424
.267
.423
.267
.426
.424
Octane Rating .
Requirements .
Specifications .
Tank Capacity .
Fuel, Flexible . . .
Fuses . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.423
.423
.537
.536
.428
.517
Garage Door Opener (HomeLink®)
Gasoline, Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gasoline (Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gasoline, Reformulated . . . . . . . . .
Gauges
Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . .
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Information . . . . . . . . . . .
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.233
.424
.423
.424
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.267
.267
.267
.267
.355
.422
.515
10
568 INDEX
Gross Axle Weight Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435 Headlight Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .496
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435 Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
GVWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435 Head Rests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Heated Seats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Hazard
Heater, Engine Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
Driving Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow
Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366 High Beam/Low Beam Select (Dimmer) Switch . . . .155
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452 Hill Start Assist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .533 Hitches
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .440
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .515 Holder, Coin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
High Beam/Low Beam Select Switch . . . . . . . . .155
Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 Ignition
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
On With Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155 Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 Immobilizer (Sentry Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Time Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 Inside Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .496 Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
INDEX 569
Unlatch The Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Instrument Panel and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Unlock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .516
Interior Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .514 Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Keyless Enter-N-Go . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Intermittent Wipers (Delay Wipers). . . . . . . . . . . . .160 Keyless Enter-N-Go™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Enter The Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Lock The Vehicle’s Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
iPod®/USB/MP3 Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
Passive Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Passive Entry Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .456
Unlock From The Driver’s Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Jack Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .455
Unlock From The Passenger Side . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Key Fob. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13 Keyless Go. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Arm The Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 Key, Sentry (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Programming Additional Key Fobs . . . . . . . . . . .18
Programming Additional Transmitters . . . . . . . . .18 Lane Change and Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Remote Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
10
570 INDEX
LaneSense . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Lap/Shoulder Belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Lead Free Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Leaks, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Light Bulbs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Anti-Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Automatic Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Brake Assist Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .533
Daytime Running . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Dimmer Switch, Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Indicator . . . . .383
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Headlights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Headlights On With Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Headlight Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
High Beam Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
High Beam/Low Beam Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Intensity Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .535
Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) . . . . . . . . .267
Map Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Parade Mode (Daytime Brightness) . . . . . . . . . . .159
INDEX 571
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
Service Engine Soon (Malfunction Indicator) . . . .267
Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Vanity Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . . .267
Loading Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .436
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
Load Leveling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Auto Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Child Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Low Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .495
Lug Nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
Maintenance Free Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Malfunction Indicator Light (Check Engine).
Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Cylinder (Brakes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Feature (Memory Seat) . . . . . . . . .
Memory Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Memory Seats and Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Methanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electric Powered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electric Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.489
.484
.542
.267
.556
.506
.143
.143
.143
.424
.110
.118
.118
10
572 INDEX
Exterior Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Vanity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Monitor, Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
MOPAR® Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
MTBE/ETBE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
Multi-Function Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
New Vehicle Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
Filter Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
Identification Logo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .486
Materials Added to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
Recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .486
Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Oil Filter, Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481
Operating Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .481
Operator Manual (Owner’s Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Outside Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Owner’s Manual (Operator Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Octane Rating, Gasoline (Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Odometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Oil, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .536
Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .486 Paint Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .511
INDEX 573
Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Parking Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
ParkSense® System, Rear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Passive Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Pedals, Adjustable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Pets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Placard, Tire and Loading Information . . . . . . . . . .392
Power
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
Deck Lid Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Distribution Center (Fuses) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .523
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Outlet (Auxiliary Electrical Outlet) . . . . . . . . . . .247
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
Tilt/Telescoping Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Pregnant Women and Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Preparation for Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .458
Pretensioners
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Programmable Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Programming Transmitters (Remote Keyless Entry) . .21
Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radiator Cap (Coolant Pressure Cap)
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radio Remote Controls . . . . . . . . . .
Radio (Sound Systems) . . . . . . . . . .
Rain Sensitive Wiper System . . . . . .
Rear Axle (Differential) . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Cupholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear ParkSense System . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Seat, Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.400
.503
.310
.308
.307
.163
.510
.228
.253
.213
.141
.260
10
574 INDEX
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Recorder, Event Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .492
Release, Hood. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Reminder, Lights On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Reminder, Seat Belt. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Remote Control
Starting System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Arm The Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
FCC General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Programming Additional Key Fobs . . . . . . . . . . .18
Programming Additional Transmitters . . . . . . . . .18
Remote Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Transmitter Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Unlatch The Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Unlock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Remote Sound System (Radio) Controls . . . . . . . . .308
Remote Starting
Exit Remote Start Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
How To Use Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
To Exit Remote Start Mode And Drive The
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Uconnect® Customer Programmable Features . . .302
Uconnect® Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
Remote Starting System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Remote Trunk Release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Replacement Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .483
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .407
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .555
Restraint, Head. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
INDEX 575
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Restraints, Occupant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Seat Belt System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Rocking Vehicle When Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
Rotation, Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411 Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .516
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Anchorage . . . . . . . . .54
Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .555
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Safety, Exhaust Gas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .384
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .542
Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Seat Belt
Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) . . . . . . . . . . .57
Energy Management Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Untwisting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Lap/Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Easy Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Seat Belt Pretensioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
10
576 INDEX
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Height Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Rear Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Seatback Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Tilting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Arm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .537
SENTRY KEY®
FCC General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Sentry Key (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Sentry Key Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .551
Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .553
Service Engine Soon Light (Malfunction Indicator) . .267
Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .556
Setting the Clock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Shoulder Belt Upper Anchorage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Side View Mirror Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Signals, Turn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Snow Chains (Tire Chains) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .409
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .401
Spare Tire. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .537
Specifications
Fuel (Gasoline) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .537
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .537
Speed Control (Cruise Control). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Speedometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
Cold Weather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
INDEX 577
Engine Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Starting and Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
Starting Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
Steering
Column Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Column Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Tilt Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Wheel, Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Steering Wheel Audio Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
Steering Wheel Mounted Sound System Controls . . .308
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
Storage, Vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Storing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
Sunglasses Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Sun Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
Supplemental Restraint System - Airbag . . . . . . . . . .60
Synthetic Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
System, Remote Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Tachometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Telescoping Steering Column . . . . . . . .
Temperature Control, Automatic (ATC) .
Temperature Gauge, Engine Coolant . . .
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Time Delay, Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire and Loading Information Placard . .
Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aging (Life of Tires) . . . . . . . . . . . .
Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . .
High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.267
.164
.311
.267
.164
.150
.391
.384
.101
.406
.396
.409
.455
.403
.396
.399
10
578 INDEX
Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . .
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)
Pressure Warning Light . . . . . . .
Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . .
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . .
Tongue Weight/Trailer Weight . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.398
.455
.406
.391
.412
.267
.557
.400
.407
.411
.384
.386
.401
.456
.405
.445
.406
.384
.442
To Open Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Recreational . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Towing Vehicle Behind a Motorhome
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cooling System Tips . . . . . . . . . .
Hitches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Minimum Requirements . . . . . . .
Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer and Tongue Weight . . . . . .
Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Towing Guide. . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.147
.437
.473
.441
.450
.441
.450
.365
.375
.437
.449
.440
.443
.448
.442
.447
.441
.441
.509
INDEX 579
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .510
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .508
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .508
Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
Transmitter Battery Service (Remote Keyless Entry) . .24
Transmitter Programming (Remote Keyless Entry) . . .21
Transmitter, Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) . . . . . . . . .21
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Trunk Lid (Deck Lid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Trunk Release, Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Trunk Release Remote Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Uconnect®
Customer Programmable Features . . . . . . . . . . .302
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
Uconnect® Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Uconnect® Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Customer Programmable Features . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Passive Entry Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Uconnect® Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Uconnect® Voice Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
Uniform Tire Quality Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .557
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) Connector . . . .307
Unleaded Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Vanity Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Vehicle Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
UCI Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307 Vehicle Modifications/Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
10
580 INDEX
Vehicle Security Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . .19
Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Viscosity, Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Voice Recognition System (VR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
Warning Flasher, Hazard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .452
Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . . .267
Warnings and Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .554
Washer
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .496
Washers, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .511
Water
Driving Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
Wheel and Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .513
Wheel and Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .513
Wind Buffeting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Reset Auto-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Windshield Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .496
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .495
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .495
Wipers, Intermittent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Wipers, Rain Sensitive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING
EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this vehicle’s
electronic system to provide immunity to radio frequency signals.
Mobile two-way radios and telephone equipment must be installed
properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed
during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly to the
battery and fused as close to the battery as possible. The negative
power connection should be made to body sheet metal adjacent to
the negative battery connection. This connection should not be
fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the roof or the
rear area of the vehicle. Care should be used in mounting antennas
with magnet bases. Magnets may affect the accuracy or operation
of the compass on vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and routed away
from the vehicle wiring when possible. Use only fully shielded
coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to ensure a low
Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than normal
may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications equipment and the vehicle’s electronic
systems.
Chrysler Group LLC
15UF-126-AA
15C481-126-AB
First Edition
Second
Edition
Printedinin U.S.A.
U.S.A.
Printed